OpenCores
URL https://opencores.org/ocsvn/openrisc/openrisc/trunk

Subversion Repositories openrisc

[/] [openrisc/] [trunk/] [gnu-old/] [gcc-4.2.2/] [gcc/] [doc/] [invoke.texi] - Blame information for rev 823

Go to most recent revision | Details | Compare with Previous | View Log

Line No. Rev Author Line
1 38 julius
@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
2
@c 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
@c This is part of the GCC manual.
4
@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
 
6
@ignore
7
@c man begin INCLUDE
8
@include gcc-vers.texi
9
@c man end
10
 
11
@c man begin COPYRIGHT
12
Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
13
1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14
 
15
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
16
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
17
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
18
Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
19
Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
20
the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the license is
21
included in the gfdl(7) man page.
22
 
23
(a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
24
 
25
     A GNU Manual
26
 
27
(b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
28
 
29
     You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
30
     software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
31
     funds for GNU development.
32
@c man end
33
@c Set file name and title for the man page.
34
@setfilename gcc
35
@settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
36
@c man begin SYNOPSIS
37
gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
38
    [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
39
    [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-pedantic}]
40
    [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
41
    [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
42
    [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
43
    [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] [@@@var{file}] @var{infile}@dots{}
44
 
45
Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
46
remainder.  @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
47
@c man end
48
@c man begin SEEALSO
49
gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
50
cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
51
and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{as},
52
@file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
53
@c man end
54
@c man begin BUGS
55
For instructions on reporting bugs, see
56
@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/bugs.html}}.
57
@c man end
58
@c man begin AUTHOR
59
See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
60
@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
61
for contributors to GCC@.
62
@c man end
63
@end ignore
64
 
65
@node Invoking GCC
66
@chapter GCC Command Options
67
@cindex GCC command options
68
@cindex command options
69
@cindex options, GCC command
70
 
71
@c man begin DESCRIPTION
72
When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
73
assembly and linking.  The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
74
process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the @option{-c} option
75
says not to run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files
76
output by the assembler.
77
 
78
Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options
79
control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself.  Yet other
80
options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
81
documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
82
 
83
@cindex C compilation options
84
Most of the command line options that you can use with GCC are useful
85
for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
86
(usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
87
for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
88
that option with all supported languages.
89
 
90
@cindex C++ compilation options
91
@xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
92
options for compiling C++ programs.
93
 
94
@cindex grouping options
95
@cindex options, grouping
96
The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many
97
options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
98
may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dr} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
99
-r}}.
100
 
101
@cindex order of options
102
@cindex options, order
103
You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order
104
you use doesn't matter.  Order does matter when you use several options
105
of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more than once,
106
the directories are searched in the order specified.
107
 
108
Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
109
@samp{-W}---for example,
110
@option{-fmove-loop-invariants}, @option{-Wformat} and so on.  Most of
111
these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
112
@option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  This manual documents
113
only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
114
 
115
@c man end
116
 
117
@xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
118
 
119
@menu
120
* Option Summary::      Brief list of all options, without explanations.
121
* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
122
                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
123
                        or preprocessed source.
124
* Invoking G++::        Compiling C++ programs.
125
* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
126
* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
127
* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
128
                        and Objective-C++.
129
* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
130
                        formatted.
131
* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
132
* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
133
* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
134
* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
135
                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
136
* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
137
* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
138
* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
139
                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
140
* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
141
* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
142
* Submodel Options::    Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
143
                        such as 68010 vs 68020.
144
* Code Gen Options::    Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
145
                        and register usage.
146
* Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
147
* Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
148
* Running Protoize::    Automatically adding or removing function prototypes.
149
@end menu
150
 
151
@c man begin OPTIONS
152
 
153
@node Option Summary
154
@section Option Summary
155
 
156
Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are
157
in the following sections.
158
 
159
@table @emph
160
@item Overall Options
161
@xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
162
@gccoptlist{-c  -S  -E  -o @var{file}  -combine -pipe  -pass-exit-codes  @gol
163
-x @var{language}  -v  -###  --help  --target-help  --version @@@var{file}}
164
 
165
@item C Language Options
166
@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
167
@gccoptlist{-ansi  -std=@var{standard}  -fgnu89-inline @gol
168
-aux-info @var{filename} @gol
169
-fno-asm  -fno-builtin  -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
170
-fhosted  -ffreestanding -fopenmp -fms-extensions @gol
171
-trigraphs  -no-integrated-cpp  -traditional  -traditional-cpp @gol
172
-fallow-single-precision  -fcond-mismatch @gol
173
-fsigned-bitfields  -fsigned-char @gol
174
-funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char}
175
 
176
@item C++ Language Options
177
@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
178
@gccoptlist{-fabi-version=@var{n}  -fno-access-control  -fcheck-new @gol
179
-fconserve-space  -ffriend-injection @gol
180
-fno-elide-constructors @gol
181
-fno-enforce-eh-specs @gol
182
-ffor-scope  -fno-for-scope  -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
183
-fno-implicit-templates @gol
184
-fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
185
-fno-implement-inlines  -fms-extensions @gol
186
-fno-nonansi-builtins  -fno-operator-names @gol
187
-fno-optional-diags  -fpermissive @gol
188
-frepo  -fno-rtti  -fstats  -ftemplate-depth-@var{n} @gol
189
-fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit  -fno-weak  -nostdinc++ @gol
190
-fno-default-inline  -fvisibility-inlines-hidden @gol
191
-Wabi  -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
192
-Wnon-virtual-dtor  -Wreorder @gol
193
-Weffc++  -Wno-deprecated  -Wstrict-null-sentinel @gol
194
-Wno-non-template-friend  -Wold-style-cast @gol
195
-Woverloaded-virtual  -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
196
-Wsign-promo}
197
 
198
@item Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
199
@xref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling
200
Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects}.
201
@gccoptlist{-fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
202
-fgnu-runtime  -fnext-runtime @gol
203
-fno-nil-receivers @gol
204
-fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors @gol
205
-fobjc-direct-dispatch @gol
206
-fobjc-exceptions @gol
207
-fobjc-gc @gol
208
-freplace-objc-classes @gol
209
-fzero-link @gol
210
-gen-decls @gol
211
-Wassign-intercept @gol
212
-Wno-protocol  -Wselector @gol
213
-Wstrict-selector-match @gol
214
-Wundeclared-selector}
215
 
216
@item Language Independent Options
217
@xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
218
@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=@var{n}  @gol
219
-fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]}  @gol
220
-fdiagnostics-show-option}
221
 
222
@item Warning Options
223
@xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
224
@gccoptlist{-fsyntax-only  -pedantic  -pedantic-errors @gol
225
-w  -Wextra  -Wall  -Waddress  -Waggregate-return -Wno-attributes @gol
226
-Wc++-compat -Wcast-align  -Wcast-qual  -Wchar-subscripts  -Wcomment @gol
227
-Wconversion  -Wno-deprecated-declarations @gol
228
-Wdisabled-optimization  -Wno-div-by-zero  -Wno-endif-labels @gol
229
-Werror  -Werror=* -Werror-implicit-function-declaration @gol
230
-Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2 @gol
231
-Wno-format-extra-args -Wformat-nonliteral @gol
232
-Wformat-security  -Wformat-y2k @gol
233
-Wimplicit  -Wimplicit-function-declaration  -Wimplicit-int @gol
234
-Wimport  -Wno-import  -Winit-self  -Winline @gol
235
-Wno-int-to-pointer-cast @gol
236
-Wno-invalid-offsetof  -Winvalid-pch @gol
237
-Wlarger-than-@var{len}  -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations  -Wlong-long @gol
238
-Wmain  -Wmissing-braces  -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
239
-Wmissing-format-attribute  -Wmissing-include-dirs @gol
240
-Wmissing-noreturn @gol
241
-Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull  -Wno-overflow @gol
242
-Woverlength-strings  -Wpacked  -Wpadded @gol
243
-Wparentheses  -Wpointer-arith  -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @gol
244
-Wredundant-decls @gol
245
-Wreturn-type  -Wsequence-point  -Wshadow @gol
246
-Wsign-compare  -Wstack-protector @gol
247
-Wstrict-aliasing -Wstrict-aliasing=2 @gol
248
-Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n} @gol
249
-Wswitch  -Wswitch-default  -Wswitch-enum @gol
250
-Wsystem-headers  -Wtrigraphs  -Wundef  -Wuninitialized @gol
251
-Wunknown-pragmas  -Wno-pragmas -Wunreachable-code @gol
252
-Wunused  -Wunused-function  -Wunused-label  -Wunused-parameter @gol
253
-Wunused-value  -Wunused-variable  -Wvariadic-macros @gol
254
-Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings}
255
 
256
@item C-only Warning Options
257
@gccoptlist{-Wbad-function-cast  -Wmissing-declarations @gol
258
-Wmissing-prototypes  -Wnested-externs  -Wold-style-definition @gol
259
-Wstrict-prototypes  -Wtraditional @gol
260
-Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign}
261
 
262
@item Debugging Options
263
@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
264
@gccoptlist{-d@var{letters}  -dumpspecs  -dumpmachine  -dumpversion @gol
265
-fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered  -fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
266
-fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
267
-fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph @gol
268
-fdump-tree-all @gol
269
-fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]}  @gol
270
-fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
271
-fdump-tree-inlined@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
272
-fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-vcg -fdump-tree-alias @gol
273
-fdump-tree-ch @gol
274
-fdump-tree-ssa@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-pre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
275
-fdump-tree-ccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-dce@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
276
-fdump-tree-gimple@r{[}-raw@r{]} -fdump-tree-mudflap@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
277
-fdump-tree-dom@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
278
-fdump-tree-dse@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
279
-fdump-tree-phiopt@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
280
-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
281
-fdump-tree-copyrename@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
282
-fdump-tree-nrv -fdump-tree-vect @gol
283
-fdump-tree-sink @gol
284
-fdump-tree-sra@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
285
-fdump-tree-salias @gol
286
-fdump-tree-fre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
287
-fdump-tree-vrp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
288
-ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n} @gol
289
-fdump-tree-storeccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
290
-feliminate-dwarf2-dups -feliminate-unused-debug-types @gol
291
-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always @gol
292
-fmem-report -fprofile-arcs @gol
293
-frandom-seed=@var{string} -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
294
-ftest-coverage  -ftime-report -fvar-tracking @gol
295
-g  -g@var{level}  -gcoff -gdwarf-2 @gol
296
-ggdb  -gstabs  -gstabs+  -gvms  -gxcoff  -gxcoff+ @gol
297
-p  -pg  -print-file-name=@var{library}  -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
298
-print-multi-directory  -print-multi-lib @gol
299
-print-prog-name=@var{program}  -print-search-dirs  -Q @gol
300
-save-temps  -time}
301
 
302
@item Optimization Options
303
@xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
304
@gccoptlist{-falign-functions=@var{n}  -falign-jumps=@var{n} @gol
305
-falign-labels=@var{n}  -falign-loops=@var{n}  @gol
306
-fbounds-check -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir @gol
307
-fbranch-probabilities -fprofile-values -fvpt -fbranch-target-load-optimize @gol
308
-fbranch-target-load-optimize2 -fbtr-bb-exclusive @gol
309
-fcaller-saves  -fcprop-registers  -fcse-follow-jumps @gol
310
-fcse-skip-blocks  -fcx-limited-range  -fdata-sections @gol
311
-fdelayed-branch  -fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fearly-inlining @gol
312
-fexpensive-optimizations  -ffast-math  -ffloat-store @gol
313
-fforce-addr  -ffunction-sections @gol
314
-fgcse  -fgcse-lm  -fgcse-sm  -fgcse-las  -fgcse-after-reload @gol
315
-fcrossjumping  -fif-conversion  -fif-conversion2 @gol
316
-finline-functions  -finline-functions-called-once @gol
317
-finline-limit=@var{n}  -fkeep-inline-functions @gol
318
-fkeep-static-consts  -fmerge-constants  -fmerge-all-constants @gol
319
-fmodulo-sched -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
320
-fno-default-inline  -fno-defer-pop -fmove-loop-invariants @gol
321
-fno-function-cse  -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
322
-fno-inline  -fno-math-errno  -fno-peephole  -fno-peephole2 @gol
323
-funsafe-math-optimizations  -funsafe-loop-optimizations  -ffinite-math-only @gol
324
-fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math  -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
325
-fomit-frame-pointer  -foptimize-register-move @gol
326
-foptimize-sibling-calls  -fprefetch-loop-arrays @gol
327
-fprofile-generate -fprofile-use @gol
328
-fregmove  -frename-registers @gol
329
-freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions @gol
330
-frerun-cse-after-loop @gol
331
-frounding-math -frtl-abstract-sequences @gol
332
-fschedule-insns  -fschedule-insns2 @gol
333
-fno-sched-interblock  -fno-sched-spec  -fsched-spec-load @gol
334
-fsched-spec-load-dangerous  @gol
335
-fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n} -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n} @gol
336
-fsched2-use-superblocks @gol
337
-fsched2-use-traces -fsee -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops @gol
338
-fsection-anchors  -fsignaling-nans  -fsingle-precision-constant @gol
339
-fstack-protector  -fstack-protector-all @gol
340
-fstrict-aliasing  -fstrict-overflow  -ftracer  -fthread-jumps @gol
341
-funroll-all-loops  -funroll-loops  -fpeel-loops @gol
342
-fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -funswitch-loops @gol
343
-fvariable-expansion-in-unroller @gol
344
-ftree-pre  -ftree-ccp  -ftree-dce -ftree-loop-optimize @gol
345
-ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-im -ftree-loop-ivcanon -fivopts @gol
346
-ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse -ftree-copyrename -ftree-sink @gol
347
-ftree-ch -ftree-sra -ftree-ter -ftree-lrs -ftree-fre -ftree-vectorize @gol
348
-ftree-vect-loop-version -ftree-salias -fipa-pta -fweb @gol
349
-ftree-copy-prop -ftree-store-ccp -ftree-store-copy-prop -fwhole-program @gol
350
--param @var{name}=@var{value}
351
-O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os}
352
 
353
@item Preprocessor Options
354
@xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
355
@gccoptlist{-A@var{question}=@var{answer} @gol
356
-A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
357
-C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN @gol
358
-D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]}  -E  -H @gol
359
-idirafter @var{dir} @gol
360
-include @var{file}  -imacros @var{file} @gol
361
-iprefix @var{file}  -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
362
-iwithprefixbefore @var{dir}  -isystem @var{dir} @gol
363
-imultilib @var{dir} -isysroot @var{dir} @gol
364
-M  -MM  -MF  -MG  -MP  -MQ  -MT  -nostdinc  @gol
365
-P  -fworking-directory  -remap @gol
366
-trigraphs  -undef  -U@var{macro}  -Wp,@var{option} @gol
367
-Xpreprocessor @var{option}}
368
 
369
@item Assembler Option
370
@xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
371
@gccoptlist{-Wa,@var{option}  -Xassembler @var{option}}
372
 
373
@item Linker Options
374
@xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
375
@gccoptlist{@var{object-file-name}  -l@var{library} @gol
376
-nostartfiles  -nodefaultlibs  -nostdlib -pie -rdynamic @gol
377
-s  -static  -static-libgcc  -shared  -shared-libgcc  -symbolic @gol
378
-Wl,@var{option}  -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
379
-u @var{symbol}}
380
 
381
@item Directory Options
382
@xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
383
@gccoptlist{-B@var{prefix}  -I@var{dir}  -iquote@var{dir}  -L@var{dir}
384
-specs=@var{file}  -I- --sysroot=@var{dir}}
385
 
386
@item Target Options
387
@c I wrote this xref this way to avoid overfull hbox. -- rms
388
@xref{Target Options}.
389
@gccoptlist{-V @var{version}  -b @var{machine}}
390
 
391
@item Machine Dependent Options
392
@xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
393
@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
394
@c Try and put the significant identifier (CPU or system) first,
395
@c so users have a clue at guessing where the ones they want will be.
396
 
397
@emph{ARC Options}
398
@gccoptlist{-EB  -EL @gol
399
-mmangle-cpu  -mcpu=@var{cpu}  -mtext=@var{text-section} @gol
400
-mdata=@var{data-section}  -mrodata=@var{readonly-data-section}}
401
 
402
@emph{ARM Options}
403
@gccoptlist{-mapcs-frame  -mno-apcs-frame @gol
404
-mabi=@var{name} @gol
405
-mapcs-stack-check  -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
406
-mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float @gol
407
-mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
408
-msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog @gol
409
-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -mwords-little-endian @gol
410
-mfloat-abi=@var{name}  -msoft-float  -mhard-float  -mfpe @gol
411
-mthumb-interwork  -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
412
-mcpu=@var{name}  -march=@var{name}  -mfpu=@var{name}  @gol
413
-mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
414
-mabort-on-noreturn @gol
415
-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
416
-msingle-pic-base  -mno-single-pic-base @gol
417
-mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
418
-mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
419
-mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns @gol
420
-mpoke-function-name @gol
421
-mthumb  -marm @gol
422
-mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
423
-mcaller-super-interworking  -mcallee-super-interworking @gol
424
-mtp=@var{name}}
425
 
426
@emph{AVR Options}
427
@gccoptlist{-mmcu=@var{mcu}  -msize  -minit-stack=@var{n}  -mno-interrupts @gol
428
-mcall-prologues  -mno-tablejump  -mtiny-stack  -mint8}
429
 
430
@emph{Blackfin Options}
431
@gccoptlist{-momit-leaf-frame-pointer -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
432
-mspecld-anomaly -mno-specld-anomaly -mcsync-anomaly -mno-csync-anomaly @gol
433
-mlow-64k -mno-low64k -mid-shared-library @gol
434
-mno-id-shared-library -mshared-library-id=@var{n} @gol
435
-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls}
436
 
437
@emph{CRIS Options}
438
@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}  -march=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
439
-mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}  -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
440
-metrax4  -metrax100  -mpdebug  -mcc-init  -mno-side-effects @gol
441
-mstack-align  -mdata-align  -mconst-align @gol
442
-m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt @gol
443
-melf  -maout  -melinux  -mlinux  -sim  -sim2 @gol
444
-mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround}
445
 
446
@emph{CRX Options}
447
@gccoptlist{-mmac -mpush-args}
448
 
449
@emph{Darwin Options}
450
@gccoptlist{-all_load  -allowable_client  -arch  -arch_errors_fatal @gol
451
-arch_only  -bind_at_load  -bundle  -bundle_loader @gol
452
-client_name  -compatibility_version  -current_version @gol
453
-dead_strip @gol
454
-dependency-file  -dylib_file  -dylinker_install_name @gol
455
-dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list @gol
456
-filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
457
-force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
458
-image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs @gol
459
-multi_module  -multiply_defined  -multiply_defined_unused @gol
460
-noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms @gol
461
-nofixprebinding -nomultidefs  -noprebind  -noseglinkedit @gol
462
-pagezero_size  -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
463
-private_bundle  -read_only_relocs  -sectalign @gol
464
-sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr @gol
465
-sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols  -sectorder @gol
466
-segaddr -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
467
-seg_addr_table  -seg_addr_table_filename  -seglinkedit @gol
468
-segprot  -segs_read_only_addr  -segs_read_write_addr @gol
469
-single_module  -static  -sub_library  -sub_umbrella @gol
470
-twolevel_namespace  -umbrella  -undefined @gol
471
-unexported_symbols_list  -weak_reference_mismatches @gol
472
-whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version} @gol
473
-mkernel -mone-byte-bool}
474
 
475
@emph{DEC Alpha Options}
476
@gccoptlist{-mno-fp-regs  -msoft-float  -malpha-as  -mgas @gol
477
-mieee  -mieee-with-inexact  -mieee-conformant @gol
478
-mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode}  -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
479
-mtrap-precision=@var{mode}  -mbuild-constants @gol
480
-mcpu=@var{cpu-type}  -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
481
-mbwx  -mmax  -mfix  -mcix @gol
482
-mfloat-vax  -mfloat-ieee @gol
483
-mexplicit-relocs  -msmall-data  -mlarge-data @gol
484
-msmall-text  -mlarge-text @gol
485
-mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
486
 
487
@emph{DEC Alpha/VMS Options}
488
@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes}
489
 
490
@emph{FRV Options}
491
@gccoptlist{-mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 @gol
492
-mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
493
-malloc-cc  -mfixed-cc  -mdword  -mno-dword @gol
494
-mdouble  -mno-double @gol
495
-mmedia  -mno-media  -mmuladd  -mno-muladd @gol
496
-mfdpic  -minline-plt -mgprel-ro  -multilib-library-pic @gol
497
-mlinked-fp  -mlong-calls  -malign-labels @gol
498
-mlibrary-pic  -macc-4  -macc-8 @gol
499
-mpack  -mno-pack  -mno-eflags  -mcond-move  -mno-cond-move @gol
500
-moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar @gol
501
-mscc  -mno-scc  -mcond-exec  -mno-cond-exec @gol
502
-mvliw-branch  -mno-vliw-branch @gol
503
-mmulti-cond-exec  -mno-multi-cond-exec  -mnested-cond-exec @gol
504
-mno-nested-cond-exec  -mtomcat-stats @gol
505
-mTLS -mtls @gol
506
-mcpu=@var{cpu}}
507
 
508
@emph{GNU/Linux Options}
509
@gccoptlist{-muclibc}
510
 
511
@emph{H8/300 Options}
512
@gccoptlist{-mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mint32  -malign-300}
513
 
514
@emph{HPPA Options}
515
@gccoptlist{-march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
516
-mbig-switch  -mdisable-fpregs  -mdisable-indexing @gol
517
-mfast-indirect-calls  -mgas  -mgnu-ld   -mhp-ld @gol
518
-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
519
-mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
520
-mlong-load-store  -mno-big-switch  -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
521
-mno-disable-indexing  -mno-fast-indirect-calls  -mno-gas @gol
522
-mno-jump-in-delay  -mno-long-load-store @gol
523
-mno-portable-runtime  -mno-soft-float @gol
524
-mno-space-regs  -msoft-float  -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
525
-mpa-risc-1-1  -mpa-risc-2-0  -mportable-runtime @gol
526
-mschedule=@var{cpu-type}  -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio @gol
527
-munix=@var{unix-std}  -nolibdld  -static  -threads}
528
 
529
@emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
530
@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
531
-mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
532
-masm=@var{dialect}  -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
533
-mno-fp-ret-in-387  -msoft-float  -msvr3-shlib @gol
534
-mno-wide-multiply  -mrtd  -malign-double @gol
535
-mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
536
-mmmx  -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -m3dnow @gol
537
-mthreads  -mno-align-stringops  -minline-all-stringops @gol
538
-mpush-args  -maccumulate-outgoing-args  -m128bit-long-double @gol
539
-m96bit-long-double  -mregparm=@var{num}  -msseregparm @gol
540
-mstackrealign @gol
541
-momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs @gol
542
-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
543
-m32  -m64 -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{num}}
544
 
545
@emph{IA-64 Options}
546
@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mgnu-as  -mgnu-ld  -mno-pic @gol
547
-mvolatile-asm-stop  -mregister-names  -mno-sdata @gol
548
-mconstant-gp  -mauto-pic  -minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
549
-minline-float-divide-max-throughput @gol
550
-minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
551
-minline-int-divide-max-throughput  @gol
552
-minline-sqrt-min-latency -minline-sqrt-max-throughput @gol
553
-mno-dwarf2-asm -mearly-stop-bits @gol
554
-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} -mtls-size=@var{tls-size} @gol
555
-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -mt -pthread -milp32 -mlp64 @gol
556
-mno-sched-br-data-spec -msched-ar-data-spec -mno-sched-control-spec @gol
557
-msched-br-in-data-spec -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec @gol
558
-msched-ldc -mno-sched-control-ldc -mno-sched-spec-verbose @gol
559
-mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns @gol
560
-mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns @gol
561
-mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path}
562
 
563
@emph{M32R/D Options}
564
@gccoptlist{-m32r2 -m32rx -m32r @gol
565
-mdebug @gol
566
-malign-loops -mno-align-loops @gol
567
-missue-rate=@var{number} @gol
568
-mbranch-cost=@var{number} @gol
569
-mmodel=@var{code-size-model-type} @gol
570
-msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
571
-mno-flush-func -mflush-func=@var{name} @gol
572
-mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=@var{number} @gol
573
-G @var{num}}
574
 
575
@emph{M32C Options}
576
@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -msim -memregs=@var{number}}
577
 
578
@emph{M680x0 Options}
579
@gccoptlist{-m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60  -m68030  -m68040 @gol
580
-m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -mcfv4e -m68881  -mbitfield  @gol
581
-mc68000  -mc68020   @gol
582
-mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mshort  -msoft-float  -mpcrel @gol
583
-malign-int  -mstrict-align  -msep-data  -mno-sep-data @gol
584
-mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library}
585
 
586
@emph{M68hc1x Options}
587
@gccoptlist{-m6811  -m6812  -m68hc11  -m68hc12   -m68hcs12 @gol
588
-mauto-incdec  -minmax  -mlong-calls  -mshort @gol
589
-msoft-reg-count=@var{count}}
590
 
591
@emph{MCore Options}
592
@gccoptlist{-mhardlit  -mno-hardlit  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mrelax-immediates @gol
593
-mno-relax-immediates  -mwide-bitfields  -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
594
-m4byte-functions  -mno-4byte-functions  -mcallgraph-data @gol
595
-mno-callgraph-data  -mslow-bytes  -mno-slow-bytes  -mno-lsim @gol
596
-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -m210  -m340  -mstack-increment}
597
 
598
@emph{MIPS Options}
599
@gccoptlist{-EL  -EB  -march=@var{arch}  -mtune=@var{arch} @gol
600
-mips1  -mips2  -mips3  -mips4  -mips32  -mips32r2  -mips64 @gol
601
-mips16  -mno-mips16  -mabi=@var{abi}  -mabicalls  -mno-abicalls @gol
602
-mshared  -mno-shared  -mxgot  -mno-xgot  -mgp32  -mgp64  @gol
603
-mfp32  -mfp64  -mhard-float  -msoft-float  @gol
604
-msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -mdsp  -mpaired-single  -mips3d @gol
605
-mlong64  -mlong32  -msym32  -mno-sym32 @gol
606
-G@var{num}  -membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data @gol
607
-muninit-const-in-rodata  -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
608
-msplit-addresses  -mno-split-addresses  @gol
609
-mexplicit-relocs  -mno-explicit-relocs  @gol
610
-mcheck-zero-division  -mno-check-zero-division @gol
611
-mdivide-traps  -mdivide-breaks @gol
612
-mmemcpy  -mno-memcpy  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
613
-mmad  -mno-mad  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -nocpp @gol
614
-mfix-r4000  -mno-fix-r4000  -mfix-r4400  -mno-fix-r4400 @gol
615
-mfix-vr4120  -mno-fix-vr4120  -mfix-vr4130 @gol
616
-mfix-sb1  -mno-fix-sb1 @gol
617
-mflush-func=@var{func}  -mno-flush-func @gol
618
-mbranch-likely  -mno-branch-likely @gol
619
-mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions @gol
620
-mvr4130-align -mno-vr4130-align}
621
 
622
@emph{MMIX Options}
623
@gccoptlist{-mlibfuncs  -mno-libfuncs  -mepsilon  -mno-epsilon  -mabi=gnu @gol
624
-mabi=mmixware  -mzero-extend  -mknuthdiv  -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
625
-melf  -mbranch-predict  -mno-branch-predict  -mbase-addresses @gol
626
-mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit}
627
 
628
@emph{MN10300 Options}
629
@gccoptlist{-mmult-bug  -mno-mult-bug @gol
630
-mam33  -mno-am33 @gol
631
-mam33-2  -mno-am33-2 @gol
632
-mreturn-pointer-on-d0 @gol
633
-mno-crt0  -mrelax}
634
 
635
@emph{MT Options}
636
@gccoptlist{-mno-crt0 -mbacc -msim @gol
637
-march=@var{cpu-type} }
638
 
639
@emph{PDP-11 Options}
640
@gccoptlist{-mfpu  -msoft-float  -mac0  -mno-ac0  -m40  -m45  -m10 @gol
641
-mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin  -mint32  -mno-int16 @gol
642
-mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32  -mno-float64 @gol
643
-mfloat64  -mno-float32  -mabshi  -mno-abshi @gol
644
-mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap @gol
645
-msplit  -mno-split  -munix-asm  -mdec-asm}
646
 
647
@emph{PowerPC Options}
648
See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
649
 
650
@emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
651
@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
652
-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
653
-mpower  -mno-power  -mpower2  -mno-power2 @gol
654
-mpowerpc  -mpowerpc64  -mno-powerpc @gol
655
-maltivec  -mno-altivec @gol
656
-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
657
-mpowerpc-gfxopt  -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
658
-mmfcrf  -mno-mfcrf  -mpopcntb  -mno-popcntb  -mfprnd  -mno-fprnd @gol
659
-mnew-mnemonics  -mold-mnemonics @gol
660
-mfull-toc   -mminimal-toc  -mno-fp-in-toc  -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
661
-m64  -m32  -mxl-compat  -mno-xl-compat  -mpe @gol
662
-malign-power  -malign-natural @gol
663
-msoft-float  -mhard-float  -mmultiple  -mno-multiple @gol
664
-mstring  -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update @gol
665
-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -mbit-align  -mno-bit-align @gol
666
-mstrict-align  -mno-strict-align  -mrelocatable @gol
667
-mno-relocatable  -mrelocatable-lib  -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
668
-mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle  -mlittle-endian  -mbig  -mbig-endian @gol
669
-mdynamic-no-pic  -maltivec  -mswdiv @gol
670
-mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority} @gol
671
-msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type} @gol
672
-minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme} @gol
673
-mcall-sysv  -mcall-netbsd @gol
674
-maix-struct-return  -msvr4-struct-return @gol
675
-mabi=@var{abi-type} -msecure-plt -mbss-plt @gol
676
-misel -mno-isel @gol
677
-misel=yes  -misel=no @gol
678
-mspe -mno-spe @gol
679
-mspe=yes  -mspe=no @gol
680
-mvrsave -mno-vrsave @gol
681
-mmulhw -mno-mulhw @gol
682
-mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb @gol
683
-mfloat-gprs=yes  -mfloat-gprs=no -mfloat-gprs=single -mfloat-gprs=double @gol
684
-mprototype  -mno-prototype @gol
685
-msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife  -memb  -msdata @gol
686
-msdata=@var{opt}  -mvxworks  -mwindiss  -G @var{num}  -pthread}
687
 
688
@emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
689
@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
690
-mhard-float  -msoft-float -mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 @gol
691
-mbackchain  -mno-backchain -mpacked-stack  -mno-packed-stack @gol
692
-msmall-exec  -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
693
-m64  -m31  -mdebug  -mno-debug  -mesa  -mzarch @gol
694
-mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
695
-mwarn-framesize  -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard}
696
 
697
@emph{Score Options}
698
@gccoptlist{-meb -mel @gol
699
-mnhwloop @gol
700
-muls @gol
701
-mmac @gol
702
-mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d}
703
 
704
@emph{SH Options}
705
@gccoptlist{-m1  -m2  -m2e  -m3  -m3e @gol
706
-m4-nofpu  -m4-single-only  -m4-single  -m4 @gol
707
-m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al @gol
708
-m5-64media  -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
709
-m5-32media  -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
710
-m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
711
-mb  -ml  -mdalign  -mrelax @gol
712
-mbigtable  -mfmovd  -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave @gol
713
-mieee  -misize  -mpadstruct  -mspace @gol
714
-mprefergot  -musermode -multcost=@var{number} -mdiv=@var{strategy} @gol
715
-mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}  @gol
716
-madjust-unroll -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=@var{number} -mpt-fixed @gol
717
 -minvalid-symbols}
718
 
719
@emph{SPARC Options}
720
@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
721
-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
722
-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
723
-m32  -m64  -mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
724
-mfaster-structs  -mno-faster-structs @gol
725
-mfpu  -mno-fpu  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
726
-mhard-quad-float  -msoft-quad-float @gol
727
-mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text  -mlittle-endian @gol
728
-mstack-bias  -mno-stack-bias @gol
729
-munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
730
-mv8plus  -mno-v8plus  -mvis  -mno-vis
731
-threads -pthreads -pthread}
732
 
733
@emph{System V Options}
734
@gccoptlist{-Qy  -Qn  -YP,@var{paths}  -Ym,@var{dir}}
735
 
736
@emph{TMS320C3x/C4x Options}
737
@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}  -mbig  -msmall  -mregparm  -mmemparm @gol
738
-mfast-fix  -mmpyi  -mbk  -mti  -mdp-isr-reload @gol
739
-mrpts=@var{count}  -mrptb  -mdb  -mloop-unsigned @gol
740
-mparallel-insns  -mparallel-mpy  -mpreserve-float}
741
 
742
@emph{V850 Options}
743
@gccoptlist{-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls  -mep  -mno-ep @gol
744
-mprolog-function  -mno-prolog-function  -mspace @gol
745
-mtda=@var{n}  -msda=@var{n}  -mzda=@var{n} @gol
746
-mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
747
-mdisable-callt  -mno-disable-callt @gol
748
-mv850e1 @gol
749
-mv850e @gol
750
-mv850  -mbig-switch}
751
 
752
@emph{VAX Options}
753
@gccoptlist{-mg  -mgnu  -munix}
754
 
755
@emph{x86-64 Options}
756
See i386 and x86-64 Options.
757
 
758
@emph{Xstormy16 Options}
759
@gccoptlist{-msim}
760
 
761
@emph{Xtensa Options}
762
@gccoptlist{-mconst16 -mno-const16 @gol
763
-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
764
-mtext-section-literals  -mno-text-section-literals @gol
765
-mtarget-align  -mno-target-align @gol
766
-mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls}
767
 
768
@emph{zSeries Options}
769
See S/390 and zSeries Options.
770
 
771
@item Code Generation Options
772
@xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
773
@gccoptlist{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}  -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
774
-ffixed-@var{reg}  -fexceptions @gol
775
-fnon-call-exceptions  -funwind-tables @gol
776
-fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
777
-finhibit-size-directive  -finstrument-functions @gol
778
-fno-common  -fno-ident @gol
779
-fpcc-struct-return  -fpic  -fPIC -fpie -fPIE @gol
780
-fno-jump-tables @gol
781
-freg-struct-return  -fshort-enums @gol
782
-fshort-double  -fshort-wchar @gol
783
-fverbose-asm  -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]  -fstack-check @gol
784
-fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}  -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
785
-fargument-alias  -fargument-noalias @gol
786
-fargument-noalias-global  -fargument-noalias-anything
787
-fleading-underscore  -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
788
-ftrapv  -fwrapv  -fbounds-check @gol
789
-fvisibility}
790
@end table
791
 
792
@menu
793
* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
794
                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
795
                        or preprocessed source.
796
* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
797
* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
798
* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
799
                        and Objective-C++.
800
* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
801
                        formatted.
802
* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
803
* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
804
* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
805
* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
806
                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
807
* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
808
* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
809
* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
810
                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
811
* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
812
* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
813
@end menu
814
 
815
@node Overall Options
816
@section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
817
 
818
Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
819
proper, assembly and linking, always in that order.  GCC is capable of
820
preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
821
assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then each
822
assembler input file produces an object file, and linking combines all
823
the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input)
824
into an executable file.
825
 
826
@cindex file name suffix
827
For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
828
compilation is done:
829
 
830
@table @gcctabopt
831
@item @var{file}.c
832
C source code which must be preprocessed.
833
 
834
@item @var{file}.i
835
C source code which should not be preprocessed.
836
 
837
@item @var{file}.ii
838
C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.
839
 
840
@item @var{file}.m
841
Objective-C source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
842
library to make an Objective-C program work.
843
 
844
@item @var{file}.mi
845
Objective-C source code which should not be preprocessed.
846
 
847
@item @var{file}.mm
848
@itemx @var{file}.M
849
Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
850
library to make an Objective-C++ program work.  Note that @samp{.M} refers
851
to a literal capital M@.
852
 
853
@item @var{file}.mii
854
Objective-C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.
855
 
856
@item @var{file}.h
857
C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a
858
precompiled header.
859
 
860
@item @var{file}.cc
861
@itemx @var{file}.cp
862
@itemx @var{file}.cxx
863
@itemx @var{file}.cpp
864
@itemx @var{file}.CPP
865
@itemx @var{file}.c++
866
@itemx @var{file}.C
867
C++ source code which must be preprocessed.  Note that in @samp{.cxx},
868
the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}.  Likewise,
869
@samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
870
 
871
@item @var{file}.mm
872
@itemx @var{file}.M
873
Objective-C++ source code which must be preprocessed.
874
 
875
@item @var{file}.mii
876
Objective-C++ source code which should not be preprocessed.
877
 
878
@item @var{file}.hh
879
@itemx @var{file}.H
880
C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header.
881
 
882
@item @var{file}.f
883
@itemx @var{file}.for
884
@itemx @var{file}.FOR
885
Fixed form Fortran source code which should not be preprocessed.
886
 
887
@item @var{file}.F
888
@itemx @var{file}.fpp
889
@itemx @var{file}.FPP
890
Fixed form Fortran source code which must be preprocessed (with the traditional
891
preprocessor).
892
 
893
@item @var{file}.f90
894
@itemx @var{file}.f95
895
Free form Fortran source code which should not be preprocessed.
896
 
897
@item @var{file}.F90
898
@itemx @var{file}.F95
899
Free form Fortran source code which must be preprocessed (with the
900
traditional preprocessor).
901
 
902
@c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
903
@c @var{file}.java
904
@c @var{file}.class
905
@c @var{file}.zip
906
@c @var{file}.jar
907
 
908
@item @var{file}.ads
909
Ada source code file which contains a library unit declaration (a
910
declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
911
instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
912
generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also
913
called @dfn{specs}.
914
 
915
@itemx @var{file}.adb
916
Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
917
package body).  Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
918
 
919
@c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
920
@c Pascal:
921
@c @var{file}.p
922
@c @var{file}.pas
923
@c Ratfor:
924
@c @var{file}.r
925
 
926
@item @var{file}.s
927
Assembler code.
928
 
929
@item @var{file}.S
930
Assembler code which must be preprocessed.
931
 
932
@item @var{other}
933
An object file to be fed straight into linking.
934
Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
935
@end table
936
 
937
@opindex x
938
You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
939
 
940
@table @gcctabopt
941
@item -x @var{language}
942
Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
943
(rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
944
name suffix).  This option applies to all following input files until
945
the next @option{-x} option.  Possible values for @var{language} are:
946
@smallexample
947
c  c-header  c-cpp-output
948
c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
949
objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
950
objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
951
assembler  assembler-with-cpp
952
ada
953
f95  f95-cpp-input
954
java
955
treelang
956
@end smallexample
957
 
958
@item -x none
959
Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
960
handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
961
has not been used at all).
962
 
963
@item -pass-exit-codes
964
@opindex pass-exit-codes
965
Normally the @command{gcc} program will exit with the code of 1 if any
966
phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code.  If you specify
967
@option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program will instead return with
968
numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error
969
indication.  The C, C++, and Fortran frontends return 4, if an internal
970
compiler error is encountered.
971
@end table
972
 
973
If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
974
@option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
975
one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
976
@command{gcc} is to stop.  Note that some combinations (for example,
977
@samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
978
 
979
@table @gcctabopt
980
@item -c
981
@opindex c
982
Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link.  The linking
983
stage simply is not done.  The ultimate output is in the form of an
984
object file for each source file.
985
 
986
By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
987
the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
988
 
989
Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
990
ignored.
991
 
992
@item -S
993
@opindex S
994
Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble.  The output
995
is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
996
file specified.
997
 
998
By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
999
replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
1000
 
1001
Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1002
 
1003
@item -E
1004
@opindex E
1005
Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The
1006
output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
1007
standard output.
1008
 
1009
Input files which don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1010
 
1011
@cindex output file option
1012
@item -o @var{file}
1013
@opindex o
1014
Place output in file @var{file}.  This applies regardless to whatever
1015
sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
1016
an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1017
 
1018
If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable
1019
file in @file{a.out}, the object file for
1020
@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in @file{@var{source}.o}, its
1021
assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, a precompiled header file in
1022
@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}.gch}, and all preprocessed C source on
1023
standard output.
1024
 
1025
@item -v
1026
@opindex v
1027
Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
1028
of compilation.  Also print the version number of the compiler driver
1029
program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
1030
 
1031
@item -###
1032
@opindex ###
1033
Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and all command
1034
arguments are quoted.  This is useful for shell scripts to capture the
1035
driver-generated command lines.
1036
 
1037
@item -pipe
1038
@opindex pipe
1039
Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1040
various stages of compilation.  This fails to work on some systems where
1041
the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
1042
no trouble.
1043
 
1044
@item -combine
1045
@opindex combine
1046
If you are compiling multiple source files, this option tells the driver
1047
to pass all the source files to the compiler at once (for those
1048
languages for which the compiler can handle this).  This will allow
1049
intermodule analysis (IMA) to be performed by the compiler.  Currently the only
1050
language for which this is supported is C@.  If you pass source files for
1051
multiple languages to the driver, using this option, the driver will invoke
1052
the compiler(s) that support IMA once each, passing each compiler all the
1053
source files appropriate for it.  For those languages that do not support
1054
IMA this option will be ignored, and the compiler will be invoked once for
1055
each source file in that language.  If you use this option in conjunction
1056
with @option{-save-temps}, the compiler will generate multiple
1057
pre-processed files
1058
(one for each source file), but only one (combined) @file{.o} or
1059
@file{.s} file.
1060
 
1061
@item --help
1062
@opindex help
1063
Print (on the standard output) a description of the command line options
1064
understood by @command{gcc}.  If the @option{-v} option is also specified
1065
then @option{--help} will also be passed on to the various processes
1066
invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command line options
1067
they accept.  If the @option{-Wextra} option is also specified then command
1068
line options which have no documentation associated with them will also
1069
be displayed.
1070
 
1071
@item --target-help
1072
@opindex target-help
1073
Print (on the standard output) a description of target specific command
1074
line options for each tool.
1075
 
1076
@item --version
1077
@opindex version
1078
Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC@.
1079
 
1080
@include @value{srcdir}/../libiberty/at-file.texi
1081
@end table
1082
 
1083
@node Invoking G++
1084
@section Compiling C++ Programs
1085
 
1086
@cindex suffixes for C++ source
1087
@cindex C++ source file suffixes
1088
C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
1089
@samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
1090
@samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh} or @samp{.H}; and
1091
preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}.  GCC recognizes
1092
files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
1093
call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
1094
with the name @command{gcc}).
1095
 
1096
@findex g++
1097
@findex c++
1098
However, the use of @command{gcc} does not add the C++ library.
1099
@command{g++} is a program that calls GCC and treats @samp{.c},
1100
@samp{.h} and @samp{.i} files as C++ source files instead of C source
1101
files unless @option{-x} is used, and automatically specifies linking
1102
against the C++ library.  This program is also useful when
1103
precompiling a C header file with a @samp{.h} extension for use in C++
1104
compilations.  On many systems, @command{g++} is also installed with
1105
the name @command{c++}.
1106
 
1107
@cindex invoking @command{g++}
1108
When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1109
command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1110
language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1111
languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1112
@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
1113
explanations of options for languages related to C@.
1114
@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
1115
explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1116
 
1117
@node C Dialect Options
1118
@section Options Controlling C Dialect
1119
@cindex dialect options
1120
@cindex language dialect options
1121
@cindex options, dialect
1122
 
1123
The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1124
from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1125
accepts:
1126
 
1127
@table @gcctabopt
1128
@cindex ANSI support
1129
@cindex ISO support
1130
@item -ansi
1131
@opindex ansi
1132
In C mode, support all ISO C90 programs.  In C++ mode,
1133
remove GNU extensions that conflict with ISO C++.
1134
 
1135
This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1136
C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1137
such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1138
predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1139
type of system you are using.  It also enables the undesirable and
1140
rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler,
1141
it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1142
the @code{inline} keyword.
1143
 
1144
The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1145
@code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1146
@option{-ansi}.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1147
course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1148
in compilations done with @option{-ansi}.  Alternate predefined macros
1149
such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1150
without @option{-ansi}.
1151
 
1152
The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1153
rejected gratuitously.  For that, @option{-pedantic} is required in
1154
addition to @option{-ansi}.  @xref{Warning Options}.
1155
 
1156
The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1157
option is used.  Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1158
from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1159
ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1160
programs that might use these names for other things.
1161
 
1162
Functions which would normally be built in but do not have semantics
1163
defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1164
functions with @option{-ansi} is used.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1165
built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1166
affected.
1167
 
1168
@item -std=
1169
@opindex std
1170
Determine the language standard.  This option is currently only
1171
supported when compiling C or C++.  A value for this option must be
1172
provided; possible values are
1173
 
1174
@table @samp
1175
@item c89
1176
@itemx iso9899:1990
1177
ISO C90 (same as @option{-ansi}).
1178
 
1179
@item iso9899:199409
1180
ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1181
 
1182
@item c99
1183
@itemx c9x
1184
@itemx iso9899:1999
1185
@itemx iso9899:199x
1186
ISO C99.  Note that this standard is not yet fully supported; see
1187
@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-4.2/c99status.html}} for more information.  The
1188
names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1189
 
1190
@item gnu89
1191
Default, ISO C90 plus GNU extensions (including some C99 features).
1192
 
1193
@item gnu99
1194
@itemx gnu9x
1195
ISO C99 plus GNU extensions.  When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC,
1196
this will become the default.  The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1197
 
1198
@item c++98
1199
The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.
1200
 
1201
@item gnu++98
1202
The same as @option{-std=c++98} plus GNU extensions.  This is the
1203
default for C++ code.
1204
@end table
1205
 
1206
Even when this option is not specified, you can still use some of the
1207
features of newer standards in so far as they do not conflict with
1208
previous C standards.  For example, you may use @code{__restrict__} even
1209
when @option{-std=c99} is not specified.
1210
 
1211
The @option{-std} options specifying some version of ISO C have the same
1212
effects as @option{-ansi}, except that features that were not in ISO C90
1213
but are in the specified version (for example, @samp{//} comments and
1214
the @code{inline} keyword in ISO C99) are not disabled.
1215
 
1216
@xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1217
these standard versions.
1218
 
1219
@item -fgnu89-inline
1220
@opindex fgnu89-inline
1221
The option @option{-fgnu89-inline} tells GCC to use the traditional
1222
GNU semantics for @code{inline} functions when in C99 mode.
1223
@xref{Inline,,An Inline Function is As Fast As a Macro}.  Using this
1224
option is roughly equivalent to adding the @code{gnu_inline} function
1225
attribute to all inline functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}).
1226
 
1227
This option is accepted by GCC versions 4.1.3 and up.  In GCC versions
1228
prior to 4.3, C99 inline semantics are not supported, and thus this
1229
option is effectively assumed to be present regardless of whether or not
1230
it is specified; the only effect of specifying it explicitly is to
1231
disable warnings about using inline functions in C99 mode.  Likewise,
1232
the option @option{-fno-gnu89-inline} is not supported in versions of
1233
GCC before 4.3.  It will be supported only in C99 or gnu99 mode, not in
1234
C89 or gnu89 mode.
1235
 
1236
The preprocesor macros @code{__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__} and
1237
@code{__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__} may be used to check which semantics are
1238
in effect for @code{inline} functions.  @xref{Common Predefined
1239
Macros,,,cpp,The C Preprocessor}.
1240
 
1241
@item -aux-info @var{filename}
1242
@opindex aux-info
1243
Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1244
declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1245
files.  This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1246
 
1247
Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1248
each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1249
implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1250
@samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1251
number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1252
definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1253
character).  In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1254
arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1255
comments, after the declaration.
1256
 
1257
@item -fno-asm
1258
@opindex fno-asm
1259
Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1260
keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers.  You can use
1261
the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1262
instead.  @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1263
 
1264
In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1265
@code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords.  You may want to
1266
use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1267
effect.  In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1268
switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1269
@code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1270
 
1271
@item -fno-builtin
1272
@itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1273
@opindex fno-builtin
1274
@cindex built-in functions
1275
Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1276
@samp{__builtin_} as prefix.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1277
functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1278
including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1279
@option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1280
do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1281
 
1282
GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1283
more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1284
instructions that adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1285
may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller
1286
and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1287
cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1288
of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,
1289
when a function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use
1290
information about that function to warn about problems with calls to
1291
that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the
1292
resulting code still contains calls to that function.  For example,
1293
warnings are given with @option{-Wformat} for bad calls to
1294
@code{printf}, when @code{printf} is built in, and @code{strlen} is
1295
known not to modify global memory.
1296
 
1297
With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1298
only the built-in function @var{function} is
1299
disabled.  @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}.  If a
1300
function is named this is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1301
option is ignored.  There is no corresponding
1302
@option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1303
built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1304
@option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1305
 
1306
@smallexample
1307
#define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
1308
#define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1309
@end smallexample
1310
 
1311
@item -fhosted
1312
@opindex fhosted
1313
@cindex hosted environment
1314
 
1315
Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted environment.  This implies
1316
@option{-fbuiltin}.  A hosted environment is one in which the
1317
entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1318
type of @code{int}.  Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1319
This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1320
 
1321
@item -ffreestanding
1322
@opindex ffreestanding
1323
@cindex hosted environment
1324
 
1325
Assert that compilation takes place in a freestanding environment.  This
1326
implies @option{-fno-builtin}.  A freestanding environment
1327
is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1328
not necessarily be at @code{main}.  The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1329
This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1330
 
1331
@xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1332
freestanding and hosted environments.
1333
 
1334
@item -fopenmp
1335
@opindex fopenmp
1336
@cindex openmp parallel
1337
Enable handling of OpenMP directives @code{#pragma omp} in C/C++ and
1338
@code{!$omp} in Fortran.  When @option{-fopenmp} is specified, the
1339
compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application
1340
Program Interface v2.5 @w{@uref{http://www.openmp.org/}}.
1341
 
1342
@item -fms-extensions
1343
@opindex fms-extensions
1344
Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1345
 
1346
Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1347
accepted with this option.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed struct/union
1348
fields within structs/unions}, for details.
1349
 
1350
@item -trigraphs
1351
@opindex trigraphs
1352
Support ISO C trigraphs.  The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1353
options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1354
 
1355
@item -no-integrated-cpp
1356
@opindex no-integrated-cpp
1357
Performs a compilation in two passes: preprocessing and compiling.  This
1358
option allows a user supplied "cc1", "cc1plus", or "cc1obj" via the
1359
@option{-B} option.  The user supplied compilation step can then add in
1360
an additional preprocessing step after normal preprocessing but before
1361
compiling.  The default is to use the integrated cpp (internal cpp)
1362
 
1363
The semantics of this option will change if "cc1", "cc1plus", and
1364
"cc1obj" are merged.
1365
 
1366
@cindex traditional C language
1367
@cindex C language, traditional
1368
@item -traditional
1369
@itemx -traditional-cpp
1370
@opindex traditional-cpp
1371
@opindex traditional
1372
Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1373
C compiler.  They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1374
The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode.  See the GNU
1375
CPP manual for details.
1376
 
1377
@item -fcond-mismatch
1378
@opindex fcond-mismatch
1379
Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1380
third arguments.  The value of such an expression is void.  This option
1381
is not supported for C++.
1382
 
1383
@item -funsigned-char
1384
@opindex funsigned-char
1385
Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1386
 
1387
Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1388
be.  It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1389
@code{signed char} by default.
1390
 
1391
Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1392
@code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1393
But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1394
expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1395
machines they were written for.  This option, and its inverse, let you
1396
make such a program work with the opposite default.
1397
 
1398
The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1399
@code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1400
is always just like one of those two.
1401
 
1402
@item -fsigned-char
1403
@opindex fsigned-char
1404
Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1405
 
1406
Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1407
the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}.  Likewise, the option
1408
@option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1409
 
1410
@item -fsigned-bitfields
1411
@itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1412
@itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1413
@itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1414
@opindex fsigned-bitfields
1415
@opindex funsigned-bitfields
1416
@opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1417
@opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1418
These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1419
declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}.  By
1420
default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1421
basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1422
@end table
1423
 
1424
@node C++ Dialect Options
1425
@section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1426
 
1427
@cindex compiler options, C++
1428
@cindex C++ options, command line
1429
@cindex options, C++
1430
This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1431
for C++ programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler options
1432
regardless of what language your program is in.  For example, you
1433
might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
1434
 
1435
@smallexample
1436
g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
1437
@end smallexample
1438
 
1439
@noindent
1440
In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
1441
only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
1442
language supported by GCC@.
1443
 
1444
Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
1445
 
1446
@table @gcctabopt
1447
 
1448
@item -fabi-version=@var{n}
1449
@opindex fabi-version
1450
Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI@.  Version 2 is the version of the
1451
C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.  Version 1 is the version of
1452
the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.  Version 0 will always be
1453
the version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.
1454
Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0 will change as ABI bugs
1455
are fixed.
1456
 
1457
The default is version 2.
1458
 
1459
@item -fno-access-control
1460
@opindex fno-access-control
1461
Turn off all access checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working
1462
around bugs in the access control code.
1463
 
1464
@item -fcheck-new
1465
@opindex fcheck-new
1466
Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
1467
before attempting to modify the storage allocated.  This check is
1468
normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
1469
@code{operator new} will only return @code{0} if it is declared
1470
@samp{throw()}, in which case the compiler will always check the
1471
return value even without this option.  In all other cases, when
1472
@code{operator new} has a non-empty exception specification, memory
1473
exhaustion is signalled by throwing @code{std::bad_alloc}.  See also
1474
@samp{new (nothrow)}.
1475
 
1476
@item -fconserve-space
1477
@opindex fconserve-space
1478
Put uninitialized or runtime-initialized global variables into the
1479
common segment, as C does.  This saves space in the executable at the
1480
cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions.  If you compile with this
1481
flag and your program mysteriously crashes after @code{main()} has
1482
completed, you may have an object that is being destroyed twice because
1483
two definitions were merged.
1484
 
1485
This option is no longer useful on most targets, now that support has
1486
been added for putting variables into BSS without making them common.
1487
 
1488
@item -ffriend-injection
1489
@opindex ffriend-injection
1490
Inject friend functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are
1491
visible outside the scope of the class in which they are declared.
1492
Friend functions were documented to work this way in the old Annotated
1493
C++ Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked
1494
that way.  However, in ISO C++ a friend function which is not declared
1495
in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument dependent
1496
lookup.  This option causes friends to be injected as they were in
1497
earlier releases.
1498
 
1499
This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future
1500
release of G++.
1501
 
1502
@item -fno-elide-constructors
1503
@opindex fno-elide-constructors
1504
The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
1505
which is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
1506
Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
1507
call the copy constructor in all cases.
1508
 
1509
@item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
1510
@opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
1511
Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications
1512
at runtime.  This option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful
1513
for reducing code size in production builds, much like defining
1514
@samp{NDEBUG}.  This does not give user code permission to throw
1515
exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the compiler
1516
will still optimize based on the specifications, so throwing an
1517
unexpected exception will result in undefined behavior.
1518
 
1519
@item -ffor-scope
1520
@itemx -fno-for-scope
1521
@opindex ffor-scope
1522
@opindex fno-for-scope
1523
If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
1524
a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
1525
as specified by the C++ standard.
1526
If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
1527
a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
1528
as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
1529
implementations of C++.
1530
 
1531
The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard,
1532
but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
1533
otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
1534
 
1535
@item -fno-gnu-keywords
1536
@opindex fno-gnu-keywords
1537
Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
1538
word as an identifier.  You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
1539
@option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
1540
 
1541
@item -fno-implicit-templates
1542
@opindex fno-implicit-templates
1543
Never emit code for non-inline templates which are instantiated
1544
implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
1545
@xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
1546
 
1547
@item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
1548
@opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
1549
Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
1550
The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
1551
without optimization will need the same set of explicit instantiations.
1552
 
1553
@item -fno-implement-inlines
1554
@opindex fno-implement-inlines
1555
To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
1556
controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}.  This will cause linker
1557
errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
1558
 
1559
@item -fms-extensions
1560
@opindex fms-extensions
1561
Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
1562
int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
1563
 
1564
@item -fno-nonansi-builtins
1565
@opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
1566
Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
1567
ANSI/ISO C@.  These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
1568
@code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
1569
 
1570
@item -fno-operator-names
1571
@opindex fno-operator-names
1572
Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
1573
@code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
1574
synonyms as keywords.
1575
 
1576
@item -fno-optional-diags
1577
@opindex fno-optional-diags
1578
Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
1579
issue.  Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
1580
a name having multiple meanings within a class.
1581
 
1582
@item -fpermissive
1583
@opindex fpermissive
1584
Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
1585
warnings.  Thus, using @option{-fpermissive} will allow some
1586
nonconforming code to compile.
1587
 
1588
@item -frepo
1589
@opindex frepo
1590
Enable automatic template instantiation at link time.  This option also
1591
implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}.  @xref{Template
1592
Instantiation}, for more information.
1593
 
1594
@item -fno-rtti
1595
@opindex fno-rtti
1596
Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
1597
functions for use by the C++ runtime type identification features
1598
(@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}).  If you don't use those parts
1599
of the language, you can save some space by using this flag.  Note that
1600
exception handling uses the same information, but it will generate it as
1601
needed. The @samp{dynamic_cast} operator can still be used for casts that
1602
do not require runtime type information, i.e. casts to @code{void *} or to
1603
unambiguous base classes.
1604
 
1605
@item -fstats
1606
@opindex fstats
1607
Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
1608
This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
1609
 
1610
@item -ftemplate-depth-@var{n}
1611
@opindex ftemplate-depth
1612
Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
1613
A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
1614
endless recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
1615
conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17.
1616
 
1617
@item -fno-threadsafe-statics
1618
@opindex fno-threadsafe-statics
1619
Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
1620
ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics.  You can use this
1621
option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need to be
1622
thread-safe.
1623
 
1624
@item -fuse-cxa-atexit
1625
@opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
1626
Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
1627
@code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
1628
This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
1629
destructors, but will only work if your C library supports
1630
@code{__cxa_atexit}.
1631
 
1632
@item -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
1633
@opindex fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
1634
Don't use the @code{__cxa_get_exception_ptr} runtime routine.  This
1635
will cause @code{std::uncaught_exception} to be incorrect, but is necessary
1636
if the runtime routine is not available.
1637
 
1638
@item -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
1639
@opindex fvisibility-inlines-hidden
1640
This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
1641
pointers to inline methods where the addresses of the two functions
1642
were taken in different shared objects.
1643
 
1644
The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with
1645
@code{__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))} so that they do not
1646
appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT indirection
1647
when used within the DSO@.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect
1648
on load and link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the
1649
dynamic export table when the library makes heavy use of templates.
1650
 
1651
The behaviour of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
1652
methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static variables
1653
local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce that
1654
the function is defined in only one shared object.
1655
 
1656
You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the
1657
effect of the switch for that method.  For example, if you do want to
1658
compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might mark it as
1659
having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit
1660
visibility will have no effect.
1661
 
1662
Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option
1663
as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library boundary.
1664
@xref{Template Instantiation}.
1665
 
1666
@item -fno-weak
1667
@opindex fno-weak
1668
Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
1669
By default, G++ will use weak symbols if they are available.  This
1670
option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
1671
it will result in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option may
1672
be removed in a future release of G++.
1673
 
1674
@item -nostdinc++
1675
@opindex nostdinc++
1676
Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
1677
C++, but do still search the other standard directories.  (This option
1678
is used when building the C++ library.)
1679
@end table
1680
 
1681
In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
1682
have meanings only for C++ programs:
1683
 
1684
@table @gcctabopt
1685
@item -fno-default-inline
1686
@opindex fno-default-inline
1687
Do not assume @samp{inline} for functions defined inside a class scope.
1688
@xref{Optimize Options,,Options That Control Optimization}.  Note that these
1689
functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't be
1690
inlined by default.
1691
 
1692
@item -Wabi @r{(C++ only)}
1693
@opindex Wabi
1694
Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
1695
vendor-neutral C++ ABI@.  Although an effort has been made to warn about
1696
all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
1697
even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may also be
1698
cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
1699
will be compatible.
1700
 
1701
You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
1702
concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
1703
compatible with code generated by other compilers.
1704
 
1705
The known incompatibilities at this point include:
1706
 
1707
@itemize @bullet
1708
 
1709
@item
1710
Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to
1711
pack data into the same byte as a base class.  For example:
1712
 
1713
@smallexample
1714
struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
1715
struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
1716
@end smallexample
1717
 
1718
@noindent
1719
In this case, G++ will place @code{B::f2} into the same byte
1720
as@code{A::f1}; other compilers will not.  You can avoid this problem
1721
by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
1722
byte size on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to
1723
layout @code{B} identically.
1724
 
1725
@item
1726
Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use
1727
tail padding when laying out virtual bases.  For example:
1728
 
1729
@smallexample
1730
struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
1731
struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
1732
struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
1733
@end smallexample
1734
 
1735
@noindent
1736
In this case, G++ will not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
1737
@code{A}; other compilers will.  You can avoid this problem by
1738
explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
1739
alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that will cause G++ and other
1740
compilers to layout @code{C} identically.
1741
 
1742
@item
1743
Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
1744
of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For
1745
example:
1746
 
1747
@smallexample
1748
union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
1749
@end smallexample
1750
 
1751
@noindent
1752
Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the
1753
union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
1754
 
1755
@item
1756
Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:
1757
 
1758
@smallexample
1759
struct A @{@};
1760
 
1761
struct B @{
1762
  A a;
1763
  virtual void f ();
1764
@};
1765
 
1766
struct C : public B, public A @{@};
1767
@end smallexample
1768
 
1769
@noindent
1770
G++ will place the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
1771
it should be placed at offset zero.  G++ mistakenly believes that the
1772
@code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
1773
 
1774
@item
1775
Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
1776
template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
1777
 
1778
@smallexample
1779
template <typename Q>
1780
void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
1781
 
1782
template <template <typename> class Q>
1783
void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
1784
@end smallexample
1785
 
1786
@noindent
1787
Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
1788
 
1789
@end itemize
1790
 
1791
@item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ only)}
1792
@opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
1793
Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
1794
destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends nor
1795
public static member functions.
1796
 
1797
@item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ only)}
1798
@opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
1799
Warn when a class appears to be polymorphic, thereby requiring a virtual
1800
destructor, yet it declares a non-virtual one.  This warning is also
1801
enabled if -Weffc++ is specified.
1802
 
1803
@item -Wreorder @r{(C++ only)}
1804
@opindex Wreorder
1805
@cindex reordering, warning
1806
@cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
1807
Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
1808
match the order in which they must be executed.  For instance:
1809
 
1810
@smallexample
1811
struct A @{
1812
  int i;
1813
  int j;
1814
  A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
1815
@};
1816
@end smallexample
1817
 
1818
The compiler will rearrange the member initializers for @samp{i}
1819
and @samp{j} to match the declaration order of the members, emitting
1820
a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
1821
@end table
1822
 
1823
The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
1824
 
1825
@table @gcctabopt
1826
@item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ only)}
1827
@opindex Weffc++
1828
Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
1829
@cite{Effective C++} book:
1830
 
1831
@itemize @bullet
1832
@item
1833
Item 11:  Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
1834
with dynamically allocated memory.
1835
 
1836
@item
1837
Item 12:  Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
1838
 
1839
@item
1840
Item 14:  Make destructors virtual in base classes.
1841
 
1842
@item
1843
Item 15:  Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
1844
 
1845
@item
1846
Item 23:  Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
1847
 
1848
@end itemize
1849
 
1850
Also warn about violations of the following style guidelines from
1851
Scott Meyers' @cite{More Effective C++} book:
1852
 
1853
@itemize @bullet
1854
@item
1855
Item 6:  Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
1856
decrement operators.
1857
 
1858
@item
1859
Item 7:  Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
1860
 
1861
@end itemize
1862
 
1863
When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
1864
headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use @samp{grep -v}
1865
to filter out those warnings.
1866
 
1867
@item -Wno-deprecated @r{(C++ only)}
1868
@opindex Wno-deprecated
1869
Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.  @xref{Deprecated Features}.
1870
 
1871
@item -Wstrict-null-sentinel @r{(C++ only)}
1872
@opindex Wstrict-null-sentinel
1873
Warn also about the use of an uncasted @code{NULL} as sentinel.  When
1874
compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as @code{NULL} is defined
1875
to @code{__null}.  Although it is a null pointer constant not a null pointer,
1876
it is guaranteed to of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is
1877
not portable across different compilers.
1878
 
1879
@item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ only)}
1880
@opindex Wno-non-template-friend
1881
Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
1882
within a template.  Since the advent of explicit template specification
1883
support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
1884
@samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
1885
friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function.  (Section
1886
14.5.3).  Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
1887
could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
1888
function.  Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
1889
behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
1890
check existing code for potential trouble spots and is on by default.
1891
This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
1892
@option{-Wno-non-template-friend} which keeps the conformant compiler code
1893
but disables the helpful warning.
1894
 
1895
@item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ only)}
1896
@opindex Wold-style-cast
1897
Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
1898
a C++ program.  The new-style casts (@samp{dynamic_cast},
1899
@samp{static_cast}, @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are
1900
less vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
1901
 
1902
@item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ only)}
1903
@opindex Woverloaded-virtual
1904
@cindex overloaded virtual fn, warning
1905
@cindex warning for overloaded virtual fn
1906
Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
1907
base class.  For example, in:
1908
 
1909
@smallexample
1910
struct A @{
1911
  virtual void f();
1912
@};
1913
 
1914
struct B: public A @{
1915
  void f(int);
1916
@};
1917
@end smallexample
1918
 
1919
the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
1920
like:
1921
 
1922
@smallexample
1923
B* b;
1924
b->f();
1925
@end smallexample
1926
 
1927
will fail to compile.
1928
 
1929
@item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ only)}
1930
@opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
1931
Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
1932
to a plain pointer.
1933
 
1934
@item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ only)}
1935
@opindex Wsign-promo
1936
Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
1937
enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned type of
1938
the same size.  Previous versions of G++ would try to preserve
1939
unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
1940
 
1941
@smallexample
1942
struct A @{
1943
  operator int ();
1944
  A& operator = (int);
1945
@};
1946
 
1947
main ()
1948
@{
1949
  A a,b;
1950
  a = b;
1951
@}
1952
@end smallexample
1953
 
1954
In this example, G++ will synthesize a default @samp{A& operator =
1955
(const A&);}, while cfront will use the user-defined @samp{operator =}.
1956
@end table
1957
 
1958
@node Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options
1959
@section Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
1960
 
1961
@cindex compiler options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
1962
@cindex Objective-C and Objective-C++ options, command line
1963
@cindex options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
1964
(NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
1965
languages themselves.  See @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
1966
Supported by GCC}, for references.)
1967
 
1968
This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1969
for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs, but you can also use most of
1970
the language-independent GNU compiler options.
1971
For example, you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
1972
 
1973
@smallexample
1974
gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
1975
@end smallexample
1976
 
1977
@noindent
1978
In this example, @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
1979
Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with
1980
any language supported by GCC@.
1981
 
1982
Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language, Objective-C
1983
compilations may also use options specific to the C front-end (e.g.,
1984
@option{-Wtraditional}).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
1985
C++-specific options (e.g., @option{-Wabi}).
1986
 
1987
Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
1988
and Objective-C++ programs:
1989
 
1990
@table @gcctabopt
1991
@item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
1992
@opindex fconstant-string-class
1993
Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
1994
literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}.  The default
1995
class name is @code{NXConstantString} if the GNU runtime is being used, and
1996
@code{NSConstantString} if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The
1997
@option{-fconstant-cfstrings} option, if also present, will override the
1998
@option{-fconstant-string-class} setting and cause @code{@@"@dots{}"} literals
1999
to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2000
 
2001
@item -fgnu-runtime
2002
@opindex fgnu-runtime
2003
Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2004
runtime.  This is the default for most types of systems.
2005
 
2006
@item -fnext-runtime
2007
@opindex fnext-runtime
2008
Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.  This is the default
2009
for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@.  The macro
2010
@code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
2011
used.
2012
 
2013
@item -fno-nil-receivers
2014
@opindex fno-nil-receivers
2015
Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches (e.g.,
2016
@code{[receiver message:arg]}) in this translation unit ensure that the receiver
2017
is not @code{nil}.  This allows for more efficient entry points in the runtime
2018
to be used.  Currently, this option is only available in conjunction with
2019
the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3 and later.
2020
 
2021
@item -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2022
@opindex fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2023
For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a
2024
C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor.  If so, synthesize a
2025
special @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} instance method that will run
2026
non-trivial default constructors on any such instance variables, in order,
2027
and then return @code{self}.  Similarly, check if any instance variable
2028
is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and if so, synthesize a
2029
special @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} method that will run
2030
all such default destructors, in reverse order.
2031
 
2032
The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and/or @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods
2033
thusly generated will only operate on instance variables declared in the
2034
current Objective-C class, and not those inherited from superclasses.  It
2035
is the responsibility of the Objective-C runtime to invoke all such methods
2036
in an object's inheritance hierarchy.  The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} methods
2037
will be invoked by the runtime immediately after a new object
2038
instance is allocated; the @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods will
2039
be invoked immediately before the runtime deallocates an object instance.
2040
 
2041
As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has
2042
support for invoking the @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and
2043
@code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods.
2044
 
2045
@item -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2046
@opindex fobjc-direct-dispatch
2047
Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is
2048
accomplished via the comm page.
2049
 
2050
@item -fobjc-exceptions
2051
@opindex fobjc-exceptions
2052
Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in Objective-C,
2053
similar to what is offered by C++ and Java.  This option is
2054
unavailable in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and
2055
earlier.
2056
 
2057
@smallexample
2058
  @@try @{
2059
    @dots{}
2060
       @@throw expr;
2061
    @dots{}
2062
  @}
2063
  @@catch (AnObjCClass *exc) @{
2064
    @dots{}
2065
      @@throw expr;
2066
    @dots{}
2067
      @@throw;
2068
    @dots{}
2069
  @}
2070
  @@catch (AnotherClass *exc) @{
2071
    @dots{}
2072
  @}
2073
  @@catch (id allOthers) @{
2074
    @dots{}
2075
  @}
2076
  @@finally @{
2077
    @dots{}
2078
      @@throw expr;
2079
    @dots{}
2080
  @}
2081
@end smallexample
2082
 
2083
The @code{@@throw} statement may appear anywhere in an Objective-C or
2084
Objective-C++ program; when used inside of a @code{@@catch} block, the
2085
@code{@@throw} may appear without an argument (as shown above), in which case
2086
the object caught by the @code{@@catch} will be rethrown.
2087
 
2088
Note that only (pointers to) Objective-C objects may be thrown and
2089
caught using this scheme.  When an object is thrown, it will be caught
2090
by the nearest @code{@@catch} clause capable of handling objects of that type,
2091
analogously to how @code{catch} blocks work in C++ and Java.  A
2092
@code{@@catch(id @dots{})} clause (as shown above) may also be provided to catch
2093
any and all Objective-C exceptions not caught by previous @code{@@catch}
2094
clauses (if any).
2095
 
2096
The @code{@@finally} clause, if present, will be executed upon exit from the
2097
immediately preceding @code{@@try @dots{} @@catch} section.  This will happen
2098
regardless of whether any exceptions are thrown, caught or rethrown
2099
inside the @code{@@try @dots{} @@catch} section, analogously to the behavior
2100
of the @code{finally} clause in Java.
2101
 
2102
There are several caveats to using the new exception mechanism:
2103
 
2104
@itemize @bullet
2105
@item
2106
Although currently designed to be binary compatible with @code{NS_HANDLER}-style
2107
idioms provided by the @code{NSException} class, the new
2108
exceptions can only be used on Mac OS X 10.3 (Panther) and later
2109
systems, due to additional functionality needed in the (NeXT) Objective-C
2110
runtime.
2111
 
2112
@item
2113
As mentioned above, the new exceptions do not support handling
2114
types other than Objective-C objects.   Furthermore, when used from
2115
Objective-C++, the Objective-C exception model does not interoperate with C++
2116
exceptions at this time.  This means you cannot @code{@@throw} an exception
2117
from Objective-C and @code{catch} it in C++, or vice versa
2118
(i.e., @code{throw @dots{} @@catch}).
2119
@end itemize
2120
 
2121
The @option{-fobjc-exceptions} switch also enables the use of synchronization
2122
blocks for thread-safe execution:
2123
 
2124
@smallexample
2125
  @@synchronized (ObjCClass *guard) @{
2126
    @dots{}
2127
  @}
2128
@end smallexample
2129
 
2130
Upon entering the @code{@@synchronized} block, a thread of execution shall
2131
first check whether a lock has been placed on the corresponding @code{guard}
2132
object by another thread.  If it has, the current thread shall wait until
2133
the other thread relinquishes its lock.  Once @code{guard} becomes available,
2134
the current thread will place its own lock on it, execute the code contained in
2135
the @code{@@synchronized} block, and finally relinquish the lock (thereby
2136
making @code{guard} available to other threads).
2137
 
2138
Unlike Java, Objective-C does not allow for entire methods to be marked
2139
@code{@@synchronized}.  Note that throwing exceptions out of
2140
@code{@@synchronized} blocks is allowed, and will cause the guarding object
2141
to be unlocked properly.
2142
 
2143
@item -fobjc-gc
2144
@opindex fobjc-gc
2145
Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs.
2146
 
2147
@item -freplace-objc-classes
2148
@opindex freplace-objc-classes
2149
Emit a special marker instructing @command{ld(1)} not to statically link in
2150
the resulting object file, and allow @command{dyld(1)} to load it in at
2151
run time instead.  This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-Continue
2152
debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and
2153
dynamically reloaded in the course of program execution, without the need
2154
to restart the program itself.  Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality
2155
is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
2156
and later.
2157
 
2158
@item -fzero-link
2159
@opindex fzero-link
2160
When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls
2161
to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")} (when the name of the class is known at
2162
compile time) with static class references that get initialized at load time,
2163
which improves run-time performance.  Specifying the @option{-fzero-link} flag
2164
suppresses this behavior and causes calls to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")}
2165
to be retained.  This is useful in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows
2166
for individual class implementations to be modified during program execution.
2167
 
2168
@item -gen-decls
2169
@opindex gen-decls
2170
Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
2171
file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
2172
 
2173
@item -Wassign-intercept
2174
@opindex Wassign-intercept
2175
Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2176
garbage collector.
2177
 
2178
@item -Wno-protocol
2179
@opindex Wno-protocol
2180
If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
2181
every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class.  The
2182
default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
2183
implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
2184
from the superclass.  If you use the @option{-Wno-protocol} option, then
2185
methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
2186
and no warning is issued for them.
2187
 
2188
@item -Wselector
2189
@opindex Wselector
2190
Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
2191
found during compilation.  The check is performed on the list of methods
2192
in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally, a check is performed
2193
for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
2194
expression, and a corresponding method for that selector has been found
2195
during compilation.  Because these checks scan the method table only at
2196
the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
2197
stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
2198
found during compilation, or because the @option{-fsyntax-only} option is
2199
being used.
2200
 
2201
@item -Wstrict-selector-match
2202
@opindex Wstrict-selector-match
2203
Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are
2204
found for a given selector when attempting to send a message using this
2205
selector to a receiver of type @code{id} or @code{Class}.  When this flag
2206
is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler will omit such warnings
2207
if any differences found are confined to types which share the same size
2208
and alignment.
2209
 
2210
@item -Wundeclared-selector
2211
@opindex Wundeclared-selector
2212
Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
2213
undeclared selector is found.  A selector is considered undeclared if no
2214
method with that name has been declared before the
2215
@code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression, either explicitly in an
2216
@code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly in
2217
an @code{@@implementation} section.  This option always performs its
2218
checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found,
2219
while @option{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
2220
compilation.  This also enforces the coding style convention
2221
that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
2222
 
2223
@item -print-objc-runtime-info
2224
@opindex print-objc-runtime-info
2225
Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by
2226
value, if any.
2227
 
2228
@end table
2229
 
2230
@node Language Independent Options
2231
@section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
2232
@cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
2233
@cindex diagnostic messages
2234
@cindex message formatting
2235
 
2236
Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
2237
the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}).  The options described
2238
below can be used to control the diagnostic messages formatting
2239
algorithm, e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
2240
information should be reported.  Right now, only the C++ front end can
2241
honor these options.  However it is expected, in the near future, that
2242
the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.
2243
 
2244
@table @gcctabopt
2245
@item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
2246
@opindex fmessage-length
2247
Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
2248
characters.  The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
2249
the front ends supported by GCC@.  If @var{n} is zero, then no
2250
line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single
2251
line.
2252
 
2253
@opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
2254
@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
2255
Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages
2256
reporter to emit @emph{once} source location information; that is, in
2257
case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
2258
be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
2259
over and over, in subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default
2260
behavior.
2261
 
2262
@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
2263
Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic
2264
messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
2265
prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
2266
a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
2267
 
2268
@item -fdiagnostics-show-option
2269
@opindex fdiagnostics-show-option
2270
This option instructs the diagnostic machinery to add text to each
2271
diagnostic emitted, which indicates which command line option directly
2272
controls that diagnostic, when such an option is known to the
2273
diagnostic machinery.
2274
 
2275
@end table
2276
 
2277
@node Warning Options
2278
@section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
2279
@cindex options to control warnings
2280
@cindex warning messages
2281
@cindex messages, warning
2282
@cindex suppressing warnings
2283
 
2284
Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions which
2285
are not inherently erroneous but which are risky or suggest there
2286
may have been an error.
2287
 
2288
You can request many specific warnings with options beginning @samp{-W},
2289
for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on implicit
2290
declarations.  Each of these specific warning options also has a
2291
negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings;
2292
for example, @option{-Wno-implicit}.  This manual lists only one of the
2293
two forms, whichever is not the default.
2294
 
2295
The following options control the amount and kinds of warnings produced
2296
by GCC; for further, language-specific options also refer to
2297
@ref{C++ Dialect Options} and @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect
2298
Options}.
2299
 
2300
@table @gcctabopt
2301
@cindex syntax checking
2302
@item -fsyntax-only
2303
@opindex fsyntax-only
2304
Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
2305
 
2306
@item -pedantic
2307
@opindex pedantic
2308
Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
2309
reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
2310
programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For ISO C, follows the
2311
version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
2312
 
2313
Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
2314
this option (though a rare few will require @option{-ansi} or a
2315
@option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@.  However,
2316
without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
2317
features are supported as well.  With this option, they are rejected.
2318
 
2319
@option{-pedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
2320
alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}.  Pedantic
2321
warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
2322
@code{__extension__}.  However, only system header files should use
2323
these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
2324
@xref{Alternate Keywords}.
2325
 
2326
Some users try to use @option{-pedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
2327
C conformance.  They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
2328
it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
2329
ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
2330
diagnostics have been added.
2331
 
2332
A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
2333
some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
2334
be quite different from @option{-pedantic}.  We don't have plans to
2335
support such a feature in the near future.
2336
 
2337
Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
2338
extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu89} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
2339
corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
2340
extended dialect is based.  Warnings from @option{-pedantic} are given
2341
where they are required by the base standard.  (It would not make sense
2342
for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
2343
C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
2344
features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
2345
nothing to warn about.)
2346
 
2347
@item -pedantic-errors
2348
@opindex pedantic-errors
2349
Like @option{-pedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
2350
warnings.
2351
 
2352
@item -w
2353
@opindex w
2354
Inhibit all warning messages.
2355
 
2356
@item -Wno-import
2357
@opindex Wno-import
2358
Inhibit warning messages about the use of @samp{#import}.
2359
 
2360
@item -Wchar-subscripts
2361
@opindex Wchar-subscripts
2362
Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}.  This is a common cause
2363
of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
2364
machines.
2365
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2366
 
2367
@item -Wcomment
2368
@opindex Wcomment
2369
Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
2370
comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
2371
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2372
 
2373
@item -Wfatal-errors
2374
@opindex Wfatal-errors
2375
This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error
2376
occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing further error
2377
messages.
2378
 
2379
@item -Wformat
2380
@opindex Wformat
2381
@opindex ffreestanding
2382
@opindex fno-builtin
2383
Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
2384
the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
2385
specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
2386
sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
2387
attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
2388
@code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
2389
not in the C standard) families (or other target-specific families).
2390
Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
2391
specified depends on the standard version selected, and such checks of
2392
functions without the attribute specified are disabled by
2393
@option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-fno-builtin}.
2394
 
2395
The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
2396
libc version 2.2.  These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
2397
as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
2398
extensions.  Other library implementations may not support all these
2399
features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
2400
particular library's limitations.  However, if @option{-pedantic} is used
2401
with @option{-Wformat}, warnings will be given about format features not
2402
in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
2403
since those are not in any version of the C standard).  @xref{C Dialect
2404
Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
2405
 
2406
Since @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for
2407
several functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}.
2408
 
2409
@option{-Wformat} is included in @option{-Wall}.  For more control over some
2410
aspects of format checking, the options @option{-Wformat-y2k},
2411
@option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, @option{-Wno-format-zero-length},
2412
@option{-Wformat-nonliteral}, @option{-Wformat-security}, and
2413
@option{-Wformat=2} are available, but are not included in @option{-Wall}.
2414
 
2415
@item -Wformat-y2k
2416
@opindex Wformat-y2k
2417
If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about @code{strftime}
2418
formats which may yield only a two-digit year.
2419
 
2420
@item -Wno-format-extra-args
2421
@opindex Wno-format-extra-args
2422
If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
2423
@code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function.  The C standard specifies
2424
that such arguments are ignored.
2425
 
2426
Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
2427
specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
2428
warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
2429
type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments.  However,
2430
in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option will suppress the
2431
warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
2432
Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
2433
 
2434
@item -Wno-format-zero-length
2435
@opindex Wno-format-zero-length
2436
If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
2437
The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
2438
 
2439
@item -Wformat-nonliteral
2440
@opindex Wformat-nonliteral
2441
If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
2442
string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
2443
takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
2444
 
2445
@item -Wformat-security
2446
@opindex Wformat-security
2447
If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
2448
functions that represent possible security problems.  At present, this
2449
warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
2450
format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
2451
as in @code{printf (foo);}.  This may be a security hole if the format
2452
string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}.  (This is
2453
currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
2454
in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
2455
included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
2456
 
2457
@item -Wformat=2
2458
@opindex Wformat=2
2459
Enable @option{-Wformat} plus format checks not included in
2460
@option{-Wformat}.  Currently equivalent to @samp{-Wformat
2461
-Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k}.
2462
 
2463
@item -Wnonnull
2464
@opindex Wnonnull
2465
Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
2466
requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
2467
 
2468
@option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}.  It
2469
can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
2470
 
2471
@item -Winit-self @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2472
@opindex Winit-self
2473
Warn about uninitialized variables which are initialized with themselves.
2474
Note this option can only be used with the @option{-Wuninitialized} option,
2475
which in turn only works with @option{-O1} and above.
2476
 
2477
For example, GCC will warn about @code{i} being uninitialized in the
2478
following snippet only when @option{-Winit-self} has been specified:
2479
@smallexample
2480
@group
2481
int f()
2482
@{
2483
  int i = i;
2484
  return i;
2485
@}
2486
@end group
2487
@end smallexample
2488
 
2489
@item -Wimplicit-int
2490
@opindex Wimplicit-int
2491
Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
2492
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2493
 
2494
@item -Wimplicit-function-declaration
2495
@itemx -Werror-implicit-function-declaration
2496
@opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
2497
@opindex Werror-implicit-function-declaration
2498
Give a warning (or error) whenever a function is used before being
2499
declared.  The form @option{-Wno-error-implicit-function-declaration}
2500
is not supported.
2501
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} (as a warning, not an error).
2502
 
2503
@item -Wimplicit
2504
@opindex Wimplicit
2505
Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
2506
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2507
 
2508
@item -Wmain
2509
@opindex Wmain
2510
Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious.  @samp{main} should be a
2511
function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
2512
arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.
2513
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2514
 
2515
@item -Wmissing-braces
2516
@opindex Wmissing-braces
2517
Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.  In
2518
the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
2519
bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed.
2520
 
2521
@smallexample
2522
int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
2523
int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
2524
@end smallexample
2525
 
2526
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2527
 
2528
@item -Wmissing-include-dirs @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2529
@opindex Wmissing-include-dirs
2530
Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
2531
 
2532
@item -Wparentheses
2533
@opindex Wparentheses
2534
Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
2535
as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
2536
is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
2537
often get confused about.  Only the warning for an assignment used as
2538
a truth value is supported when compiling C++; the other warnings are
2539
only supported when compiling C@.
2540
 
2541
Also warn if a comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is
2542
equivalent to @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different
2543
interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
2544
 
2545
Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
2546
@code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs.  Here is an example of
2547
such a case:
2548
 
2549
@smallexample
2550
@group
2551
@{
2552
  if (a)
2553
    if (b)
2554
      foo ();
2555
  else
2556
    bar ();
2557
@}
2558
@end group
2559
@end smallexample
2560
 
2561
In C, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible @code{if}
2562
statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}.  This is often not
2563
what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above example by
2564
indentation the programmer chose.  When there is the potential for this
2565
confusion, GCC will issue a warning when this flag is specified.
2566
To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around the innermost
2567
@code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else} could belong to
2568
the enclosing @code{if}.  The resulting code would look like this:
2569
 
2570
@smallexample
2571
@group
2572
@{
2573
  if (a)
2574
    @{
2575
      if (b)
2576
        foo ();
2577
      else
2578
        bar ();
2579
    @}
2580
@}
2581
@end group
2582
@end smallexample
2583
 
2584
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2585
 
2586
@item -Wsequence-point
2587
@opindex Wsequence-point
2588
Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
2589
of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
2590
 
2591
The C and C++ standards defines the order in which expressions in a C/C++
2592
program are evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent
2593
a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those
2594
executed before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These
2595
occur after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part
2596
of a larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
2597
@code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
2598
function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
2599
expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
2600
Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
2601
evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All
2602
these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
2603
since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
2604
with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
2605
are called is not specified.  However, the standards committee have
2606
ruled that function calls do not overlap.
2607
 
2608
It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
2609
values of objects take effect.  Programs whose behavior depends on this
2610
have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that ``Between
2611
the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored
2612
value modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression.
2613
Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to determine the value
2614
to be stored.''.  If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
2615
particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
2616
 
2617
Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
2618
= b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}.  Some more complicated cases are not
2619
diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
2620
result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
2621
this sort of problem in programs.
2622
 
2623
The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
2624
over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
2625
Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
2626
definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
2627
@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/readings.html}}.
2628
 
2629
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} for C and C++.
2630
 
2631
@item -Wreturn-type
2632
@opindex Wreturn-type
2633
Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults to
2634
@code{int}.  Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
2635
return-value in a function whose return-type is not @code{void}.
2636
 
2637
For C, also warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier
2638
such as @code{const}.  Such a type qualifier has no effect, since the
2639
value returned by a function is not an lvalue.  ISO C prohibits
2640
qualified @code{void} return types on function definitions, so such
2641
return types always receive a warning even without this option.
2642
 
2643
For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
2644
message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified.  The only
2645
exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
2646
 
2647
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2648
 
2649
@item -Wswitch
2650
@opindex Wswitch
2651
Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
2652
and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
2653
enumeration.  (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
2654
warning.)  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
2655
provoke warnings when this option is used.
2656
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2657
 
2658
@item -Wswitch-default
2659
@opindex Wswitch-switch
2660
Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
2661
case.
2662
 
2663
@item -Wswitch-enum
2664
@opindex Wswitch-enum
2665
Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
2666
and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
2667
enumeration.  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
2668
provoke warnings when this option is used.
2669
 
2670
@item -Wtrigraphs
2671
@opindex Wtrigraphs
2672
Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
2673
the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
2674
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2675
 
2676
@item -Wunused-function
2677
@opindex Wunused-function
2678
Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
2679
non-inline static function is unused.
2680
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2681
 
2682
@item -Wunused-label
2683
@opindex Wunused-label
2684
Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
2685
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2686
 
2687
To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2688
(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2689
 
2690
@item -Wunused-parameter
2691
@opindex Wunused-parameter
2692
Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
2693
 
2694
To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2695
(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2696
 
2697
@item -Wunused-variable
2698
@opindex Wunused-variable
2699
Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
2700
aside from its declaration.
2701
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2702
 
2703
To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
2704
(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
2705
 
2706
@item -Wunused-value
2707
@opindex Wunused-value
2708
Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not used.
2709
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2710
 
2711
To suppress this warning cast the expression to @samp{void}.
2712
 
2713
@item -Wunused
2714
@opindex Wunused
2715
All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
2716
 
2717
In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
2718
either specify @samp{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @samp{-Wall} implies
2719
@samp{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
2720
 
2721
@item -Wuninitialized
2722
@opindex Wuninitialized
2723
Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized or
2724
if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call.
2725
 
2726
These warnings are possible only in optimizing compilation,
2727
because they require data flow information that is computed only
2728
when optimizing.  If you do not specify @option{-O}, you will not get
2729
these warnings. Instead, GCC will issue a warning about @option{-Wuninitialized}
2730
requiring @option{-O}.
2731
 
2732
If you want to warn about code which uses the uninitialized value of the
2733
variable in its own initializer, use the @option{-Winit-self} option.
2734
 
2735
These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
2736
elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
2737
variables which are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole.  They do
2738
not occur for variables or elements declared @code{volatile}.  Because
2739
these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or elements
2740
for which there are warnings will depend on the precise optimization
2741
options and version of GCC used.
2742
 
2743
Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
2744
to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
2745
computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
2746
are printed.
2747
 
2748
These warnings are made optional because GCC is not smart
2749
enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
2750
despite appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how
2751
this can happen:
2752
 
2753
@smallexample
2754
@group
2755
@{
2756
  int x;
2757
  switch (y)
2758
    @{
2759
    case 1: x = 1;
2760
      break;
2761
    case 2: x = 4;
2762
      break;
2763
    case 3: x = 5;
2764
    @}
2765
  foo (x);
2766
@}
2767
@end group
2768
@end smallexample
2769
 
2770
@noindent
2771
If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
2772
always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this.  Here is
2773
another common case:
2774
 
2775
@smallexample
2776
@{
2777
  int save_y;
2778
  if (change_y) save_y = y, y = new_y;
2779
  @dots{}
2780
  if (change_y) y = save_y;
2781
@}
2782
@end smallexample
2783
 
2784
@noindent
2785
This has no bug because @code{save_y} is used only if it is set.
2786
 
2787
@cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
2788
This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
2789
changed by a call to @code{longjmp}.  These warnings as well are possible
2790
only in optimizing compilation.
2791
 
2792
The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}.  It cannot know
2793
where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
2794
call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may get a warning
2795
even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
2796
in fact be called at the place which would cause a problem.
2797
 
2798
Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
2799
you use that never return as @code{noreturn}.  @xref{Function
2800
Attributes}.
2801
 
2802
This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2803
 
2804
@item -Wunknown-pragmas
2805
@opindex Wunknown-pragmas
2806
@cindex warning for unknown pragmas
2807
@cindex unknown pragmas, warning
2808
@cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
2809
Warn when a #pragma directive is encountered which is not understood by
2810
GCC@.  If this command line option is used, warnings will even be issued
2811
for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not the case if
2812
the warnings were only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command line option.
2813
 
2814
@item -Wno-pragmas
2815
@opindex Wno-pragmas
2816
@opindex Wpragmas
2817
Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
2818
invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas.  See also
2819
@samp{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
2820
 
2821
@item -Wstrict-aliasing
2822
@opindex Wstrict-aliasing
2823
This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
2824
It warns about code which might break the strict aliasing rules that the
2825
compiler is using for optimization.  The warning does not catch all
2826
cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls.  It is
2827
included in @option{-Wall}.
2828
 
2829
@item -Wstrict-aliasing=2
2830
@opindex Wstrict-aliasing=2
2831
This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
2832
It warns about code which might break the strict aliasing rules that the
2833
compiler is using for optimization.  This warning catches more cases than
2834
@option{-Wstrict-aliasing}, but it will also give a warning for some ambiguous
2835
cases that are safe.
2836
 
2837
@item -Wstrict-overflow
2838
@item -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n}
2839
@opindex Wstrict-overflow
2840
This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is active.
2841
It warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
2842
assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it does not
2843
warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only warns
2844
about cases where the compiler implements some optimization.  Thus
2845
this warning depends on the optimization level.
2846
 
2847
An optimization which assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
2848
perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such that
2849
overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
2850
easily give a false positive: a warning about code which is not
2851
actually a problem.  To help focus on important issues, several
2852
warning levels are defined.  No warnings are issued for the use of
2853
undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop
2854
will require, in particular when determining whether a loop will be
2855
executed at all.
2856
 
2857
@table @gcctabopt
2858
@item -Wstrict-overflow=1
2859
Warn about cases which are both questionable and easy to avoid.  For
2860
example: @code{x + 1 > x}; with @option{-fstrict-overflow}, the
2861
compiler will simplify this to @code{1}.  This level of
2862
@option{-Wstrict-overflow} is enabled by @option{-Wall}; higher levels
2863
are not, and must be explicitly requested.
2864
 
2865
@item -Wstrict-overflow=2
2866
Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a
2867
constant.  For example: @code{abs (x) >= 0}.  This can only be
2868
simplified when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is in effect, because
2869
@code{abs (INT_MIN)} overflows to @code{INT_MIN}, which is less than
2870
zero.  @option{-Wstrict-overflow} (with no level) is the same as
2871
@option{-Wstrict-overflow=2}.
2872
 
2873
@item -Wstrict-overflow=3
2874
Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For
2875
example: @code{x + 1 > 1} will be simplified to @code{x > 0}.
2876
 
2877
@item -Wstrict-overflow=4
2878
Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.
2879
For example: @code{(x * 10) / 5} will be simplified to @code{x * 2}.
2880
 
2881
@item -Wstrict-overflow=5
2882
Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude of a
2883
constant involved in a comparison.  For example: @code{x + 2 > y} will
2884
be simplified to @code{x + 1 >= y}.  This is reported only at the
2885
highest warning level because this simplification applies to many
2886
comparisons, so this warning level will give a very large number of
2887
false positives.
2888
@end table
2889
 
2890
@item -Wall
2891
@opindex Wall
2892
All of the above @samp{-W} options combined.  This enables all the
2893
warnings about constructions that some users consider questionable, and
2894
that are easy to avoid (or modify to prevent the warning), even in
2895
conjunction with macros.  This also enables some language-specific
2896
warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
2897
@ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
2898
@end table
2899
 
2900
The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not implied by @option{-Wall}.
2901
Some of them warn about constructions that users generally do not
2902
consider questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check
2903
for; others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid
2904
in some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
2905
the warning.
2906
 
2907
@table @gcctabopt
2908
@item -Wextra
2909
@opindex W
2910
@opindex Wextra
2911
(This option used to be called @option{-W}.  The older name is still
2912
supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)  Print extra warning
2913
messages for these events:
2914
 
2915
@itemize @bullet
2916
@item
2917
A function can return either with or without a value.  (Falling
2918
off the end of the function body is considered returning without
2919
a value.)  For example, this function would evoke such a
2920
warning:
2921
 
2922
@smallexample
2923
@group
2924
foo (a)
2925
@{
2926
  if (a > 0)
2927
    return a;
2928
@}
2929
@end group
2930
@end smallexample
2931
 
2932
@item
2933
An expression-statement or the left-hand side of a comma expression
2934
contains no side effects.
2935
To suppress the warning, cast the unused expression to void.
2936
For example, an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} will cause a warning,
2937
but @samp{x[(void)i,j]} will not.
2938
 
2939
@item
2940
An unsigned value is compared against zero with @samp{<} or @samp{>=}.
2941
 
2942
@item
2943
Storage-class specifiers like @code{static} are not the first things in
2944
a declaration.  According to the C Standard, this usage is obsolescent.
2945
 
2946
@item
2947
If @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wunused} is also specified, warn about unused
2948
arguments.
2949
 
2950
@item
2951
A comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce an
2952
incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
2953
(But don't warn if @option{-Wno-sign-compare} is also specified.)
2954
 
2955
@item
2956
An aggregate has an initializer which does not initialize all members.
2957
This warning can be independently controlled by
2958
@option{-Wmissing-field-initializers}.
2959
 
2960
@item
2961
An initialized field without side effects is overridden when using
2962
designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
2963
Initializers}).  This warning can be independently controlled by
2964
@option{-Woverride-init}.
2965
 
2966
@item
2967
A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
2968
functions:
2969
 
2970
@smallexample
2971
void foo(bar) @{ @}
2972
@end smallexample
2973
 
2974
@item
2975
An empty body occurs in an @samp{if} or @samp{else} statement.
2976
 
2977
@item
2978
A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
2979
@samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
2980
 
2981
@item
2982
A variable might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or @samp{vfork}.
2983
 
2984
@item @r{(C++ only)}
2985
An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a conditional expression.
2986
 
2987
@item @r{(C++ only)}
2988
A non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member appears in a
2989
class without constructors.
2990
 
2991
@item @r{(C++ only)}
2992
Ambiguous virtual bases.
2993
 
2994
@item @r{(C++ only)}
2995
Subscripting an array which has been declared @samp{register}.
2996
 
2997
@item @r{(C++ only)}
2998
Taking the address of a variable which has been declared @samp{register}.
2999
 
3000
@item @r{(C++ only)}
3001
A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy constructor.
3002
@end itemize
3003
 
3004
@item -Wno-div-by-zero
3005
@opindex Wno-div-by-zero
3006
@opindex Wdiv-by-zero
3007
Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero.  Floating point
3008
division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
3009
obtaining infinities and NaNs.
3010
 
3011
@item -Wsystem-headers
3012
@opindex Wsystem-headers
3013
@cindex warnings from system headers
3014
@cindex system headers, warnings from
3015
Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
3016
Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
3017
that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
3018
compiler output harder to read.  Using this command line option tells
3019
GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
3020
code.  However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
3021
option will @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
3022
headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
3023
 
3024
@item -Wfloat-equal
3025
@opindex Wfloat-equal
3026
Warn if floating point values are used in equality comparisons.
3027
 
3028
The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
3029
programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
3030
infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this, then you need
3031
to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
3032
likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
3033
when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
3034
different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
3035
would check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
3036
this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
3037
probably mistaken.
3038
 
3039
@item -Wtraditional @r{(C only)}
3040
@opindex Wtraditional
3041
Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
3042
ISO C@.  Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
3043
equivalent, and/or problematic constructs which should be avoided.
3044
 
3045
@itemize @bullet
3046
@item
3047
Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
3048
In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
3049
but does not in ISO C@.
3050
 
3051
@item
3052
In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
3053
Traditional preprocessors would only consider a line to be a directive
3054
if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line.  Therefore
3055
@option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
3056
understands but would ignore because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
3057
first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives like
3058
@samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them.  Some
3059
traditional implementations would not recognize @samp{#elif}, so it
3060
suggests avoiding it altogether.
3061
 
3062
@item
3063
A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
3064
 
3065
@item
3066
The unary plus operator.
3067
 
3068
@item
3069
The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating point
3070
constant suffixes.  (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
3071
constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
3072
headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
3073
Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
3074
warnings, however GCC's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
3075
avoid warning in these cases.
3076
 
3077
@item
3078
A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
3079
the block.
3080
 
3081
@item
3082
A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
3083
 
3084
@item
3085
A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
3086
This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
3087
 
3088
@item
3089
The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
3090
signedness from its traditional type.  This warning is only issued if
3091
the base of the constant is ten.  I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
3092
typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
3093
 
3094
@item
3095
Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
3096
 
3097
@item
3098
Initialization of automatic aggregates.
3099
 
3100
@item
3101
Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate
3102
namespace for labels.
3103
 
3104
@item
3105
Initialization of unions.  If the initializer is zero, the warning is
3106
omitted.  This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
3107
user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
3108
initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
3109
traditional C case.
3110
 
3111
@item
3112
Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating point values and vice
3113
versa.  The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
3114
C would cause serious problems.  This is a subset of the possible
3115
conversion warnings, for the full set use @option{-Wconversion}.
3116
 
3117
@item
3118
Use of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is
3119
@emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
3120
because these ISO C features will appear in your code when using
3121
libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
3122
@code{VPARAMS}.  This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
3123
because that feature is already a GCC extension and thus not relevant to
3124
traditional C compatibility.
3125
@end itemize
3126
 
3127
@item -Wdeclaration-after-statement @r{(C only)}
3128
@opindex Wdeclaration-after-statement
3129
Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This
3130
construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is by default
3131
allowed in GCC@.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not supported by
3132
GCC versions before GCC 3.0.  @xref{Mixed Declarations}.
3133
 
3134
@item -Wundef
3135
@opindex Wundef
3136
Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
3137
 
3138
@item -Wno-endif-labels
3139
@opindex Wno-endif-labels
3140
@opindex Wendif-labels
3141
Do not warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
3142
 
3143
@item -Wshadow
3144
@opindex Wshadow
3145
Warn whenever a local variable shadows another local variable, parameter or
3146
global variable or whenever a built-in function is shadowed.
3147
 
3148
@item -Wlarger-than-@var{len}
3149
@opindex Wlarger-than
3150
Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
3151
 
3152
@item -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
3153
@opindex Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
3154
Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler could not
3155
assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices.  With
3156
@option{-funsafe-loop-optimizations} warn if the compiler made
3157
such assumptions.
3158
 
3159
@item -Wpointer-arith
3160
@opindex Wpointer-arith
3161
Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
3162
of @code{void}.  GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
3163
convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
3164
to functions.
3165
 
3166
@item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C only)}
3167
@opindex Wbad-function-cast
3168
Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
3169
For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
3170
 
3171
@item -Wc++-compat
3172
Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of
3173
ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.@: request for implicit conversion from
3174
@code{void *} to a pointer to non-@code{void} type.
3175
 
3176
@item -Wcast-qual
3177
@opindex Wcast-qual
3178
Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
3179
the target type.  For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
3180
to an ordinary @code{char *}.
3181
 
3182
@item -Wcast-align
3183
@opindex Wcast-align
3184
Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
3185
target is increased.  For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
3186
an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
3187
two- or four-byte boundaries.
3188
 
3189
@item -Wwrite-strings
3190
@opindex Wwrite-strings
3191
When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
3192
char[@var{length}]} so that
3193
copying the address of one into a non-@code{const} @code{char *}
3194
pointer will get a warning; when compiling C++, warn about the
3195
deprecated conversion from string literals to @code{char *}.  This
3196
warning, by default, is enabled for C++ programs.
3197
These warnings will help you find at
3198
compile time code that can try to write into a string constant, but
3199
only if you have been very careful about using @code{const} in
3200
declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it will just be a nuisance;
3201
this is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request these warnings.
3202
 
3203
@item -Wconversion
3204
@opindex Wconversion
3205
Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
3206
would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype.  This
3207
includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
3208
conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed point argument
3209
except when the same as the default promotion.
3210
 
3211
Also, warn if a negative integer constant expression is implicitly
3212
converted to an unsigned type.  For example, warn about the assignment
3213
@code{x = -1} if @code{x} is unsigned.  But do not warn about explicit
3214
casts like @code{(unsigned) -1}.
3215
 
3216
@item -Wsign-compare
3217
@opindex Wsign-compare
3218
@cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
3219
@cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
3220
@cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
3221
Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
3222
an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
3223
This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
3224
of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
3225
 
3226
@item -Waddress
3227
@opindex Waddress
3228
@opindex Wno-address
3229
Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
3230
the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
3231
@code{void func(void); if (func)}, and comparisons against the memory
3232
address of a string literal, such as @code{if (x == "abc")}.  Such
3233
uses typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
3234
always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
3235
indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
3236
call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
3237
behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that the
3238
programmer intended to use @code{strcmp}.  This warning is enabled by
3239
@option{-Wall}.
3240
 
3241
@item -Waggregate-return
3242
@opindex Waggregate-return
3243
Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
3244
called.  (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
3245
a warning.)
3246
 
3247
@item -Wno-attributes
3248
@opindex Wno-attributes
3249
@opindex Wattributes
3250
Do not warn if an unexpected @code{__attribute__} is used, such as
3251
unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
3252
etc.  This will not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
3253
attributes.
3254
 
3255
@item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C only)}
3256
@opindex Wstrict-prototypes
3257
Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
3258
argument types.  (An old-style function definition is permitted without
3259
a warning if preceded by a declaration which specifies the argument
3260
types.)
3261
 
3262
@item -Wold-style-definition @r{(C only)}
3263
@opindex Wold-style-definition
3264
Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given
3265
even if there is a previous prototype.
3266
 
3267
@item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C only)}
3268
@opindex Wmissing-prototypes
3269
Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
3270
declaration.  This warning is issued even if the definition itself
3271
provides a prototype.  The aim is to detect global functions that fail
3272
to be declared in header files.
3273
 
3274
@item -Wmissing-declarations @r{(C only)}
3275
@opindex Wmissing-declarations
3276
Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
3277
Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
3278
Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
3279
header files.
3280
 
3281
@item -Wmissing-field-initializers
3282
@opindex Wmissing-field-initializers
3283
@opindex W
3284
@opindex Wextra
3285
Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing.  For
3286
example, the following code would cause such a warning, because
3287
@code{x.h} is implicitly zero:
3288
 
3289
@smallexample
3290
struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
3291
struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
3292
@end smallexample
3293
 
3294
This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the following
3295
modification would not trigger a warning:
3296
 
3297
@smallexample
3298
struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
3299
struct s x = @{ .f = 3, .g = 4 @};
3300
@end smallexample
3301
 
3302
This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other @option{-Wextra}
3303
warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers}.
3304
 
3305
@item -Wmissing-noreturn
3306
@opindex Wmissing-noreturn
3307
Warn about functions which might be candidates for attribute @code{noreturn}.
3308
Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.  Care should
3309
be taken to manually verify functions actually do not ever return before
3310
adding the @code{noreturn} attribute, otherwise subtle code generation
3311
bugs could be introduced.  You will not get a warning for @code{main} in
3312
hosted C environments.
3313
 
3314
@item -Wmissing-format-attribute
3315
@opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
3316
@opindex Wformat
3317
Warn about function pointers which might be candidates for @code{format}
3318
attributes.  Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.
3319
GCC will guess that function pointers with @code{format} attributes that
3320
are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return
3321
statements should have a corresponding @code{format} attribute in the
3322
resulting type.  I.e.@: the left-hand side of the assignment or
3323
initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type
3324
of the containing function respectively should also have a @code{format}
3325
attribute to avoid the warning.
3326
 
3327
GCC will also warn about function definitions which might be
3328
candidates for @code{format} attributes.  Again, these are only
3329
possible candidates.  GCC will guess that @code{format} attributes
3330
might be appropriate for any function that calls a function like
3331
@code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
3332
case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
3333
appropriate may not be detected.
3334
 
3335
@item -Wno-multichar
3336
@opindex Wno-multichar
3337
@opindex Wmultichar
3338
Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
3339
Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
3340
implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
3341
 
3342
@item -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
3343
@opindex Wnormalized
3344
@cindex NFC
3345
@cindex NFKC
3346
@cindex character set, input normalization
3347
In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
3348
different sequences of characters.  However, sometimes when characters
3349
outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
3350
different character sequences that look the same.  To avoid confusion,
3351
the ISO 10646 standard sets out some @dfn{normalization rules} which
3352
when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are turned into
3353
the same sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers which
3354
have not been normalized; this option controls that warning.
3355
 
3356
There are four levels of warning that GCC supports.  The default is
3357
@option{-Wnormalized=nfc}, which warns about any identifier which is
3358
not in the ISO 10646 ``C'' normalized form, @dfn{NFC}.  NFC is the
3359
recommended form for most uses.
3360
 
3361
Unfortunately, there are some characters which ISO C and ISO C++ allow
3362
in identifiers that when turned into NFC aren't allowable as
3363
identifiers.  That is, there's no way to use these symbols in portable
3364
ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC.
3365
@option{-Wnormalized=id} suppresses the warning for these characters.
3366
It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
3367
this, which is why this option is not the default.
3368
 
3369
You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
3370
@option{-Wnormalized=none}.  You would only want to do this if you
3371
were using some other normalization scheme (like ``D''), because
3372
otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.
3373
 
3374
Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look identical
3375
in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once formatting has
3376
been applied.  For instance @code{\u207F}, ``SUPERSCRIPT LATIN SMALL
3377
LETTER N'', will display just like a regular @code{n} which has been
3378
placed in a superscript.  ISO 10646 defines the @dfn{NFKC}
3379
normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
3380
well, and GCC will warn if your code is not in NFKC if you use
3381
@option{-Wnormalized=nfkc}.  This warning is comparable to warning
3382
about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
3383
confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
3384
useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment is
3385
unable to be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
3386
 
3387
@item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
3388
@opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
3389
Do not warn about uses of functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}),
3390
variables (@pxref{Variable Attributes}), and types (@pxref{Type
3391
Attributes}) marked as deprecated by using the @code{deprecated}
3392
attribute.
3393
 
3394
@item -Wno-overflow
3395
@opindex Wno-overflow
3396
Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
3397
 
3398
@item -Woverride-init
3399
@opindex Woverride-init
3400
@opindex W
3401
@opindex Wextra
3402
Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when
3403
using designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
3404
Initializers}).
3405
 
3406
This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other
3407
@option{-Wextra} warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra
3408
-Wno-override-init}.
3409
 
3410
@item -Wpacked
3411
@opindex Wpacked
3412
Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
3413
attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
3414
Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit.  For
3415
instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
3416
will be misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
3417
have the packed attribute:
3418
 
3419
@smallexample
3420
@group
3421
struct foo @{
3422
  int x;
3423
  char a, b, c, d;
3424
@} __attribute__((packed));
3425
struct bar @{
3426
  char z;
3427
  struct foo f;
3428
@};
3429
@end group
3430
@end smallexample
3431
 
3432
@item -Wpadded
3433
@opindex Wpadded
3434
Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
3435
of the structure or to align the whole structure.  Sometimes when this
3436
happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
3437
reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
3438
 
3439
@item -Wredundant-decls
3440
@opindex Wredundant-decls
3441
Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
3442
cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
3443
 
3444
@item -Wnested-externs @r{(C only)}
3445
@opindex Wnested-externs
3446
Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
3447
 
3448
@item -Wunreachable-code
3449
@opindex Wunreachable-code
3450
Warn if the compiler detects that code will never be executed.
3451
 
3452
This option is intended to warn when the compiler detects that at
3453
least a whole line of source code will never be executed, because
3454
some condition is never satisfied or because it is after a
3455
procedure that never returns.
3456
 
3457
It is possible for this option to produce a warning even though there
3458
are circumstances under which part of the affected line can be executed,
3459
so care should be taken when removing apparently-unreachable code.
3460
 
3461
For instance, when a function is inlined, a warning may mean that the
3462
line is unreachable in only one inlined copy of the function.
3463
 
3464
This option is not made part of @option{-Wall} because in a debugging
3465
version of a program there is often substantial code which checks
3466
correct functioning of the program and is, hopefully, unreachable
3467
because the program does work.  Another common use of unreachable
3468
code is to provide behavior which is selectable at compile-time.
3469
 
3470
@item -Winline
3471
@opindex Winline
3472
Warn if a function can not be inlined and it was declared as inline.
3473
Even with this option, the compiler will not warn about failures to
3474
inline functions declared in system headers.
3475
 
3476
The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not
3477
to inline a function.  For example, the compiler takes into account
3478
the size of the function being inlined and the amount of inlining
3479
that has already been done in the current function.  Therefore,
3480
seemingly insignificant changes in the source program can cause the
3481
warnings produced by @option{-Winline} to appear or disappear.
3482
 
3483
@item -Wno-invalid-offsetof @r{(C++ only)}
3484
@opindex Wno-invalid-offsetof
3485
Suppress warnings from applying the @samp{offsetof} macro to a non-POD
3486
type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++ standard, applying @samp{offsetof}
3487
to a non-POD type is undefined.  In existing C++ implementations,
3488
however, @samp{offsetof} typically gives meaningful results even when
3489
applied to certain kinds of non-POD types. (Such as a simple
3490
@samp{struct} that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a
3491
constructor.)  This flag is for users who are aware that they are
3492
writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore the
3493
warning about it.
3494
 
3495
The restrictions on @samp{offsetof} may be relaxed in a future version
3496
of the C++ standard.
3497
 
3498
@item -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast @r{(C only)}
3499
@opindex Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
3500
Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
3501
different size.
3502
 
3503
@item -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @r{(C only)}
3504
@opindex Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
3505
Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
3506
different size.
3507
 
3508
@item -Winvalid-pch
3509
@opindex Winvalid-pch
3510
Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
3511
the search path but can't be used.
3512
 
3513
@item -Wlong-long
3514
@opindex Wlong-long
3515
@opindex Wno-long-long
3516
Warn if @samp{long long} type is used.  This is default.  To inhibit
3517
the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}.  Flags
3518
@option{-Wlong-long} and @option{-Wno-long-long} are taken into account
3519
only when @option{-pedantic} flag is used.
3520
 
3521
@item -Wvariadic-macros
3522
@opindex Wvariadic-macros
3523
@opindex Wno-variadic-macros
3524
Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU
3525
alternate syntax when in pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.
3526
To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-variadic-macros}.
3527
 
3528
@item -Wvolatile-register-var
3529
@opindex Wvolatile-register-var
3530
@opindex Wno-volatile-register-var
3531
Warn if a register variable is declared volatile.  The volatile
3532
modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate reads
3533
and/or writes to register variables.
3534
 
3535
@item -Wdisabled-optimization
3536
@opindex Wdisabled-optimization
3537
Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does
3538
not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
3539
merely indicates that GCC's optimizers were unable to handle the code
3540
effectively.  Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
3541
complex; GCC will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization
3542
itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
3543
 
3544
@item -Wpointer-sign
3545
@opindex Wpointer-sign
3546
@opindex Wno-pointer-sign
3547
Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different signedness.
3548
This option is only supported for C and Objective-C@.  It is implied by
3549
@option{-Wall} and by @option{-pedantic}, which can be disabled with
3550
@option{-Wno-pointer-sign}.
3551
 
3552
@item -Werror
3553
@opindex Werror
3554
Make all warnings into errors.
3555
 
3556
@item -Werror=
3557
@opindex Werror=
3558
Make the specified warning into an errors.  The specifier for a
3559
warning is appended, for example @option{-Werror=switch} turns the
3560
warnings controlled by @option{-Wswitch} into errors.  This switch
3561
takes a negative form, to be used to negate @option{-Werror} for
3562
specific warnings, for example @option{-Wno-error=switch} makes
3563
@option{-Wswitch} warnings not be errors, even when @option{-Werror}
3564
is in effect.  You can use the @option{-fdiagnostics-show-option}
3565
option to have each controllable warning amended with the option which
3566
controls it, to determine what to use with this option.
3567
 
3568
Note that specifying @option{-Werror=}@var{foo} automatically implies
3569
@option{-W}@var{foo}.  However, @option{-Wno-error=}@var{foo} does not
3570
imply anything.
3571
 
3572
@item -Wstack-protector
3573
@opindex Wstack-protector
3574
This option is only active when @option{-fstack-protector} is active.  It
3575
warns about functions that will not be protected against stack smashing.
3576
 
3577
@item -Woverlength-strings
3578
@opindex Woverlength-strings
3579
Warn about string constants which are longer than the ``minimum
3580
maximum'' length specified in the C standard.  Modern compilers
3581
generally allow string constants which are much longer than the
3582
standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
3583
using longer strings.
3584
 
3585
The limit applies @emph{after} string constant concatenation, and does
3586
not count the trailing NUL@.  In C89, the limit was 509 characters; in
3587
C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
3588
minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++@.
3589
 
3590
This option is implied by @option{-pedantic}, and can be disabled with
3591
@option{-Wno-overlength-strings}.
3592
@end table
3593
 
3594
@node Debugging Options
3595
@section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
3596
@cindex options, debugging
3597
@cindex debugging information options
3598
 
3599
GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
3600
either your program or GCC:
3601
 
3602
@table @gcctabopt
3603
@item -g
3604
@opindex g
3605
Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
3606
(stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF 2)@.  GDB can work with this debugging
3607
information.
3608
 
3609
On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
3610
debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
3611
makes debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other debuggers
3612
crash or
3613
refuse to read the program.  If you want to control for certain whether
3614
to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
3615
@option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms} (see below).
3616
 
3617
GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
3618
@option{-O}.  The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
3619
produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
3620
at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
3621
some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
3622
results or their values were already at hand; some statements may
3623
execute in different places because they were moved out of loops.
3624
 
3625
Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This makes
3626
it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
3627
 
3628
The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
3629
capability for more than one debugging format.
3630
 
3631
@item -ggdb
3632
@opindex ggdb
3633
Produce debugging information for use by GDB@.  This means to use the
3634
most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
3635
if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
3636
possible.
3637
 
3638
@item -gstabs
3639
@opindex gstabs
3640
Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
3641
without GDB extensions.  This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
3642
systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
3643
produces stabs debugging output which is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
3644
On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
3645
 
3646
@item -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
3647
@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
3648
Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
3649
for only symbols that are actually used.
3650
 
3651
@item -femit-class-debug-always
3652
Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one
3653
object file, emit it in all object files using the class.  This option
3654
should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle the way GCC
3655
normally emits debugging information for classes because using this
3656
option will increase the size of debugging information by as much as a
3657
factor of two.
3658
 
3659
@item -gstabs+
3660
@opindex gstabs+
3661
Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
3662
using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
3663
use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
3664
refuse to read the program.
3665
 
3666
@item -gcoff
3667
@opindex gcoff
3668
Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
3669
This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
3670
System V Release 4.
3671
 
3672
@item -gxcoff
3673
@opindex gxcoff
3674
Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
3675
This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
3676
 
3677
@item -gxcoff+
3678
@opindex gxcoff+
3679
Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
3680
using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
3681
use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
3682
refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
3683
assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
3684
 
3685
@item -gdwarf-2
3686
@opindex gdwarf-2
3687
Produce debugging information in DWARF version 2 format (if that is
3688
supported).  This is the format used by DBX on IRIX 6.  With this
3689
option, GCC uses features of DWARF version 3 when they are useful;
3690
version 3 is upward compatible with version 2, but may still cause
3691
problems for older debuggers.
3692
 
3693
@item -gvms
3694
@opindex gvms
3695
Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is
3696
supported).  This is the format used by DEBUG on VMS systems.
3697
 
3698
@item -g@var{level}
3699
@itemx -ggdb@var{level}
3700
@itemx -gstabs@var{level}
3701
@itemx -gcoff@var{level}
3702
@itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
3703
@itemx -gvms@var{level}
3704
Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
3705
much information.  The default level is 2.
3706
 
3707
Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
3708
parts of the program that you don't plan to debug.  This includes
3709
descriptions of functions and external variables, but no information
3710
about local variables and no line numbers.
3711
 
3712
Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
3713
present in the program.  Some debuggers support macro expansion when
3714
you use @option{-g3}.
3715
 
3716
@option{-gdwarf-2} does not accept a concatenated debug level, because
3717
GCC used to support an option @option{-gdwarf} that meant to generate
3718
debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very
3719
different from version 2), and it would have been too confusing.  That
3720
debug format is long obsolete, but the option cannot be changed now.
3721
Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}} option to change the
3722
debug level for DWARF2.
3723
 
3724
@item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
3725
@opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
3726
Compress DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
3727
information about each symbol.  This option only makes sense when
3728
generating DWARF2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
3729
 
3730
@cindex @command{prof}
3731
@item -p
3732
@opindex p
3733
Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
3734
analysis program @command{prof}.  You must use this option when compiling
3735
the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
3736
linking.
3737
 
3738
@cindex @command{gprof}
3739
@item -pg
3740
@opindex pg
3741
Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
3742
analysis program @command{gprof}.  You must use this option when compiling
3743
the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
3744
linking.
3745
 
3746
@item -Q
3747
@opindex Q
3748
Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
3749
print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
3750
 
3751
@item -ftime-report
3752
@opindex ftime-report
3753
Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
3754
pass when it finishes.
3755
 
3756
@item -fmem-report
3757
@opindex fmem-report
3758
Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
3759
allocation when it finishes.
3760
 
3761
@item -fprofile-arcs
3762
@opindex fprofile-arcs
3763
Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented.  During
3764
execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
3765
executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the compiled
3766
program exits it saves this data to a file called
3767
@file{@var{auxname}.gcda} for each source file.  The data may be used for
3768
profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
3769
test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}).  Each object file's
3770
@var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
3771
explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
3772
the basename of the source file.  In both cases any suffix is removed
3773
(e.g.@: @file{foo.gcda} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
3774
@file{dir/foo.gcda} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
3775
@xref{Cross-profiling}.
3776
 
3777
@cindex @command{gcov}
3778
@item --coverage
3779
@opindex coverage
3780
 
3781
This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage
3782
analysis.  The option is a synonym for @option{-fprofile-arcs}
3783
@option{-ftest-coverage} (when compiling) and @option{-lgcov} (when
3784
linking).  See the documentation for those options for more details.
3785
 
3786
@itemize
3787
 
3788
@item
3789
Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
3790
and code generation options.  For test coverage analysis, use the
3791
additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option.  You do not need to profile
3792
every source file in a program.
3793
 
3794
@item
3795
Link your object files with @option{-lgcov} or @option{-fprofile-arcs}
3796
(the latter implies the former).
3797
 
3798
@item
3799
Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
3800
information.  This may be repeated any number of times.  You can run
3801
concurrent instances of your program, and provided that the file system
3802
supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated.  Also
3803
@code{fork} calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting
3804
will not happen).
3805
 
3806
@item
3807
For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
3808
the same optimization and code generation options plus
3809
@option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
3810
Control Optimization}).
3811
 
3812
@item
3813
For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
3814
information from the @file{.gcno} and @file{.gcda} files.  Refer to the
3815
@command{gcov} documentation for further information.
3816
 
3817
@end itemize
3818
 
3819
With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
3820
creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
3821
Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
3822
compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
3823
executed.  When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
3824
instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
3825
block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
3826
 
3827
@need 2000
3828
@item -ftest-coverage
3829
@opindex ftest-coverage
3830
Produce a notes file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
3831
(@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
3832
show program coverage.  Each source file's note file is called
3833
@file{@var{auxname}.gcno}.  Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
3834
above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
3835
generate test coverage data.  Coverage data will match the source files
3836
more closely, if you do not optimize.
3837
 
3838
@item -d@var{letters}
3839
@item -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
3840
@opindex d
3841
Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
3842
@var{letters}.    This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
3843
compiler.  The file names for most of the dumps are made by appending a
3844
pass number and a word to the @var{dumpname}.  @var{dumpname} is generated
3845
from the name of the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not
3846
an executable, otherwise it is the basename of the source file.
3847
 
3848
Most debug dumps can be enabled either passing a letter to the @option{-d}
3849
option, or with a long @option{-fdump-rtl} switch; here are the possible
3850
letters for use in @var{letters} and @var{pass}, and their meanings:
3851
 
3852
@table @gcctabopt
3853
@item -dA
3854
@opindex dA
3855
Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
3856
 
3857
@item -dB
3858
@itemx -fdump-rtl-bbro
3859
@opindex dB
3860
@opindex fdump-rtl-bbro
3861
Dump after block reordering, to @file{@var{file}.148r.bbro}.
3862
 
3863
@item -dc
3864
@itemx -fdump-rtl-combine
3865
@opindex dc
3866
@opindex fdump-rtl-combine
3867
Dump after instruction combination, to the file @file{@var{file}.129r.combine}.
3868
 
3869
@item -dC
3870
@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce1
3871
@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce2
3872
@opindex dC
3873
@opindex fdump-rtl-ce1
3874
@opindex fdump-rtl-ce2
3875
@option{-dC} and @option{-fdump-rtl-ce1} enable dumping after the
3876
first if conversion, to the file @file{@var{file}.117r.ce1}.  @option{-dC}
3877
and @option{-fdump-rtl-ce2} enable dumping after the second if
3878
conversion, to the file @file{@var{file}.130r.ce2}.
3879
 
3880
@item -dd
3881
@itemx -fdump-rtl-btl
3882
@itemx -fdump-rtl-dbr
3883
@opindex dd
3884
@opindex fdump-rtl-btl
3885
@opindex fdump-rtl-dbr
3886
@option{-dd} and @option{-fdump-rtl-btl} enable dumping after branch
3887
target load optimization, to @file{@var{file}.31.btl}.  @option{-dd}
3888
and @option{-fdump-rtl-dbr} enable dumping after delayed branch
3889
scheduling, to @file{@var{file}.36.dbr}.
3890
 
3891
@item -dD
3892
@opindex dD
3893
Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
3894
normal output.
3895
 
3896
@item -dE
3897
@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce3
3898
@opindex dE
3899
@opindex fdump-rtl-ce3
3900
Dump after the third if conversion, to @file{@var{file}.146r.ce3}.
3901
 
3902
@item -df
3903
@itemx -fdump-rtl-cfg
3904
@itemx -fdump-rtl-life
3905
@opindex df
3906
@opindex fdump-rtl-cfg
3907
@opindex fdump-rtl-life
3908
@option{-df} and @option{-fdump-rtl-cfg} enable dumping after control
3909
and data flow analysis, to @file{@var{file}.116r.cfg}.  @option{-df}
3910
and @option{-fdump-rtl-cfg} enable dumping dump after life analysis,
3911
to @file{@var{file}.128r.life1} and @file{@var{file}.135r.life2}.
3912
 
3913
@item -dg
3914
@itemx -fdump-rtl-greg
3915
@opindex dg
3916
@opindex fdump-rtl-greg
3917
Dump after global register allocation, to @file{@var{file}.139r.greg}.
3918
 
3919
@item -dG
3920
@itemx -fdump-rtl-gcse
3921
@itemx -fdump-rtl-bypass
3922
@opindex dG
3923
@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse
3924
@opindex fdump-rtl-bypass
3925
@option{-dG} and @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse} enable dumping after GCSE, to
3926
@file{@var{file}.114r.gcse}.  @option{-dG} and @option{-fdump-rtl-bypass}
3927
enable dumping after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations, to
3928
@file{@var{file}.115r.bypass}.
3929
 
3930
@item -dh
3931
@itemx -fdump-rtl-eh
3932
@opindex dh
3933
@opindex fdump-rtl-eh
3934
Dump after finalization of EH handling code, to @file{@var{file}.02.eh}.
3935
 
3936
@item -di
3937
@itemx -fdump-rtl-sibling
3938
@opindex di
3939
@opindex fdump-rtl-sibling
3940
Dump after sibling call optimizations, to @file{@var{file}.106r.sibling}.
3941
 
3942
@item -dj
3943
@itemx -fdump-rtl-jump
3944
@opindex dj
3945
@opindex fdump-rtl-jump
3946
Dump after the first jump optimization, to @file{@var{file}.112r.jump}.
3947
 
3948
@item -dk
3949
@itemx -fdump-rtl-stack
3950
@opindex dk
3951
@opindex fdump-rtl-stack
3952
Dump after conversion from registers to stack, to @file{@var{file}.152r.stack}.
3953
 
3954
@item -dl
3955
@itemx -fdump-rtl-lreg
3956
@opindex dl
3957
@opindex fdump-rtl-lreg
3958
Dump after local register allocation, to @file{@var{file}.138r.lreg}.
3959
 
3960
@item -dL
3961
@itemx -fdump-rtl-loop2
3962
@opindex dL
3963
@opindex fdump-rtl-loop2
3964
@option{-dL} and @option{-fdump-rtl-loop2} enable dumping after the
3965
loop optimization pass, to @file{@var{file}.119r.loop2},
3966
@file{@var{file}.120r.loop2_init},
3967
@file{@var{file}.121r.loop2_invariant}, and
3968
@file{@var{file}.125r.loop2_done}.
3969
 
3970
@item -dm
3971
@itemx -fdump-rtl-sms
3972
@opindex dm
3973
@opindex fdump-rtl-sms
3974
Dump after modulo scheduling, to @file{@var{file}.136r.sms}.
3975
 
3976
@item -dM
3977
@itemx -fdump-rtl-mach
3978
@opindex dM
3979
@opindex fdump-rtl-mach
3980
Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, to
3981
@file{@var{file}.155r.mach}.
3982
 
3983
@item -dn
3984
@itemx -fdump-rtl-rnreg
3985
@opindex dn
3986
@opindex fdump-rtl-rnreg
3987
Dump after register renumbering, to @file{@var{file}.147r.rnreg}.
3988
 
3989
@item -dN
3990
@itemx -fdump-rtl-regmove
3991
@opindex dN
3992
@opindex fdump-rtl-regmove
3993
Dump after the register move pass, to @file{@var{file}.132r.regmove}.
3994
 
3995
@item -do
3996
@itemx -fdump-rtl-postreload
3997
@opindex do
3998
@opindex fdump-rtl-postreload
3999
Dump after post-reload optimizations, to @file{@var{file}.24.postreload}.
4000
 
4001
@item -dr
4002
@itemx -fdump-rtl-expand
4003
@opindex dr
4004
@opindex fdump-rtl-expand
4005
Dump after RTL generation, to @file{@var{file}.104r.expand}.
4006
 
4007
@item -dR
4008
@itemx -fdump-rtl-sched2
4009
@opindex dR
4010
@opindex fdump-rtl-sched2
4011
Dump after the second scheduling pass, to @file{@var{file}.150r.sched2}.
4012
 
4013
@item -ds
4014
@itemx -fdump-rtl-cse
4015
@opindex ds
4016
@opindex fdump-rtl-cse
4017
Dump after CSE (including the jump optimization that sometimes follows
4018
CSE), to @file{@var{file}.113r.cse}.
4019
 
4020
@item -dS
4021
@itemx -fdump-rtl-sched
4022
@opindex dS
4023
@opindex fdump-rtl-sched
4024
Dump after the first scheduling pass, to @file{@var{file}.21.sched}.
4025
 
4026
@item -dt
4027
@itemx -fdump-rtl-cse2
4028
@opindex dt
4029
@opindex fdump-rtl-cse2
4030
Dump after the second CSE pass (including the jump optimization that
4031
sometimes follows CSE), to @file{@var{file}.127r.cse2}.
4032
 
4033
@item -dT
4034
@itemx -fdump-rtl-tracer
4035
@opindex dT
4036
@opindex fdump-rtl-tracer
4037
Dump after running tracer, to @file{@var{file}.118r.tracer}.
4038
 
4039
@item -dV
4040
@itemx -fdump-rtl-vpt
4041
@itemx -fdump-rtl-vartrack
4042
@opindex dV
4043
@opindex fdump-rtl-vpt
4044
@opindex fdump-rtl-vartrack
4045
@option{-dV} and @option{-fdump-rtl-vpt} enable dumping after the value
4046
profile transformations, to @file{@var{file}.10.vpt}.  @option{-dV}
4047
and @option{-fdump-rtl-vartrack} enable dumping after variable tracking,
4048
to @file{@var{file}.154r.vartrack}.
4049
 
4050
@item -dw
4051
@itemx -fdump-rtl-flow2
4052
@opindex dw
4053
@opindex fdump-rtl-flow2
4054
Dump after the second flow pass, to @file{@var{file}.142r.flow2}.
4055
 
4056
@item -dz
4057
@itemx -fdump-rtl-peephole2
4058
@opindex dz
4059
@opindex fdump-rtl-peephole2
4060
Dump after the peephole pass, to @file{@var{file}.145r.peephole2}.
4061
 
4062
@item -dZ
4063
@itemx -fdump-rtl-web
4064
@opindex dZ
4065
@opindex fdump-rtl-web
4066
Dump after live range splitting, to @file{@var{file}.126r.web}.
4067
 
4068
@item -da
4069
@itemx -fdump-rtl-all
4070
@opindex da
4071
@opindex fdump-rtl-all
4072
Produce all the dumps listed above.
4073
 
4074
@item -dH
4075
@opindex dH
4076
Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
4077
 
4078
@item -dm
4079
@opindex dm
4080
Print statistics on memory usage, at the end of the run, to
4081
standard error.
4082
 
4083
@item -dp
4084
@opindex dp
4085
Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
4086
pattern and alternative was used.  The length of each instruction is
4087
also printed.
4088
 
4089
@item -dP
4090
@opindex dP
4091
Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
4092
Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
4093
 
4094
@item -dv
4095
@opindex dv
4096
For each of the other indicated dump files (either with @option{-d} or
4097
@option{-fdump-rtl-@var{pass}}), dump a representation of the control flow
4098
graph suitable for viewing with VCG to @file{@var{file}.@var{pass}.vcg}.
4099
 
4100
@item -dx
4101
@opindex dx
4102
Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used
4103
with @samp{r} (@option{-fdump-rtl-expand}).
4104
 
4105
@item -dy
4106
@opindex dy
4107
Dump debugging information during parsing, to standard error.
4108
@end table
4109
 
4110
@item -fdump-noaddr
4111
@opindex fdump-noaddr
4112
When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress
4113
address output.  This makes it more feasible to use diff on debugging
4114
dumps for compiler invocations with different compiler binaries and/or
4115
different text / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
4116
 
4117
@item -fdump-unnumbered
4118
@opindex fdump-unnumbered
4119
When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress instruction
4120
numbers, line number note and address output.  This makes it more feasible to
4121
use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with different
4122
options, in particular with and without @option{-g}.
4123
 
4124
@item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C++ only)}
4125
@itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
4126
@opindex fdump-translation-unit
4127
Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
4128
unit to a file.  The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
4129
source file name.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
4130
controls the details of the dump as described for the
4131
@option{-fdump-tree} options.
4132
 
4133
@item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
4134
@itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
4135
@opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
4136
Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
4137
table layout to a file.  The file name is made by appending @file{.class}
4138
to the source file name.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used,
4139
@var{options} controls the details of the dump as described for the
4140
@option{-fdump-tree} options.
4141
 
4142
@item -fdump-ipa-@var{switch}
4143
@opindex fdump-ipa
4144
Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
4145
language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a switch
4146
specific suffix to the source file name.  The following dumps are possible:
4147
 
4148
@table @samp
4149
@item all
4150
Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps; currently the only produced
4151
dump is the @samp{cgraph} dump.
4152
 
4153
@item cgraph
4154
Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal,
4155
and inlining decisions.
4156
@end table
4157
 
4158
@item -fdump-tree-@var{switch}
4159
@itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}
4160
@opindex fdump-tree
4161
Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
4162
language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a switch
4163
specific suffix to the source file name.  If the @samp{-@var{options}}
4164
form is used, @var{options} is a list of @samp{-} separated options that
4165
control the details of the dump.  Not all options are applicable to all
4166
dumps, those which are not meaningful will be ignored.  The following
4167
options are available
4168
 
4169
@table @samp
4170
@item address
4171
Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it
4172
changes according to the environment and source file.  Its primary use
4173
is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
4174
@item slim
4175
Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
4176
because that scope has been reached.  Only dump such items when they
4177
are directly reachable by some other path.  When dumping pretty-printed
4178
trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.
4179
@item raw
4180
Print a raw representation of the tree.  By default, trees are
4181
pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
4182
@item details
4183
Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).
4184
@item stats
4185
Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump
4186
option).
4187
@item blocks
4188
Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
4189
@item vops
4190
Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
4191
@item lineno
4192
Enable showing line numbers for statements.
4193
@item uid
4194
Enable showing the unique ID (@code{DECL_UID}) for each variable.
4195
@item all
4196
Turn on all options, except @option{raw}, @option{slim} and @option{lineno}.
4197
@end table
4198
 
4199
The following tree dumps are possible:
4200
@table @samp
4201
 
4202
@item original
4203
Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
4204
 
4205
@item optimized
4206
Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
4207
 
4208
@item inlined
4209
Dump after function inlining, to @file{@var{file}.inlined}.
4210
 
4211
@item gimple
4212
@opindex fdump-tree-gimple
4213
Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The
4214
file name is made by appending @file{.gimple} to the source file name.
4215
 
4216
@item cfg
4217
@opindex fdump-tree-cfg
4218
Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is
4219
made by appending @file{.cfg} to the source file name.
4220
 
4221
@item vcg
4222
@opindex fdump-tree-vcg
4223
Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file in VCG format.  The
4224
file name is made by appending @file{.vcg} to the source file name.  Note
4225
that if the file contains more than one function, the generated file cannot
4226
be used directly by VCG@.  You will need to cut and paste each function's
4227
graph into its own separate file first.
4228
 
4229
@item ch
4230
@opindex fdump-tree-ch
4231
Dump each function after copying loop headers.  The file name is made by
4232
appending @file{.ch} to the source file name.
4233
 
4234
@item ssa
4235
@opindex fdump-tree-ssa
4236
Dump SSA related information to a file.  The file name is made by appending
4237
@file{.ssa} to the source file name.
4238
 
4239
@item salias
4240
@opindex fdump-tree-salias
4241
Dump structure aliasing variable information to a file.  This file name
4242
is made by appending @file{.salias} to the source file name.
4243
 
4244
@item alias
4245
@opindex fdump-tree-alias
4246
Dump aliasing information for each function.  The file name is made by
4247
appending @file{.alias} to the source file name.
4248
 
4249
@item ccp
4250
@opindex fdump-tree-ccp
4251
Dump each function after CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
4252
@file{.ccp} to the source file name.
4253
 
4254
@item storeccp
4255
@opindex fdump-tree-storeccp
4256
Dump each function after STORE-CCP.  The file name is made by appending
4257
@file{.storeccp} to the source file name.
4258
 
4259
@item pre
4260
@opindex fdump-tree-pre
4261
Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
4262
by appending @file{.pre} to the source file name.
4263
 
4264
@item fre
4265
@opindex fdump-tree-fre
4266
Dump trees after full redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
4267
by appending @file{.fre} to the source file name.
4268
 
4269
@item copyprop
4270
@opindex fdump-tree-copyprop
4271
Dump trees after copy propagation.  The file name is made
4272
by appending @file{.copyprop} to the source file name.
4273
 
4274
@item store_copyprop
4275
@opindex fdump-tree-store_copyprop
4276
Dump trees after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made
4277
by appending @file{.store_copyprop} to the source file name.
4278
 
4279
@item dce
4280
@opindex fdump-tree-dce
4281
Dump each function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by
4282
appending @file{.dce} to the source file name.
4283
 
4284
@item mudflap
4285
@opindex fdump-tree-mudflap
4286
Dump each function after adding mudflap instrumentation.  The file name is
4287
made by appending @file{.mudflap} to the source file name.
4288
 
4289
@item sra
4290
@opindex fdump-tree-sra
4291
Dump each function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The
4292
file name is made by appending @file{.sra} to the source file name.
4293
 
4294
@item sink
4295
@opindex fdump-tree-sink
4296
Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made
4297
by appending @file{.sink} to the source file name.
4298
 
4299
@item dom
4300
@opindex fdump-tree-dom
4301
Dump each function after applying dominator tree optimizations.  The file
4302
name is made by appending @file{.dom} to the source file name.
4303
 
4304
@item dse
4305
@opindex fdump-tree-dse
4306
Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file
4307
name is made by appending @file{.dse} to the source file name.
4308
 
4309
@item phiopt
4310
@opindex fdump-tree-phiopt
4311
Dump each function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file
4312
name is made by appending @file{.phiopt} to the source file name.
4313
 
4314
@item forwprop
4315
@opindex fdump-tree-forwprop
4316
Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The file
4317
name is made by appending @file{.forwprop} to the source file name.
4318
 
4319
@item copyrename
4320
@opindex fdump-tree-copyrename
4321
Dump each function after applying the copy rename optimization.  The file
4322
name is made by appending @file{.copyrename} to the source file name.
4323
 
4324
@item nrv
4325
@opindex fdump-tree-nrv
4326
Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on
4327
generic trees.  The file name is made by appending @file{.nrv} to the source
4328
file name.
4329
 
4330
@item vect
4331
@opindex fdump-tree-vect
4332
Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name is
4333
made by appending @file{.vect} to the source file name.
4334
 
4335
@item vrp
4336
@opindex fdump-tree-vrp
4337
Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name
4338
is made by appending @file{.vrp} to the source file name.
4339
 
4340
@item all
4341
@opindex fdump-tree-all
4342
Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.
4343
@end table
4344
 
4345
@item -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n}
4346
@opindex ftree-vectorizer-verbose
4347
This option controls the amount of debugging output the vectorizer prints.
4348
This information is written to standard error, unless
4349
@option{-fdump-tree-all} or @option{-fdump-tree-vect} is specified,
4350
in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, @file{.vect}.
4351
For @var{n}=0 no diagnostic information is reported.
4352
If @var{n}=1 the vectorizer reports each loop that got vectorized,
4353
and the total number of loops that got vectorized.
4354
If @var{n}=2 the vectorizer also reports non-vectorized loops that passed
4355
the first analysis phase (vect_analyze_loop_form) - i.e. countable,
4356
inner-most, single-bb, single-entry/exit loops.  This is the same verbosity
4357
level that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-stats} uses.
4358
Higher verbosity levels mean either more information dumped for each
4359
reported loop, or same amount of information reported for more loops:
4360
If @var{n}=3, alignment related information is added to the reports.
4361
If @var{n}=4, data-references related information (e.g. memory dependences,
4362
memory access-patterns) is added to the reports.
4363
If @var{n}=5, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized inner-most loops
4364
that did not pass the first analysis phase (i.e. may not be countable, or
4365
may have complicated control-flow).
4366
If @var{n}=6, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized nested loops.
4367
For @var{n}=7, all the information the vectorizer generates during its
4368
analysis and transformation is reported.  This is the same verbosity level
4369
that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-details} uses.
4370
 
4371
@item -frandom-seed=@var{string}
4372
@opindex frandom-string
4373
This option provides a seed that GCC uses when it would otherwise use
4374
random numbers.  It is used to generate certain symbol names
4375
that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to
4376
place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that
4377
produce them.  You can use the @option{-frandom-seed} option to produce
4378
reproducibly identical object files.
4379
 
4380
The @var{string} should be different for every file you compile.
4381
 
4382
@item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
4383
@opindex fsched-verbose
4384
On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
4385
amount of debugging output the scheduler prints.  This information is
4386
written to standard error, unless @option{-dS} or @option{-dR} is
4387
specified, in which case it is output to the usual dump
4388
listing file, @file{.sched} or @file{.sched2} respectively.  However
4389
for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is always printed to standard
4390
error.
4391
 
4392
For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
4393
same information as @option{-dRS}.  For @var{n} greater than one, it
4394
also output basic block probabilities, detailed ready list information
4395
and unit/insn info.  For @var{n} greater than two, it includes RTL
4396
at abort point, control-flow and regions info.  And for @var{n} over
4397
four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes dependence info.
4398
 
4399
@item -save-temps
4400
@opindex save-temps
4401
Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
4402
in the current directory and name them based on the source file.  Thus,
4403
compiling @file{foo.c} with @samp{-c -save-temps} would produce files
4404
@file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}.  This creates a
4405
preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
4406
normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
4407
 
4408
When used in combination with the @option{-x} command line option,
4409
@option{-save-temps} is sensible enough to avoid over writing an
4410
input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.
4411
The corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
4412
source file before using @option{-save-temps}.
4413
 
4414
@item -time
4415
@opindex time
4416
Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
4417
sequence.  For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
4418
(plus the linker if linking is done).  The output looks like this:
4419
 
4420
@smallexample
4421
# cc1 0.12 0.01
4422
# as 0.00 0.01
4423
@end smallexample
4424
 
4425
The first number on each line is the ``user time'', that is time spent
4426
executing the program itself.  The second number is ``system time'',
4427
time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
4428
Both numbers are in seconds.
4429
 
4430
@item -fvar-tracking
4431
@opindex fvar-tracking
4432
Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each
4433
position in code.  Better debugging information is then generated
4434
(if the debugging information format supports this information).
4435
 
4436
It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (@option{-Os},
4437
@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, ...), debugging information (@option{-g}) and
4438
the debug info format supports it.
4439
 
4440
@item -print-file-name=@var{library}
4441
@opindex print-file-name
4442
Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
4443
would be used when linking---and don't do anything else.  With this
4444
option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
4445
file name.
4446
 
4447
@item -print-multi-directory
4448
@opindex print-multi-directory
4449
Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
4450
other switches present in the command line.  This directory is supposed
4451
to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
4452
 
4453
@item -print-multi-lib
4454
@opindex print-multi-lib
4455
Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
4456
that enable them.  The directory name is separated from the switches by
4457
@samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
4458
@samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to
4459
ease shell-processing.
4460
 
4461
@item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
4462
@opindex print-prog-name
4463
Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
4464
 
4465
@item -print-libgcc-file-name
4466
@opindex print-libgcc-file-name
4467
Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
4468
 
4469
This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
4470
but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}.  You can do
4471
 
4472
@smallexample
4473
gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
4474
@end smallexample
4475
 
4476
@item -print-search-dirs
4477
@opindex print-search-dirs
4478
Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
4479
program and library directories @command{gcc} will search---and don't do anything else.
4480
 
4481
This is useful when @command{gcc} prints the error message
4482
@samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
4483
To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
4484
components where @command{gcc} expects to find them, or you can set the environment
4485
variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
4486
Don't forget the trailing @samp{/}.
4487
@xref{Environment Variables}.
4488
 
4489
@item -dumpmachine
4490
@opindex dumpmachine
4491
Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
4492
@samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
4493
 
4494
@item -dumpversion
4495
@opindex dumpversion
4496
Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
4497
anything else.
4498
 
4499
@item -dumpspecs
4500
@opindex dumpspecs
4501
Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This
4502
is used when GCC itself is being built.)  @xref{Spec Files}.
4503
 
4504
@item -feliminate-unused-debug-types
4505
@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-types
4506
Normally, when producing DWARF2 output, GCC will emit debugging
4507
information for all types declared in a compilation
4508
unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used
4509
in that compilation unit.  Sometimes this is useful, such as
4510
if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is
4511
not actually used in your program (but is declared).  More often,
4512
however, this results in a significant amount of wasted space.
4513
With this option, GCC will avoid producing debug symbol output
4514
for types that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.
4515
@end table
4516
 
4517
@node Optimize Options
4518
@section Options That Control Optimization
4519
@cindex optimize options
4520
@cindex options, optimization
4521
 
4522
These options control various sorts of optimizations.
4523
 
4524
Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
4525
cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
4526
results.  Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
4527
breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
4528
variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
4529
function and get exactly the results you would expect from the source
4530
code.
4531
 
4532
Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
4533
the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
4534
and possibly the ability to debug the program.
4535
 
4536
The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of
4537
the program.  Optimization levels @option{-O} and above, in
4538
particular, enable @emph{unit-at-a-time} mode, which allows the
4539
compiler to consider information gained from later functions in
4540
the file when compiling a function.  Compiling multiple files at
4541
once to a single output file in @emph{unit-at-a-time} mode allows
4542
the compiler to use information gained from all of the files when
4543
compiling each of them.
4544
 
4545
Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only
4546
optimizations that have a flag are listed.
4547
 
4548
@table @gcctabopt
4549
@item -O
4550
@itemx -O1
4551
@opindex O
4552
@opindex O1
4553
Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
4554
more memory for a large function.
4555
 
4556
With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
4557
time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
4558
compilation time.
4559
 
4560
@option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
4561
@gccoptlist{-fdefer-pop @gol
4562
-fdelayed-branch @gol
4563
-fguess-branch-probability @gol
4564
-fcprop-registers @gol
4565
-fif-conversion @gol
4566
-fif-conversion2 @gol
4567
-ftree-ccp @gol
4568
-ftree-dce @gol
4569
-ftree-dominator-opts @gol
4570
-ftree-dse @gol
4571
-ftree-ter @gol
4572
-ftree-lrs @gol
4573
-ftree-sra @gol
4574
-ftree-copyrename @gol
4575
-ftree-fre @gol
4576
-ftree-ch @gol
4577
-funit-at-a-time @gol
4578
-fmerge-constants}
4579
 
4580
@option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
4581
where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
4582
 
4583
@item -O2
4584
@opindex O2
4585
Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
4586
that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff.  The compiler does not
4587
perform loop unrolling or function inlining when you specify @option{-O2}.
4588
As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
4589
and the performance of the generated code.
4590
 
4591
@option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}.  It
4592
also turns on the following optimization flags:
4593
@gccoptlist{-fthread-jumps @gol
4594
-fcrossjumping @gol
4595
-foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
4596
-fcse-follow-jumps  -fcse-skip-blocks @gol
4597
-fgcse  -fgcse-lm  @gol
4598
-fexpensive-optimizations @gol
4599
-frerun-cse-after-loop  @gol
4600
-fcaller-saves @gol
4601
-fpeephole2 @gol
4602
-fschedule-insns  -fschedule-insns2 @gol
4603
-fsched-interblock  -fsched-spec @gol
4604
-fregmove @gol
4605
-fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
4606
-fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
4607
-freorder-blocks  -freorder-functions @gol
4608
-falign-functions  -falign-jumps @gol
4609
-falign-loops  -falign-labels @gol
4610
-ftree-vrp @gol
4611
-ftree-pre}
4612
 
4613
Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
4614
invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
4615
 
4616
@option{-O2} doesn't turn on @option{-ftree-vrp} for the Ada compiler.
4617
This option must be explicitly specified on the command line to be
4618
enabled for the Ada compiler.
4619
 
4620
@item -O3
4621
@opindex O3
4622
Optimize yet more.  @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified by
4623
@option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions},
4624
@option{-funswitch-loops} and @option{-fgcse-after-reload} options.
4625
 
4626
@item -O0
4627
@opindex O0
4628
Do not optimize.  This is the default.
4629
 
4630
@item -Os
4631
@opindex Os
4632
Optimize for size.  @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
4633
do not typically increase code size.  It also performs further
4634
optimizations designed to reduce code size.
4635
 
4636
@option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
4637
@gccoptlist{-falign-functions  -falign-jumps  -falign-loops @gol
4638
-falign-labels  -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition @gol
4639
-fprefetch-loop-arrays  -ftree-vect-loop-version}
4640
 
4641
If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
4642
the last such option is the one that is effective.
4643
@end table
4644
 
4645
Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
4646
flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
4647
form of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table
4648
below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically will
4649
use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
4650
or adding it.
4651
 
4652
The following options control specific optimizations.  They are either
4653
activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are.  You
4654
can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
4655
optimizations to be performed is desired.
4656
 
4657
@table @gcctabopt
4658
@item -fno-default-inline
4659
@opindex fno-default-inline
4660
Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are
4661
defined inside the class scope (C++ only).  Otherwise, when you specify
4662
@w{@option{-O}}, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
4663
inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add @samp{inline} in front of
4664
the member function name.
4665
 
4666
@item -fno-defer-pop
4667
@opindex fno-defer-pop
4668
Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
4669
returns.  For machines which must pop arguments after a function call,
4670
the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
4671
function calls and pops them all at once.
4672
 
4673
Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4674
 
4675
@item -fforce-mem
4676
@opindex fforce-mem
4677
Force memory operands to be copied into registers before doing
4678
arithmetic on them.  This produces better code by making all memory
4679
references potential common subexpressions.  When they are not common
4680
subexpressions, instruction combination should eliminate the separate
4681
register-load. This option is now a nop and will be removed in 4.3.
4682
 
4683
@item -fforce-addr
4684
@opindex fforce-addr
4685
Force memory address constants to be copied into registers before
4686
doing arithmetic on them.
4687
 
4688
@item -fomit-frame-pointer
4689
@opindex fomit-frame-pointer
4690
Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
4691
don't need one.  This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
4692
restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
4693
in many functions.  @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
4694
some machines.}
4695
 
4696
On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
4697
the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
4698
and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist.  The
4699
machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
4700
whether a target machine supports this flag.  @xref{Registers,,Register
4701
Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
4702
 
4703
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4704
 
4705
@item -foptimize-sibling-calls
4706
@opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
4707
Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
4708
 
4709
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4710
 
4711
@item -fno-inline
4712
@opindex fno-inline
4713
Don't pay attention to the @code{inline} keyword.  Normally this option
4714
is used to keep the compiler from expanding any functions inline.
4715
Note that if you are not optimizing, no functions can be expanded inline.
4716
 
4717
@item -finline-functions
4718
@opindex finline-functions
4719
Integrate all simple functions into their callers.  The compiler
4720
heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth
4721
integrating in this way.
4722
 
4723
If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
4724
declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
4725
assembler code in its own right.
4726
 
4727
Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
4728
 
4729
@item -finline-functions-called-once
4730
@opindex finline-functions-called-once
4731
Consider all @code{static} functions called once for inlining into their
4732
caller even if they are not marked @code{inline}.  If a call to a given
4733
function is integrated, then the function is not output as assembler code
4734
in its own right.
4735
 
4736
Enabled if @option{-funit-at-a-time} is enabled.
4737
 
4738
@item -fearly-inlining
4739
@opindex fearly-inlining
4740
Inline functions marked by @code{always_inline} and functions whose body seems
4741
smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
4742
@option{-fprofile-generate} instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
4743
makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs
4744
having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
4745
 
4746
Enabled by default.
4747
 
4748
@item -finline-limit=@var{n}
4749
@opindex finline-limit
4750
By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag
4751
allows the control of this limit for functions that are explicitly marked as
4752
inline (i.e., marked with the inline keyword or defined within the class
4753
definition in c++).  @var{n} is the size of functions that can be inlined in
4754
number of pseudo instructions (not counting parameter handling).  The default
4755
value of @var{n} is 600.
4756
Increasing this value can result in more inlined code at
4757
the cost of compilation time and memory consumption.  Decreasing usually makes
4758
the compilation faster and less code will be inlined (which presumably
4759
means slower programs).  This option is particularly useful for programs that
4760
use inlining heavily such as those based on recursive templates with C++.
4761
 
4762
Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may be
4763
specified individually by using @option{--param @var{name}=@var{value}}.
4764
The @option{-finline-limit=@var{n}} option sets some of these parameters
4765
as follows:
4766
 
4767
@table @gcctabopt
4768
@item max-inline-insns-single
4769
 is set to @var{n}/2.
4770
@item max-inline-insns-auto
4771
 is set to @var{n}/2.
4772
@item min-inline-insns
4773
 is set to 130 or @var{n}/4, whichever is smaller.
4774
@item max-inline-insns-rtl
4775
 is set to @var{n}.
4776
@end table
4777
 
4778
See below for a documentation of the individual
4779
parameters controlling inlining.
4780
 
4781
@emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
4782
abstract measurement of function's size.  In no way does it represent a count
4783
of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
4784
release to an another.
4785
 
4786
@item -fkeep-inline-functions
4787
@opindex fkeep-inline-functions
4788
In C, emit @code{static} functions that are declared @code{inline}
4789
into the object file, even if the function has been inlined into all
4790
of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions using the
4791
@code{extern inline} extension in GNU C@.  In C++, emit any and all
4792
inline functions into the object file.
4793
 
4794
@item -fkeep-static-consts
4795
@opindex fkeep-static-consts
4796
Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
4797
on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
4798
 
4799
GCC enables this option by default.  If you want to force the compiler to
4800
check if the variable was referenced, regardless of whether or not
4801
optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
4802
 
4803
@item -fmerge-constants
4804
Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating point
4805
constants) across compilation units.
4806
 
4807
This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
4808
linker support it.  Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
4809
behavior.
4810
 
4811
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4812
 
4813
@item -fmerge-all-constants
4814
Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
4815
 
4816
This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}.  In addition to
4817
@option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g.@: even constant initialized
4818
arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating point
4819
types.  Languages like C or C++ require each non-automatic variable to
4820
have distinct location, so using this option will result in non-conforming
4821
behavior.
4822
 
4823
@item -fmodulo-sched
4824
@opindex fmodulo-sched
4825
Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling
4826
pass.  This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders their
4827
instructions by overlapping different iterations.
4828
 
4829
@item -fno-branch-count-reg
4830
@opindex fno-branch-count-reg
4831
Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
4832
but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
4833
register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
4834
This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
4835
instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
4836
 
4837
The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}.
4838
 
4839
@item -fno-function-cse
4840
@opindex fno-function-cse
4841
Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
4842
calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
4843
 
4844
This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
4845
that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
4846
performed when this option is not used.
4847
 
4848
The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
4849
 
4850
@item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
4851
@opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
4852
If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
4853
are initialized to zero into BSS@.  This can save space in the resulting
4854
code.
4855
 
4856
This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
4857
rely on variables going to the data section.  E.g., so that the
4858
resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
4859
assumptions based on that.
4860
 
4861
The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
4862
 
4863
@item -fbounds-check
4864
@opindex fbounds-check
4865
For front-ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
4866
indices used to access arrays are within the declared range.  This is
4867
currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front-ends, where
4868
this option defaults to true and false respectively.
4869
 
4870
@item -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir
4871
@opindex fmudflap
4872
@opindex fmudflapth
4873
@opindex fmudflapir
4874
@cindex bounds checking
4875
@cindex mudflap
4876
For front-ends that support it (C and C++), instrument all risky
4877
pointer/array dereferencing operations, some standard library
4878
string/heap functions, and some other associated constructs with
4879
range/validity tests.  Modules so instrumented should be immune to
4880
buffer overflows, invalid heap use, and some other classes of C/C++
4881
programming errors.  The instrumentation relies on a separate runtime
4882
library (@file{libmudflap}), which will be linked into a program if
4883
@option{-fmudflap} is given at link time.  Run-time behavior of the
4884
instrumented program is controlled by the @env{MUDFLAP_OPTIONS}
4885
environment variable.  See @code{env MUDFLAP_OPTIONS=-help a.out}
4886
for its options.
4887
 
4888
Use @option{-fmudflapth} instead of @option{-fmudflap} to compile and to
4889
link if your program is multi-threaded.  Use @option{-fmudflapir}, in
4890
addition to @option{-fmudflap} or @option{-fmudflapth}, if
4891
instrumentation should ignore pointer reads.  This produces less
4892
instrumentation (and therefore faster execution) and still provides
4893
some protection against outright memory corrupting writes, but allows
4894
erroneously read data to propagate within a program.
4895
 
4896
@item -fthread-jumps
4897
@opindex fthread-jumps
4898
Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a
4899
location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found.  If
4900
so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
4901
second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
4902
the condition is known to be true or false.
4903
 
4904
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4905
 
4906
@item -fcse-follow-jumps
4907
@opindex fcse-follow-jumps
4908
In common subexpression elimination, scan through jump instructions
4909
when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path.  For
4910
example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
4911
@code{else} clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition
4912
tested is false.
4913
 
4914
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4915
 
4916
@item -fcse-skip-blocks
4917
@opindex fcse-skip-blocks
4918
This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
4919
follow jumps which conditionally skip over blocks.  When CSE
4920
encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
4921
@option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
4922
body of the @code{if}.
4923
 
4924
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4925
 
4926
@item -frerun-cse-after-loop
4927
@opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
4928
Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been
4929
performed.
4930
 
4931
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4932
 
4933
@item -fgcse
4934
@opindex fgcse
4935
Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
4936
This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
4937
 
4938
@emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
4939
extension, you may get better runtime performance if you disable
4940
the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
4941
@option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
4942
 
4943
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4944
 
4945
@item -fgcse-lm
4946
@opindex fgcse-lm
4947
When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will
4948
attempt to move loads which are only killed by stores into themselves.  This
4949
allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
4950
the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
4951
 
4952
Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
4953
 
4954
@item -fgcse-sm
4955
@opindex fgcse-sm
4956
When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, a store motion pass is run after
4957
global common subexpression elimination.  This pass will attempt to move
4958
stores out of loops.  When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm},
4959
loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before
4960
the loop and a store after the loop.
4961
 
4962
Not enabled at any optimization level.
4963
 
4964
@item -fgcse-las
4965
@opindex fgcse-las
4966
When @option{-fgcse-las} is enabled, the global common subexpression
4967
elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores to the
4968
same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
4969
 
4970
Not enabled at any optimization level.
4971
 
4972
@item -fgcse-after-reload
4973
@opindex fgcse-after-reload
4974
When @option{-fgcse-after-reload} is enabled, a redundant load elimination
4975
pass is performed after reload.  The purpose of this pass is to cleanup
4976
redundant spilling.
4977
 
4978
@item -funsafe-loop-optimizations
4979
@opindex funsafe-loop-optimizations
4980
If given, the loop optimizer will assume that loop indices do not
4981
overflow, and that the loops with nontrivial exit condition are not
4982
infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
4983
the loop optimizer itself cannot prove that these assumptions are valid.
4984
Using @option{-Wunsafe-loop-optimizations}, the compiler will warn you
4985
if it finds this kind of loop.
4986
 
4987
@item -fcrossjumping
4988
@opindex crossjumping
4989
Perform cross-jumping transformation.  This transformation unifies equivalent code and save code size.  The
4990
resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
4991
 
4992
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
4993
 
4994
@item -fif-conversion
4995
@opindex if-conversion
4996
Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.  This
4997
include use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
4998
some tricks doable by standard arithmetics.  The use of conditional execution
4999
on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
5000
 
5001
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5002
 
5003
@item -fif-conversion2
5004
@opindex if-conversion2
5005
Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
5006
branch-less equivalents.
5007
 
5008
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5009
 
5010
@item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
5011
@opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
5012
Use global dataflow analysis to identify and eliminate useless checks
5013
for null pointers.  The compiler assumes that dereferencing a null
5014
pointer would have halted the program.  If a pointer is checked after
5015
it has already been dereferenced, it cannot be null.
5016
 
5017
In some environments, this assumption is not true, and programs can
5018
safely dereference null pointers.  Use
5019
@option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
5020
for programs which depend on that behavior.
5021
 
5022
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5023
 
5024
@item -fexpensive-optimizations
5025
@opindex fexpensive-optimizations
5026
Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
5027
 
5028
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5029
 
5030
@item -foptimize-register-move
5031
@itemx -fregmove
5032
@opindex foptimize-register-move
5033
@opindex fregmove
5034
Attempt to reassign register numbers in move instructions and as
5035
operands of other simple instructions in order to maximize the amount of
5036
register tying.  This is especially helpful on machines with two-operand
5037
instructions.
5038
 
5039
Note @option{-fregmove} and @option{-foptimize-register-move} are the same
5040
optimization.
5041
 
5042
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5043
 
5044
@item -fdelayed-branch
5045
@opindex fdelayed-branch
5046
If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
5047
to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
5048
instructions.
5049
 
5050
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5051
 
5052
@item -fschedule-insns
5053
@opindex fschedule-insns
5054
If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
5055
eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable.  This
5056
helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
5057
by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
5058
or floating point instruction is required.
5059
 
5060
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5061
 
5062
@item -fschedule-insns2
5063
@opindex fschedule-insns2
5064
Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
5065
instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done.  This is
5066
especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
5067
registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
5068
 
5069
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5070
 
5071
@item -fno-sched-interblock
5072
@opindex fno-sched-interblock
5073
Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally
5074
enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
5075
with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5076
 
5077
@item -fno-sched-spec
5078
@opindex fno-sched-spec
5079
Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally
5080
enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
5081
with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5082
 
5083
@item -fsched-spec-load
5084
@opindex fsched-spec-load
5085
Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes
5086
sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
5087
@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5088
 
5089
@item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
5090
@opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
5091
Allow speculative motion of more load instructions.  This only makes
5092
sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
5093
@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5094
 
5095
@item -fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n}
5096
@opindex fsched-stalled-insns
5097
Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue
5098
of stalled insns into the ready list, during the second scheduling pass.
5099
 
5100
@item -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n}
5101
@opindex fsched-stalled-insns-dep
5102
Define how many insn groups (cycles) will be examined for a dependency
5103
on a stalled insn that is candidate for premature removal from the queue
5104
of stalled insns.  Has an effect only during the second scheduling pass,
5105
and only if @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} is used and its value is not zero.
5106
 
5107
@item -fsched2-use-superblocks
5108
@opindex fsched2-use-superblocks
5109
When scheduling after register allocation, do use superblock scheduling
5110
algorithm.  Superblock scheduling allows motion across basic block boundaries
5111
resulting on faster schedules.  This option is experimental, as not all machine
5112
descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable
5113
results from the algorithm.
5114
 
5115
This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
5116
@option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5117
 
5118
@item -fsched2-use-traces
5119
@opindex fsched2-use-traces
5120
Use @option{-fsched2-use-superblocks} algorithm when scheduling after register
5121
allocation and additionally perform code duplication in order to increase the
5122
size of superblocks using tracer pass.  See @option{-ftracer} for details on
5123
trace formation.
5124
 
5125
This mode should produce faster but significantly longer programs.  Also
5126
without @option{-fbranch-probabilities} the traces constructed may not
5127
match the reality and hurt the performance.  This only makes
5128
sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
5129
@option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
5130
 
5131
@item -fsee
5132
@opindex fsee
5133
Eliminates redundant extension instructions and move the non redundant
5134
ones to optimal placement using LCM.
5135
 
5136
@item -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
5137
@opindex fscheduling-in-modulo-scheduled-loops
5138
The modulo scheduling comes before the traditional scheduling, if a loop was modulo scheduled
5139
we may want to prevent the later scheduling passes from changing its schedule, we use this
5140
option to control that.
5141
 
5142
@item -fcaller-saves
5143
@opindex fcaller-saves
5144
Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered by
5145
function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
5146
registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only when it
5147
seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.
5148
 
5149
This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
5150
those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
5151
 
5152
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5153
 
5154
@item -ftree-pre
5155
Perform Partial Redundancy Elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is
5156
enabled by default at @option{-O2} and @option{-O3}.
5157
 
5158
@item -ftree-fre
5159
Perform Full Redundancy Elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference
5160
between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions
5161
that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.
5162
This analysis faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
5163
This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5164
 
5165
@item -ftree-copy-prop
5166
Perform copy propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary
5167
copy operations.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
5168
higher.
5169
 
5170
@item -ftree-store-copy-prop
5171
Perform copy propagation of memory loads and stores.  This pass
5172
eliminates unnecessary copy operations in memory references
5173
(structures, global variables, arrays, etc).  This flag is enabled by
5174
default at @option{-O2} and higher.
5175
 
5176
@item -ftree-salias
5177
Perform structural alias analysis on trees.  This flag
5178
is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5179
 
5180
@item -fipa-pta
5181
Perform interprocedural pointer analysis.
5182
 
5183
@item -ftree-sink
5184
Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is
5185
enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5186
 
5187
@item -ftree-ccp
5188
Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.  This
5189
pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
5190
at @option{-O} and higher.
5191
 
5192
@item -ftree-store-ccp
5193
Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.  This
5194
pass operates on both local scalar variables and memory stores and
5195
loads (global variables, structures, arrays, etc).  This flag is
5196
enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.
5197
 
5198
@item -ftree-dce
5199
Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by
5200
default at @option{-O} and higher.
5201
 
5202
@item -ftree-dominator-opts
5203
Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
5204
propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and expression
5205
simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This also
5206
performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is
5207
enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5208
 
5209
@item -ftree-ch
5210
Perform loop header copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases
5211
effectiveness of code motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag
5212
is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.  It is not enabled
5213
for @option{-Os}, since it usually increases code size.
5214
 
5215
@item -ftree-loop-optimize
5216
Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
5217
at @option{-O} and higher.
5218
 
5219
@item -ftree-loop-linear
5220
Perform linear loop transformations on tree.  This flag can improve cache
5221
performance and allow further loop optimizations to take place.
5222
 
5223
@item -ftree-loop-im
5224
Perform loop invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that
5225
would be hard to handle at RTL level (function calls, operations that expand to
5226
nontrivial sequences of insns).  With @option{-funswitch-loops} it also moves
5227
operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we can use
5228
just trivial invariantness analysis in loop unswitching.  The pass also includes
5229
store motion.
5230
 
5231
@item -ftree-loop-ivcanon
5232
Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in the loop for that
5233
determining number of iterations requires complicated analysis.  Later
5234
optimizations then may determine the number easily.  Useful especially
5235
in connection with unrolling.
5236
 
5237
@item -fivopts
5238
Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction, induction
5239
variable merging and induction variable elimination) on trees.
5240
 
5241
@item -ftree-sra
5242
Perform scalar replacement of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure
5243
references with scalars to prevent committing structures to memory too
5244
early.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5245
 
5246
@item -ftree-copyrename
5247
Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler
5248
temporaries to other variables at copy locations, usually resulting in
5249
variable names which more closely resemble the original variables.  This flag
5250
is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5251
 
5252
@item -ftree-ter
5253
Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal phase.  Single
5254
use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use location with their
5255
defining expression.  This results in non-GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders
5256
much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL generation.  This is
5257
enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5258
 
5259
@item -ftree-lrs
5260
Perform live range splitting during the SSA->normal phase.  Distinct live
5261
ranges of a variable are split into unique variables, allowing for better
5262
optimization later.  This is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
5263
 
5264
@item -ftree-vectorize
5265
Perform loop vectorization on trees.
5266
 
5267
@item -ftree-vect-loop-version
5268
@opindex ftree-vect-loop-version
5269
Perform loop versioning when doing loop vectorization on trees.  When a loop
5270
appears to be vectorizable except that data alignment or data dependence cannot
5271
be determined at compile time then vectorized and non-vectorized versions of
5272
the loop are generated along with runtime checks for alignment or dependence
5273
to control which version is executed.  This option is enabled by default
5274
except at level @option{-Os} where it is disabled.
5275
 
5276
@item -ftree-vrp
5277
Perform Value Range Propagation on trees.  This is similar to the
5278
constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values are
5279
propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary range
5280
checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is
5281
enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  Null pointer check
5282
elimination is only done if @option{-fdelete-null-pointer-checks} is
5283
enabled.
5284
 
5285
@item -ftracer
5286
@opindex ftracer
5287
Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
5288
simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
5289
better job.
5290
 
5291
@item -funroll-loops
5292
@opindex funroll-loops
5293
Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
5294
time or upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
5295
@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}.  This option makes code larger,
5296
and may or may not make it run faster.
5297
 
5298
@item -funroll-all-loops
5299
@opindex funroll-all-loops
5300
Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
5301
the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
5302
@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
5303
@option{-funroll-loops},
5304
 
5305
@item -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
5306
@opindex fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
5307
Enables expressing of values of induction variables in later iterations
5308
of the unrolled loop using the value in the first iteration.  This breaks
5309
long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of the scheduling passes.
5310
 
5311
Combination of @option{-fweb} and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
5312
same effect.  However in cases the loop body is more complicated than
5313
a single basic block, this is not reliable.  It also does not work at all
5314
on some of the architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.
5315
 
5316
This optimization is enabled by default.
5317
 
5318
@item -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
5319
@opindex fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
5320
With this option, the compiler will create multiple copies of some
5321
local variables when unrolling a loop which can result in superior code.
5322
 
5323
@item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
5324
@opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
5325
If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
5326
memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
5327
 
5328
This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
5329
dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
5330
 
5331
Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
5332
 
5333
@item -fno-peephole
5334
@itemx -fno-peephole2
5335
@opindex fno-peephole
5336
@opindex fno-peephole2
5337
Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations.  The difference
5338
between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
5339
are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
5340
other, a few use both.
5341
 
5342
@option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
5343
@option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5344
 
5345
@item -fno-guess-branch-probability
5346
@opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
5347
Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
5348
 
5349
GCC will use heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are
5350
not provided by profiling feedback (@option{-fprofile-arcs}).  These
5351
heuristics are based on the control flow graph.  If some branch probabilities
5352
are specified by @samp{__builtin_expect}, then the heuristics will be
5353
used to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph,
5354
taking the @samp{__builtin_expect} info into account.  The interactions
5355
between the heuristics and @samp{__builtin_expect} can be complex, and in
5356
some cases, it may be useful to disable the heuristics so that the effects
5357
of @samp{__builtin_expect} are easier to understand.
5358
 
5359
The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
5360
@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5361
 
5362
@item -freorder-blocks
5363
@opindex freorder-blocks
5364
Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
5365
taken branches and improve code locality.
5366
 
5367
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
5368
 
5369
@item -freorder-blocks-and-partition
5370
@opindex freorder-blocks-and-partition
5371
In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order
5372
to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks
5373
into separate sections of the assembly and .o files, to improve
5374
paging and cache locality performance.
5375
 
5376
This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
5377
exception handling, for linkonce sections, for functions with a user-defined
5378
section attribute and on any architecture that does not support named
5379
sections.
5380
 
5381
@item -freorder-functions
5382
@opindex freorder-functions
5383
Reorder functions in the object file in order to
5384
improve code locality.  This is implemented by using special
5385
subsections @code{.text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
5386
@code{.text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions.  Reordering is done by
5387
the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
5388
place them in a reasonable way.
5389
 
5390
Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option effective.  See
5391
@option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
5392
 
5393
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5394
 
5395
@item -fstrict-aliasing
5396
@opindex fstrict-aliasing
5397
Allows the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
5398
the language being compiled.  For C (and C++), this activates
5399
optimizations based on the type of expressions.  In particular, an
5400
object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
5401
object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same.  For
5402
example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
5403
@code{void*} or a @code{double}.  A character type may alias any other
5404
type.
5405
 
5406
Pay special attention to code like this:
5407
@smallexample
5408
union a_union @{
5409
  int i;
5410
  double d;
5411
@};
5412
 
5413
int f() @{
5414
  a_union t;
5415
  t.d = 3.0;
5416
  return t.i;
5417
@}
5418
@end smallexample
5419
The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
5420
recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common.  Even with
5421
@option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
5422
is accessed through the union type.  So, the code above will work as
5423
expected.  However, this code might not:
5424
@smallexample
5425
int f() @{
5426
  a_union t;
5427
  int* ip;
5428
  t.d = 3.0;
5429
  ip = &t.i;
5430
  return *ip;
5431
@}
5432
@end smallexample
5433
 
5434
Every language that wishes to perform language-specific alias analysis
5435
should define a function that computes, given an @code{tree}
5436
node, an alias set for the node.  Nodes in different alias sets are not
5437
allowed to alias.  For an example, see the C front-end function
5438
@code{c_get_alias_set}.
5439
 
5440
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5441
 
5442
@item -fstrict-overflow
5443
@opindex fstrict-overflow
5444
Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending
5445
on the language being compiled.  For C (and C++) this means that
5446
overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined, which
5447
means that the compiler may assume that it will not happen.  This
5448
permits various optimizations.  For example, the compiler will assume
5449
that an expression like @code{i + 10 > i} will always be true for
5450
signed @code{i}.  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is
5451
undefined, as the expression is false if @code{i + 10} overflows when
5452
using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is in effect any
5453
attempt to determine whether an operation on signed numbers will
5454
overflow must be written carefully to not actually involve overflow.
5455
 
5456
See also the @option{-fwrapv} option.  Using @option{-fwrapv} means
5457
that signed overflow is fully defined: it wraps.  When
5458
@option{-fwrapv} is used, there is no difference between
5459
@option{-fstrict-overflow} and @option{-fno-strict-overflow}.  With
5460
@option{-fwrapv} certain types of overflow are permitted.  For
5461
example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing arithmetic on
5462
constants, the overflowed value can still be used with
5463
@option{-fwrapv}, but not otherwise.
5464
 
5465
The @option{-fstrict-overflow} option is enabled at levels
5466
@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5467
 
5468
@item -falign-functions
5469
@itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
5470
@opindex falign-functions
5471
Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
5472
@var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes.  For instance,
5473
@option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
5474
boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} would align to the next
5475
32-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
5476
 
5477
@option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
5478
equivalent and mean that functions will not be aligned.
5479
 
5480
Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
5481
in that case, it is rounded up.
5482
 
5483
If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
5484
 
5485
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
5486
 
5487
@item -falign-labels
5488
@itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
5489
@opindex falign-labels
5490
Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
5491
@var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  This option can easily
5492
make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
5493
branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
5494
 
5495
@option{-fno-align-labels} and @option{-falign-labels=1} are
5496
equivalent and mean that labels will not be aligned.
5497
 
5498
If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
5499
are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
5500
 
5501
If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
5502
which is very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
5503
 
5504
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
5505
 
5506
@item -falign-loops
5507
@itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
5508
@opindex falign-loops
5509
Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
5510
like @option{-falign-functions}.  The hope is that the loop will be
5511
executed many times, which will make up for any execution of the dummy
5512
operations.
5513
 
5514
@option{-fno-align-loops} and @option{-falign-loops=1} are
5515
equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
5516
 
5517
If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
5518
 
5519
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
5520
 
5521
@item -falign-jumps
5522
@itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
5523
@opindex falign-jumps
5524
Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
5525
where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
5526
bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  In this case, no dummy operations
5527
need be executed.
5528
 
5529
@option{-fno-align-jumps} and @option{-falign-jumps=1} are
5530
equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
5531
 
5532
If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
5533
 
5534
Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
5535
 
5536
@item -funit-at-a-time
5537
@opindex funit-at-a-time
5538
Parse the whole compilation unit before starting to produce code.
5539
This allows some extra optimizations to take place but consumes
5540
more memory (in general).  There are some compatibility issues
5541
with @emph{unit-at-a-time} mode:
5542
@itemize @bullet
5543
@item
5544
enabling @emph{unit-at-a-time} mode may change the order
5545
in which functions, variables, and top-level @code{asm} statements
5546
are emitted, and will likely break code relying on some particular
5547
ordering.  The majority of such top-level @code{asm} statements,
5548
though, can be replaced by @code{section} attributes.  The
5549
@option{fno-toplevel-reorder} option may be used to keep the ordering
5550
used in the input file, at the cost of some optimizations.
5551
 
5552
@item
5553
@emph{unit-at-a-time} mode removes unreferenced static variables
5554
and functions.  This may result in undefined references
5555
when an @code{asm} statement refers directly to variables or functions
5556
that are otherwise unused.  In that case either the variable/function
5557
shall be listed as an operand of the @code{asm} statement operand or,
5558
in the case of top-level @code{asm} statements the attribute @code{used}
5559
shall be used on the declaration.
5560
 
5561
@item
5562
Static functions now can use non-standard passing conventions that
5563
may break @code{asm} statements calling functions directly.  Again,
5564
attribute @code{used} will prevent this behavior.
5565
@end itemize
5566
 
5567
As a temporary workaround, @option{-fno-unit-at-a-time} can be used,
5568
but this scheme may not be supported by future releases of GCC@.
5569
 
5570
Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5571
 
5572
@item -fno-toplevel-reorder
5573
Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and @code{asm}
5574
statements.  Output them in the same order that they appear in the
5575
input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables
5576
will not be removed.  This option is intended to support existing code
5577
which relies on a particular ordering.  For new code, it is better to
5578
use attributes.
5579
 
5580
@item -fweb
5581
@opindex fweb
5582
Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes and assign
5583
each web individual pseudo register.  This allows the register allocation pass
5584
to operate on pseudos directly, but also strengthens several other optimization
5585
passes, such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code remover.  It can,
5586
however, make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a
5587
``home register''.
5588
 
5589
Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
5590
 
5591
@item -fwhole-program
5592
@opindex fwhole-program
5593
Assume that the current compilation unit represents whole program being
5594
compiled.  All public functions and variables with the exception of @code{main}
5595
and those merged by attribute @code{externally_visible} become static functions
5596
and in a affect gets more aggressively optimized by interprocedural optimizers.
5597
While this option is equivalent to proper use of @code{static} keyword for
5598
programs consisting of single file, in combination with option
5599
@option{--combine} this flag can be used to compile most of smaller scale C
5600
programs since the functions and variables become local for the whole combined
5601
compilation unit, not for the single source file itself.
5602
 
5603
 
5604
@item -fno-cprop-registers
5605
@opindex fno-cprop-registers
5606
After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
5607
we perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
5608
and occasionally eliminate the copy.
5609
 
5610
Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
5611
 
5612
@item -fprofile-generate
5613
@opindex fprofile-generate
5614
 
5615
Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to produce
5616
profile useful for later recompilation with profile feedback based
5617
optimization.  You must use @option{-fprofile-generate} both when
5618
compiling and when linking your program.
5619
 
5620
The following options are enabled: @code{-fprofile-arcs}, @code{-fprofile-values}, @code{-fvpt}.
5621
 
5622
@item -fprofile-use
5623
@opindex fprofile-use
5624
Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and optimizations
5625
generally profitable only with profile feedback available.
5626
 
5627
The following options are enabled: @code{-fbranch-probabilities}, @code{-fvpt},
5628
@code{-funroll-loops}, @code{-fpeel-loops}, @code{-ftracer}
5629
 
5630
@end table
5631
 
5632
The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating
5633
point arithmetic.  These options trade off between speed and
5634
correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.
5635
 
5636
@table @gcctabopt
5637
@item -ffloat-store
5638
@opindex ffloat-store
5639
Do not store floating point variables in registers, and inhibit other
5640
options that might change whether a floating point value is taken from a
5641
register or memory.
5642
 
5643
@cindex floating point precision
5644
This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
5645
the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
5646
precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have.  Similarly for the
5647
x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only
5648
good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
5649
point.  Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
5650
them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
5651
 
5652
@item -ffast-math
5653
@opindex ffast-math
5654
Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations}, @*
5655
@option{-fno-trapping-math}, @option{-ffinite-math-only},
5656
@option{-fno-rounding-math}, @option{-fno-signaling-nans}
5657
and @option{fcx-limited-range}.
5658
 
5659
This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
5660
 
5661
This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
5662
it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
5663
an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
5664
math functions.
5665
 
5666
@item -fno-math-errno
5667
@opindex fno-math-errno
5668
Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed
5669
with a single instruction, e.g., sqrt.  A program that relies on
5670
IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
5671
for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
5672
 
5673
This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
5674
it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
5675
an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
5676
math functions.
5677
 
5678
The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
5679
 
5680
On Darwin systems, the math library never sets @code{errno}.  There is therefore
5681
no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility that it might,
5682
and @option{-fno-math-errno} is the default.
5683
 
5684
@item -funsafe-math-optimizations
5685
@opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
5686
Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
5687
that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
5688
ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may include libraries
5689
or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
5690
similar optimizations.
5691
 
5692
This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
5693
it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
5694
an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
5695
math functions.
5696
 
5697
The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
5698
 
5699
@item -ffinite-math-only
5700
@opindex ffinite-math-only
5701
Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
5702
that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
5703
 
5704
This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
5705
it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
5706
an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications.
5707
 
5708
The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
5709
 
5710
@item -fno-trapping-math
5711
@opindex fno-trapping-math
5712
Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
5713
user-visible traps.  These traps include division by zero, overflow,
5714
underflow, inexact result and invalid operation.  This option implies
5715
@option{-fno-signaling-nans}.  Setting this option may allow faster
5716
code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
5717
 
5718
This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
5719
it can result in incorrect output for programs which depend on
5720
an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
5721
math functions.
5722
 
5723
The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
5724
 
5725
@item -frounding-math
5726
@opindex frounding-math
5727
Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating
5728
point rounding behavior.  This is round-to-zero for all floating point
5729
to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all other arithmetic
5730
truncations.  This option should be specified for programs that change
5731
the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a
5732
non-default rounding mode.  This option disables constant folding of
5733
floating point expressions at compile-time (which may be affected by
5734
rounding mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe in the
5735
presence of sign-dependent rounding modes.
5736
 
5737
The default is @option{-fno-rounding-math}.
5738
 
5739
This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
5740
disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
5741
Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
5742
using C99's @code{FENV_ACCESS} pragma.  This command line option
5743
will be used to specify the default state for @code{FENV_ACCESS}.
5744
 
5745
@item -frtl-abstract-sequences
5746
@opindex frtl-abstract-sequences
5747
It is a size optimization method. This option is to find identical
5748
sequences of code, which can be turned into pseudo-procedures  and
5749
then  replace  all  occurrences with  calls to  the  newly created
5750
subroutine. It is kind of an opposite of @option{-finline-functions}.
5751
This optimization runs at RTL level.
5752
 
5753
@item -fsignaling-nans
5754
@opindex fsignaling-nans
5755
Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
5756
traps during floating-point operations.  Setting this option disables
5757
optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
5758
signaling NaNs.  This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
5759
 
5760
This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
5761
be defined.
5762
 
5763
The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
5764
 
5765
This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
5766
disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
5767
 
5768
@item -fsingle-precision-constant
5769
@opindex fsingle-precision-constant
5770
Treat floating point constant as single precision constant instead of
5771
implicitly converting it to double precision constant.
5772
 
5773
@item -fcx-limited-range
5774
@itemx -fno-cx-limited-range
5775
@opindex fcx-limited-range
5776
@opindex fno-cx-limited-range
5777
When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
5778
needed when performing complex division.  The default is
5779
@option{-fno-cx-limited-range}, but is enabled by @option{-ffast-math}.
5780
 
5781
This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
5782
@code{CX_LIMITED_RANGE} pragma.  Nevertheless, the option applies to
5783
all languages.
5784
 
5785
@end table
5786
 
5787
The following options control optimizations that may improve
5788
performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options.  This
5789
section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
5790
 
5791
@table @gcctabopt
5792
@item -fbranch-probabilities
5793
@opindex fbranch-probabilities
5794
After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5795
(@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
5796
@command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
5797
@option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
5798
the number of times each branch was taken.  When the program
5799
compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits it saves arc execution
5800
counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.gcda} for each source
5801
file  The information in this data file is very dependent on the
5802
structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
5803
and the same optimization options for both compilations.
5804
 
5805
With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a
5806
@samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
5807
These can be used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only
5808
used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
5809
branch is mostly to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
5810
exactly determine which path is taken more often.
5811
 
5812
@item -fprofile-values
5813
@opindex fprofile-values
5814
If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it adds code so that some
5815
data about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
5816
 
5817
With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
5818
from profiling values of expressions and adds @samp{REG_VALUE_PROFILE}
5819
notes to instructions for their later usage in optimizations.
5820
 
5821
Enabled with @option{-fprofile-generate} and @option{-fprofile-use}.
5822
 
5823
@item -fvpt
5824
@opindex fvpt
5825
If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it instructs the compiler to add
5826
a code to gather information about values of expressions.
5827
 
5828
With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
5829
and actually performs the optimizations based on them.
5830
Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operation
5831
using the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
5832
 
5833
@item -frename-registers
5834
@opindex frename-registers
5835
Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
5836
of registers left over after register allocation.  This optimization
5837
will most benefit processors with lots of registers.  Depending on the
5838
debug information format adopted by the target, however, it can
5839
make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in
5840
a ``home register''.
5841
 
5842
Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
5843
 
5844
@item -ftracer
5845
@opindex ftracer
5846
Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
5847
simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
5848
better job.
5849
 
5850
Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
5851
 
5852
@item -funroll-loops
5853
@opindex funroll-loops
5854
Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or
5855
upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
5856
@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}, @option{-fweb} and @option{-frename-registers}.
5857
It also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with
5858
small constant number of iterations).  This option makes code larger, and may
5859
or may not make it run faster.
5860
 
5861
Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
5862
 
5863
@item -funroll-all-loops
5864
@opindex funroll-all-loops
5865
Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
5866
the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
5867
@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
5868
@option{-funroll-loops}.
5869
 
5870
@item -fpeel-loops
5871
@opindex fpeel-loops
5872
Peels the loops for that there is enough information that they do not
5873
roll much (from profile feedback).  It also turns on complete loop peeling
5874
(i.e.@: complete removal of loops with small constant number of iterations).
5875
 
5876
Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
5877
 
5878
@item -fmove-loop-invariants
5879
@opindex fmove-loop-invariants
5880
Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled
5881
at level @option{-O1}
5882
 
5883
@item -funswitch-loops
5884
@opindex funswitch-loops
5885
Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates
5886
of the loop on both branches (modified according to result of the condition).
5887
 
5888
@item -ffunction-sections
5889
@itemx -fdata-sections
5890
@opindex ffunction-sections
5891
@opindex fdata-sections
5892
Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
5893
file if the target supports arbitrary sections.  The name of the
5894
function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
5895
in the output file.
5896
 
5897
Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
5898
to improve locality of reference in the instruction space.  Most systems
5899
using the ELF object format and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
5900
linkers with such optimizations.  AIX may have these optimizations in
5901
the future.
5902
 
5903
Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
5904
so.  When you specify these options, the assembler and linker will
5905
create larger object and executable files and will also be slower.
5906
You will not be able to use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
5907
specify this option and you may have problems with debugging if
5908
you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
5909
 
5910
@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize
5911
@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize
5912
Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue
5913
threading.
5914
The use of target registers can typically be exposed only during reload,
5915
thus hoisting loads out of loops and doing inter-block scheduling needs
5916
a separate optimization pass.
5917
 
5918
@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
5919
@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize2
5920
Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue
5921
threading.
5922
 
5923
@item -fbtr-bb-exclusive
5924
@opindex fbtr-bb-exclusive
5925
When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse
5926
branch target registers in within any basic block.
5927
 
5928
@item -fstack-protector
5929
Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack smashing
5930
attacks.  This is done by adding a guard variable to functions with
5931
vulnerable objects.  This includes functions that call alloca, and
5932
functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized
5933
when a function is entered and then checked when the function exits.
5934
If a guard check fails, an error message is printed and the program exits.
5935
 
5936
@item -fstack-protector-all
5937
Like @option{-fstack-protector} except that all functions are protected.
5938
 
5939
@item -fsection-anchors
5940
@opindex fsection-anchors
5941
Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
5942
shared ``anchor'' symbols to address nearby objects.  This transformation
5943
can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on some
5944
targets.
5945
 
5946
For example, the implementation of the following function @code{foo}:
5947
 
5948
@smallexample
5949
static int a, b, c;
5950
int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5951
@end smallexample
5952
 
5953
would usually calculate the addresses of all three variables, but if you
5954
compile it with @option{-fsection-anchors}, it will access the variables
5955
from a common anchor point instead.  The effect is similar to the
5956
following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
5957
 
5958
@smallexample
5959
int foo (void)
5960
@{
5961
  register int *xr = &x;
5962
  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5963
@}
5964
@end smallexample
5965
 
5966
Not all targets support this option.
5967
 
5968
@item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
5969
@opindex param
5970
In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
5971
optimization that is done.  For example, GCC will not inline functions
5972
that contain more that a certain number of instructions.  You can
5973
control some of these constants on the command-line using the
5974
@option{--param} option.
5975
 
5976
The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are
5977
tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to change
5978
without notice in future releases.
5979
 
5980
In each case, the @var{value} is an integer.  The allowable choices for
5981
@var{name} are given in the following table:
5982
 
5983
@table @gcctabopt
5984
@item salias-max-implicit-fields
5985
The maximum number of fields in a variable without direct
5986
structure accesses for which structure aliasing will consider trying
5987
to track each field.  The default is 5
5988
 
5989
@item salias-max-array-elements
5990
The maximum number of elements an array can have and its elements
5991
still be tracked individually by structure aliasing. The default is 4
5992
 
5993
@item sra-max-structure-size
5994
The maximum structure size, in bytes, at which the scalar replacement
5995
of aggregates (SRA) optimization will perform block copies.  The
5996
default value, 0, implies that GCC will select the most appropriate
5997
size itself.
5998
 
5999
@item sra-field-structure-ratio
6000
The threshold ratio (as a percentage) between instantiated fields and
6001
the complete structure size.  We say that if the ratio of the number
6002
of bytes in instantiated fields to the number of bytes in the complete
6003
structure exceeds this parameter, then block copies are not used.  The
6004
default is 75.
6005
 
6006
@item max-crossjump-edges
6007
The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for crossjumping.
6008
The algorithm used by @option{-fcrossjumping} is @math{O(N^2)} in
6009
the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
6010
more aggressive optimization, making the compile time increase with
6011
probably small improvement in executable size.
6012
 
6013
@item min-crossjump-insns
6014
The minimum number of instructions which must be matched at the end
6015
of two blocks before crossjumping will be performed on them.  This
6016
value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the block being
6017
crossjumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.
6018
 
6019
@item max-grow-copy-bb-insns
6020
The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic blocks
6021
instead of jumping.  The expansion is relative to a jump instruction.
6022
The default value is 8.
6023
 
6024
@item max-goto-duplication-insns
6025
The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps
6026
to a computed goto.  To avoid @math{O(N^2)} behavior in a number of
6027
passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation process,
6028
and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps at the
6029
end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are
6030
unfactored.  The default value is 8.
6031
 
6032
@item max-delay-slot-insn-search
6033
The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
6034
instruction to fill a delay slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of
6035
instructions is searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
6036
will be minimal so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more
6037
aggressive optimization, making the compile time increase with probably
6038
small improvement in executable run time.
6039
 
6040
@item max-delay-slot-live-search
6041
When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
6042
consider when searching for a block with valid live register
6043
information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
6044
aggressive optimization, increasing the compile time.  This parameter
6045
should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
6046
control-flow graph.
6047
 
6048
@item max-gcse-memory
6049
The approximate maximum amount of memory that will be allocated in
6050
order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
6051
optimization.  If more memory than specified is required, the
6052
optimization will not be done.
6053
 
6054
@item max-gcse-passes
6055
The maximum number of passes of GCSE to run.  The default is 1.
6056
 
6057
@item max-pending-list-length
6058
The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will allow
6059
before flushing the current state and starting over.  Large functions
6060
with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
6061
needlessly consume memory and resources.
6062
 
6063
@item max-inline-insns-single
6064
Several parameters control the tree inliner used in gcc.
6065
This number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in GCC's
6066
internal representation) in a single function that the tree inliner
6067
will consider for inlining.  This only affects functions declared
6068
inline and methods implemented in a class declaration (C++).
6069
The default value is 450.
6070
 
6071
@item max-inline-insns-auto
6072
When you use @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}),
6073
a lot of functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
6074
by the compiler will be investigated.  To those functions, a different
6075
(more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can
6076
be applied.
6077
The default value is 90.
6078
 
6079
@item large-function-insns
6080
The limit specifying really large functions.  For functions larger than this
6081
limit after inlining inlining is constrained by
6082
@option{--param large-function-growth}.  This parameter is useful primarily
6083
to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the
6084
backend.
6085
This parameter is ignored when @option{-funit-at-a-time} is not used.
6086
The default value is 2700.
6087
 
6088
@item large-function-growth
6089
Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.
6090
This parameter is ignored when @option{-funit-at-a-time} is not used.
6091
The default value is 100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times
6092
the original size.
6093
 
6094
@item large-unit-insns
6095
The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of
6096
units larger than this limit is limited by @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.
6097
For small units this might be too tight (consider unit consisting of function A
6098
that is inline and B that just calls A three time.  If B is small relative to
6099
A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane.  For very
6100
large units consisting of small inlininable functions however the overall unit
6101
growth limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.  Thus for
6102
smaller units, the size is increased to @option{--param large-unit-insns}
6103
before applying @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.  The default is 10000
6104
 
6105
@item inline-unit-growth
6106
Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.
6107
This parameter is ignored when @option{-funit-at-a-time} is not used.
6108
The default value is 50 which limits unit growth to 1.5 times the original
6109
size.
6110
 
6111
@item max-inline-insns-recursive
6112
@itemx max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
6113
Specifies maximum number of instructions out-of-line copy of self recursive inline
6114
function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.
6115
 
6116
For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive} is
6117
taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
6118
happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
6119
enabled and @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto} is used.  The
6120
default value is 450.
6121
 
6122
@item max-inline-recursive-depth
6123
@itemx max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
6124
Specifies maximum recursion depth used by the recursive inlining.
6125
 
6126
For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth} is
6127
taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
6128
happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
6129
enabled and @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto} is used.  The
6130
default value is 450.
6131
 
6132
@item min-inline-recursive-probability
6133
Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion
6134
in average and can hurt for function having little recursion depth by
6135
increasing the prologue size or complexity of function body to other
6136
optimizers.
6137
 
6138
When profile feedback is available (see @option{-fprofile-generate}) the actual
6139
recursion depth can be guessed from probability that function will recurse via
6140
given call expression.  This parameter limits inlining only to call expression
6141
whose probability exceeds given threshold (in percents).  The default value is
6142
10.
6143
 
6144
@item inline-call-cost
6145
Specify cost of call instruction relative to simple arithmetics operations
6146
(having cost of 1).  Increasing this cost disqualifies inlining of non-leaf
6147
functions and at the same time increases size of leaf function that is believed to
6148
reduce function size by being inlined.  In effect it increases amount of
6149
inlining for code having large abstraction penalty (many functions that just
6150
pass the arguments to other functions) and decrease inlining for code with low
6151
abstraction penalty.  The default value is 16.
6152
 
6153
@item max-unrolled-insns
6154
The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
6155
is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times
6156
the loop code is unrolled.
6157
 
6158
@item max-average-unrolled-insns
6159
The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution
6160
that a loop should have if that loop is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled,
6161
it determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
6162
 
6163
@item max-unroll-times
6164
The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
6165
 
6166
@item max-peeled-insns
6167
The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
6168
is peeled, and if the loop is peeled, it determines how many times
6169
the loop code is peeled.
6170
 
6171
@item max-peel-times
6172
The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
6173
 
6174
@item max-completely-peeled-insns
6175
The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
6176
 
6177
@item max-completely-peel-times
6178
The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.
6179
 
6180
@item max-unswitch-insns
6181
The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
6182
 
6183
@item max-unswitch-level
6184
The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
6185
 
6186
@item lim-expensive
6187
The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.
6188
 
6189
@item iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
6190
Bound on number of candidates for induction variables below that
6191
all candidates are considered for each use in induction variable
6192
optimizations.  Only the most relevant candidates are considered
6193
if there are more candidates, to avoid quadratic time complexity.
6194
 
6195
@item iv-max-considered-uses
6196
The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more
6197
induction variable uses.
6198
 
6199
@item iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
6200
If number of candidates in the set is smaller than this value,
6201
we always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set during its
6202
optimization when a new iv is added to the set.
6203
 
6204
@item scev-max-expr-size
6205
Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
6206
Large expressions slow the analyzer.
6207
 
6208
@item vect-max-version-checks
6209
The maximum number of runtime checks that can be performed when doing
6210
loop versioning in the vectorizer.  See option ftree-vect-loop-version
6211
for more information.
6212
 
6213
@item max-iterations-to-track
6214
 
6215
The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute force algorithm
6216
for analysis of # of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.
6217
 
6218
@item hot-bb-count-fraction
6219
Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program
6220
given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
6221
 
6222
@item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
6223
Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of basic block in
6224
function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot
6225
 
6226
@item max-predicted-iterations
6227
The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.  This is useful
6228
in cases where function contain single loop with known bound and other loop
6229
with unknown.  We predict the known number of iterations correctly, while
6230
the unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10.  This means that the
6231
loop without bounds would appear artificially cold relative to the other one.
6232
 
6233
@item tracer-dynamic-coverage
6234
@itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
6235
 
6236
This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
6237
executed instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size
6238
expansion.
6239
 
6240
The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
6241
feedback is available.  The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
6242
ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
6243
 
6244
@item tracer-max-code-growth
6245
Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage.  This is
6246
rather hokey argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in
6247
cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
6248
growth.
6249
 
6250
@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
6251
 
6252
Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
6253
threshold (in percent).
6254
 
6255
@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
6256
@itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
6257
 
6258
Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this
6259
threshold.
6260
 
6261
Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
6262
compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without.  The value
6263
for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
6264
order to make tracer effective.
6265
 
6266
@item max-cse-path-length
6267
 
6268
Maximum number of basic blocks on path that cse considers.  The default is 10.
6269
 
6270
@item max-cse-insns
6271
The maximum instructions CSE process before flushing. The default is 1000.
6272
 
6273
@item global-var-threshold
6274
 
6275
Counts the number of function calls (@var{n}) and the number of
6276
call-clobbered variables (@var{v}).  If @var{n}x@var{v} is larger than this limit, a
6277
single artificial variable will be created to represent all the
6278
call-clobbered variables at function call sites.  This artificial
6279
variable will then be made to alias every call-clobbered variable.
6280
(done as @code{int * size_t} on the host machine; beware overflow).
6281
 
6282
@item max-aliased-vops
6283
 
6284
Maximum number of virtual operands allowed to represent aliases
6285
before triggering the alias grouping heuristic.  Alias grouping
6286
reduces compile times and memory consumption needed for aliasing at
6287
the expense of precision loss in alias information.
6288
 
6289
@item ggc-min-expand
6290
 
6291
GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This
6292
parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
6293
collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
6294
Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
6295
generation.
6296
 
6297
The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when
6298
RAM >= 1GB@.  If @code{getrlimit} is available, the notion of "RAM" is
6299
the smallest of actual RAM and @code{RLIMIT_DATA} or @code{RLIMIT_AS}.  If
6300
GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower
6301
bound of 30% is used.  Setting this parameter and
6302
@option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
6303
every opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
6304
debugging.
6305
 
6306
@item ggc-min-heapsize
6307
 
6308
Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
6309
to collect garbage.  The first collection occurs after the heap expands
6310
by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}.  Again,
6311
tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
6312
generation.
6313
 
6314
The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit which
6315
tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but
6316
with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound of
6317
131072 (128 megabytes).  If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
6318
particular platform, the lower bound is used.  Setting this parameter
6319
very large effectively disables garbage collection.  Setting this
6320
parameter and @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection
6321
to occur at every opportunity.
6322
 
6323
@item max-reload-search-insns
6324
The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward for equivalent
6325
register.  Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
6326
compile time increase with probably slightly better performance.  The default
6327
value is 100.
6328
 
6329
@item max-cselib-memory-locations
6330
The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.
6331
Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compile time
6332
increase with probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 500.
6333
 
6334
@item max-flow-memory-locations
6335
Similar as @option{max-cselib-memory-locations} but for dataflow liveness.
6336
The default value is 100.
6337
 
6338
@item reorder-blocks-duplicate
6339
@itemx reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
6340
 
6341
Used by basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional
6342
branch or duplicate the code on its destination.  Code is duplicated when its
6343
estimated size is smaller than this value multiplied by the estimated size of
6344
unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.
6345
 
6346
The @option{reorder-block-duplicate-feedback} is used only when profile
6347
feedback is available and may be set to higher values than
6348
@option{reorder-block-duplicate} since information about the hot spots is more
6349
accurate.
6350
 
6351
@item max-sched-ready-insns
6352
The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should
6353
consider at any given time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing
6354
values mean more thorough searches, making the compilation time increase
6355
with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.
6356
 
6357
@item max-sched-region-blocks
6358
The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
6359
interblock scheduling.  The default value is 10.
6360
 
6361
@item max-sched-region-insns
6362
The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
6363
interblock scheduling.  The default value is 100.
6364
 
6365
@item min-spec-prob
6366
The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source block
6367
for interblock speculative scheduling.  The default value is 40.
6368
 
6369
@item max-sched-extend-regions-iters
6370
The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
6371
 
6372
N - do at most N iterations.
6373
The default value is 0.
6374
 
6375
@item max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
6376
The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for speculative motion.
6377
The default value is 3.
6378
 
6379
@item sched-spec-prob-cutoff
6380
The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents), so that
6381
speculative insn will be scheduled.
6382
The default value is 40.
6383
 
6384
@item max-last-value-rtl
6385
 
6386
The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression
6387
in combiner for a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default
6388
is 10000.
6389
 
6390
@item integer-share-limit
6391
Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the
6392
compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed.  This sets the maximum
6393
value of a shared integer constant's.  The default value is 256.
6394
 
6395
@item min-virtual-mappings
6396
Specifies the minimum number of virtual mappings in the incremental
6397
SSA updater that should be registered to trigger the virtual mappings
6398
heuristic defined by virtual-mappings-ratio.  The default value is
6399
100.
6400
 
6401
@item virtual-mappings-ratio
6402
If the number of virtual mappings is virtual-mappings-ratio bigger
6403
than the number of virtual symbols to be updated, then the incremental
6404
SSA updater switches to a full update for those symbols.  The default
6405
ratio is 3.
6406
 
6407
@item ssp-buffer-size
6408
The minimum size of buffers (i.e. arrays) that will receive stack smashing
6409
protection when @option{-fstack-protection} is used.
6410
 
6411
@item max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
6412
Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be
6413
duplicated when threading jumps.
6414
 
6415
@item max-fields-for-field-sensitive
6416
Maximum number of fields in a structure we will treat in
6417
a field sensitive manner during pointer analysis.
6418
 
6419
@end table
6420
@end table
6421
 
6422
@node Preprocessor Options
6423
@section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
6424
@cindex preprocessor options
6425
@cindex options, preprocessor
6426
 
6427
These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
6428
file before actual compilation.
6429
 
6430
If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
6431
Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
6432
they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
6433
compilation.
6434
 
6435
@table @gcctabopt
6436
@opindex Wp
6437
You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
6438
and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor.  If
6439
@var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
6440
commas.  However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
6441
by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
6442
@option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase.  The preprocessor's direct
6443
interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
6444
you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
6445
options instead.
6446
 
6447
@item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
6448
@opindex preprocessor
6449
Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor.  You can use this to
6450
supply system-specific preprocessor options which GCC does not know how to
6451
recognize.
6452
 
6453
If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
6454
@option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
6455
@end table
6456
 
6457
@include cppopts.texi
6458
 
6459
@node Assembler Options
6460
@section Passing Options to the Assembler
6461
 
6462
@c prevent bad page break with this line
6463
You can pass options to the assembler.
6464
 
6465
@table @gcctabopt
6466
@item -Wa,@var{option}
6467
@opindex Wa
6468
Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  If @var{option}
6469
contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
6470
 
6471
@item -Xassembler @var{option}
6472
@opindex Xassembler
6473
Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  You can use this to
6474
supply system-specific assembler options which GCC does not know how to
6475
recognize.
6476
 
6477
If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
6478
@option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
6479
 
6480
@end table
6481
 
6482
@node Link Options
6483
@section Options for Linking
6484
@cindex link options
6485
@cindex options, linking
6486
 
6487
These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
6488
an executable output file.  They are meaningless if the compiler is
6489
not doing a link step.
6490
 
6491
@table @gcctabopt
6492
@cindex file names
6493
@item @var{object-file-name}
6494
A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
6495
considered to name an object file or library.  (Object files are
6496
distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
6497
contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input
6498
to the linker.
6499
 
6500
@item -c
6501
@itemx -S
6502
@itemx -E
6503
@opindex c
6504
@opindex S
6505
@opindex E
6506
If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
6507
object file names should not be used as arguments.  @xref{Overall
6508
Options}.
6509
 
6510
@cindex Libraries
6511
@item -l@var{library}
6512
@itemx -l @var{library}
6513
@opindex l
6514
Search the library named @var{library} when linking.  (The second
6515
alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
6516
POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
6517
 
6518
It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
6519
linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
6520
are specified.  Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
6521
after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}.  If @file{bar.o} refers
6522
to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
6523
 
6524
The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
6525
which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}.  The linker
6526
then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
6527
 
6528
The directories searched include several standard system directories
6529
plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
6530
 
6531
Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
6532
whose members are object files.  The linker handles an archive file by
6533
scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
6534
been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an
6535
ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion.  The only
6536
difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
6537
is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
6538
and searches several directories.
6539
 
6540
@item -lobjc
6541
@opindex lobjc
6542
You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
6543
link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
6544
 
6545
@item -nostartfiles
6546
@opindex nostartfiles
6547
Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
6548
The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
6549
or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
6550
 
6551
@item -nodefaultlibs
6552
@opindex nodefaultlibs
6553
Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
6554
Only the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker.
6555
The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
6556
is used.  The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp},
6557
@code{memset}, @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
6558
These entries are usually resolved by entries in
6559
libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
6560
mechanism when this option is specified.
6561
 
6562
@item -nostdlib
6563
@opindex nostdlib
6564
Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
6565
No startup files and only the libraries you specify will be passed to
6566
the linker.  The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp}, @code{memset},
6567
@code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
6568
These entries are usually resolved by entries in
6569
libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
6570
mechanism when this option is specified.
6571
 
6572
@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
6573
@cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
6574
@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
6575
@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6576
@cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
6577
@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6578
One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
6579
@option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
6580
that GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
6581
needs for some languages.
6582
(@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
6583
Collection (GCC) Internals},
6584
for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
6585
In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
6586
other standard libraries.  In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
6587
or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
6588
This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
6589
library subroutines.  (For example, @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
6590
constructors will be called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
6591
GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
6592
 
6593
@item -pie
6594
@opindex pie
6595
Produce a position independent executable on targets which support it.
6596
For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
6597
that were used to generate code (@option{-fpie}, @option{-fPIE},
6598
or model suboptions) when you specify this option.
6599
 
6600
@item -rdynamic
6601
@opindex rdynamic
6602
Pass the flag @option{-export-dynamic} to the ELF linker, on targets
6603
that support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not
6604
only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed
6605
for some uses of @code{dlopen} or to allow obtaining backtraces
6606
from within a program.
6607
 
6608
@item -s
6609
@opindex s
6610
Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
6611
 
6612
@item -static
6613
@opindex static
6614
On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
6615
libraries.  On other systems, this option has no effect.
6616
 
6617
@item -shared
6618
@opindex shared
6619
Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
6620
form an executable.  Not all systems support this option.  For predictable
6621
results, you must also specify the same set of options that were used to
6622
generate code (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions)
6623
when you specify this option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
6624
needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
6625
multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
6626
libraries to link against.  Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
6627
to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
6628
is innocuous.}
6629
 
6630
@item -shared-libgcc
6631
@itemx -static-libgcc
6632
@opindex shared-libgcc
6633
@opindex static-libgcc
6634
On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
6635
force the use of either the shared or static version respectively.
6636
If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
6637
configured, these options have no effect.
6638
 
6639
There are several situations in which an application should use the
6640
shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version.  The most common
6641
of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
6642
across different shared libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries
6643
as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
6644
 
6645
Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
6646
@option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
6647
executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
6648
this is the right thing to do.
6649
 
6650
If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
6651
find that they will not always be linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
6652
If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU linker
6653
or a GNU linker that does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr},
6654
it will link the shared version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries
6655
by default.  Otherwise, it will take advantage of the linker and optimize
6656
away the linking with the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with
6657
the static version of libgcc by default.  This allows exceptions to
6658
propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring relocation
6659
costs at library load time.
6660
 
6661
However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
6662
exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
6663
for the languages used in the program, or using the option
6664
@option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
6665
@file{libgcc}.
6666
 
6667
@item -symbolic
6668
@opindex symbolic
6669
Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object.  Warn
6670
about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
6671
option @samp{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}).  Only a few systems support
6672
this option.
6673
 
6674
@item -Xlinker @var{option}
6675
@opindex Xlinker
6676
Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  You can use this to
6677
supply system-specific linker options which GCC does not know how to
6678
recognize.
6679
 
6680
If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
6681
@option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
6682
For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
6683
@samp{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}.  It does not work to write
6684
@option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
6685
string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
6686
 
6687
@item -Wl,@var{option}
6688
@opindex Wl
6689
Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  If @var{option} contains
6690
commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
6691
 
6692
@item -u @var{symbol}
6693
@opindex u
6694
Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
6695
library modules to define it.  You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
6696
different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
6697
@end table
6698
 
6699
@node Directory Options
6700
@section Options for Directory Search
6701
@cindex directory options
6702
@cindex options, directory search
6703
@cindex search path
6704
 
6705
These options specify directories to search for header files, for
6706
libraries and for parts of the compiler:
6707
 
6708
@table @gcctabopt
6709
@item -I@var{dir}
6710
@opindex I
6711
Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
6712
searched for header files.  This can be used to override a system header
6713
file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
6714
searched before the system header file directories.  However, you should
6715
not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
6716
system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that).  If you use more than
6717
one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
6718
order; the standard system directories come after.
6719
 
6720
If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
6721
@option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
6722
option will be ignored.  The directory will still be searched but as a
6723
system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
6724
This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
6725
the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently changed.
6726
If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
6727
use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
6728
 
6729
@item -iquote@var{dir}
6730
@opindex iquote
6731
Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to
6732
be searched for header files only for the case of @samp{#include
6733
"@var{file}"}; they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>},
6734
otherwise just like @option{-I}.
6735
 
6736
@item -L@var{dir}
6737
@opindex L
6738
Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
6739
for @option{-l}.
6740
 
6741
@item -B@var{prefix}
6742
@opindex B
6743
This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
6744
include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
6745
 
6746
The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
6747
@file{cpp}, @file{cc1}, @file{as} and @file{ld}.  It tries
6748
@var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
6749
without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
6750
 
6751
For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
6752
@option{-B} prefix, if any.  If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
6753
was not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes, which are
6754
@file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc/}.  If neither of
6755
those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
6756
name is searched for using the directories specified in your
6757
@env{PATH} environment variable.
6758
 
6759
The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
6760
refers to a directory, and if necessary it will add a directory
6761
separator character at the end of the path.
6762
 
6763
@option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
6764
to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
6765
options into @option{-L} options for the linker.  They also apply to
6766
includes files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
6767
options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor.  In this case,
6768
the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
6769
 
6770
The run-time support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
6771
the @option{-B} prefix, if needed.  If it is not found there, the two
6772
standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left
6773
out of the link if it is not found by those means.
6774
 
6775
Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
6776
the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @xref{Environment
6777
Variables}.
6778
 
6779
As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
6780
@file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
6781
9, then it will be replaced by @file{[dir/]include}.  This is to help
6782
with boot-strapping the compiler.
6783
 
6784
@item -specs=@var{file}
6785
@opindex specs
6786
Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
6787
file, in order to override the defaults that the @file{gcc} driver
6788
program uses when determining what switches to pass to @file{cc1},
6789
@file{cc1plus}, @file{as}, @file{ld}, etc.  More than one
6790
@option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
6791
are processed in order, from left to right.
6792
 
6793
@item --sysroot=@var{dir}
6794
@opindex sysroot
6795
Use @var{dir} as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
6796
For example, if the compiler would normally search for headers in
6797
@file{/usr/include} and libraries in @file{/usr/lib}, it will instead
6798
search @file{@var{dir}/usr/include} and @file{@var{dir}/usr/lib}.
6799
 
6800
If you use both this option and the @option{-isysroot} option, then
6801
the @option{--sysroot} option will apply to libraries, but the
6802
@option{-isysroot} option will apply to header files.
6803
 
6804
The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support
6805
for this option.  If your linker does not support this option, the
6806
header file aspect of @option{--sysroot} will still work, but the
6807
library aspect will not.
6808
 
6809
@item -I-
6810
@opindex I-
6811
This option has been deprecated.  Please use @option{-iquote} instead for
6812
@option{-I} directories before the @option{-I-} and remove the @option{-I-}.
6813
Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
6814
option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
6815
they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
6816
 
6817
If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
6818
the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
6819
directives.  (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
6820
this way.)
6821
 
6822
In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
6823
directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
6824
directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}.  There is no way to
6825
override this effect of @option{-I-}.  With @option{-I.} you can specify
6826
searching the directory which was current when the compiler was
6827
invoked.  That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
6828
by default, but it is often satisfactory.
6829
 
6830
@option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
6831
for header files.  Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
6832
independent.
6833
@end table
6834
 
6835
@c man end
6836
 
6837
@node Spec Files
6838
@section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
6839
@cindex Spec Files
6840
 
6841
@command{gcc} is a driver program.  It performs its job by invoking a
6842
sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
6843
linking.  GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
6844
deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
6845
it ought to place on their command lines.  This behavior is controlled
6846
by @dfn{spec strings}.  In most cases there is one spec string for each
6847
program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
6848
strings to control their behavior.  The spec strings built into GCC can
6849
be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
6850
a spec file.
6851
 
6852
@dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
6853
strings.  They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
6854
lines.  The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
6855
character on the line and it can be one of the following:
6856
 
6857
@table @code
6858
@item %@var{command}
6859
Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor.  The commands that can
6860
appear here are:
6861
 
6862
@table @code
6863
@item %include <@var{file}>
6864
@cindex %include
6865
Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
6866
specs file.
6867
 
6868
@item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
6869
@cindex %include_noerr
6870
Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
6871
file cannot be found.
6872
 
6873
@item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
6874
@cindex %rename
6875
Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
6876
 
6877
@end table
6878
 
6879
@item *[@var{spec_name}]:
6880
This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
6881
string.  All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
6882
blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string.  If this
6883
results in an empty string then the spec will be deleted.  (Or, if the
6884
spec did not exist, then nothing will happened.)  Otherwise, if the spec
6885
does not currently exist a new spec will be created.  If the spec does
6886
exist then its contents will be overridden by the text of this
6887
directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
6888
character, in which case the text will be appended to the spec.
6889
 
6890
@item [@var{suffix}]:
6891
Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair.  All lines after this directive
6892
and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
6893
spec string for the indicated suffix.  When the compiler encounters an
6894
input file with the named suffix, it will processes the spec string in
6895
order to work out how to compile that file.  For example:
6896
 
6897
@smallexample
6898
.ZZ:
6899
z-compile -input %i
6900
@end smallexample
6901
 
6902
This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
6903
passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
6904
command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
6905
@samp{%i} substitution.  (See below.)
6906
 
6907
As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text that follows a
6908
suffix directive can be one of the following:
6909
 
6910
@table @code
6911
@item @@@var{language}
6912
This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}.  This is
6913
similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
6914
language explicitly.  For example:
6915
 
6916
@smallexample
6917
.ZZ:
6918
@@c++
6919
@end smallexample
6920
 
6921
Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
6922
 
6923
@item #@var{name}
6924
This causes an error messages saying:
6925
 
6926
@smallexample
6927
@var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
6928
@end smallexample
6929
@end table
6930
 
6931
GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
6932
This directive will add an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
6933
since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
6934
possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
6935
 
6936
@end table
6937
 
6938
GCC has the following spec strings built into it.  Spec files can
6939
override these strings or create their own.  Note that individual
6940
targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
6941
 
6942
@smallexample
6943
asm          Options to pass to the assembler
6944
asm_final    Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
6945
cpp          Options to pass to the C preprocessor
6946
cc1          Options to pass to the C compiler
6947
cc1plus      Options to pass to the C++ compiler
6948
endfile      Object files to include at the end of the link
6949
link         Options to pass to the linker
6950
lib          Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
6951
libgcc       Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
6952
linker       Sets the name of the linker
6953
predefines   Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
6954
signed_char  Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
6955
             by default
6956
startfile    Object files to include at the start of the link
6957
@end smallexample
6958
 
6959
Here is a small example of a spec file:
6960
 
6961
@smallexample
6962
%rename lib                 old_lib
6963
 
6964
*lib:
6965
--start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
6966
@end smallexample
6967
 
6968
This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
6969
then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
6970
The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
6971
including the text of the old definition.
6972
 
6973
@dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
6974
corresponding program.  In addition, the spec strings can contain
6975
@samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
6976
conditionally insert text into the command line.  Using these constructs
6977
it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
6978
 
6979
Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
6980
strings.  Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
6981
results of expanding these sequences.  Therefore you can concatenate them
6982
together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
6983
 
6984
@table @code
6985
@item %%
6986
Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
6987
 
6988
@item %i
6989
Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
6990
 
6991
@item %b
6992
Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
6993
This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
6994
and not including the directory.
6995
 
6996
@item %B
6997
This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
6998
the last period).
6999
 
7000
@item %d
7001
Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
7002
temporary file name, so that that file will be deleted if GCC exits
7003
successfully.  Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
7004
argument.
7005
 
7006
@item %g@var{suffix}
7007
Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
7008
once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
7009
@samp{%d}.  To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
7010
name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
7011
chosen file names are known.  For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
7012
might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}.  @var{suffix} matches
7013
the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
7014
treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed.  Previously, @samp{%g}
7015
was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
7016
without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
7017
just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
7018
 
7019
@item %u@var{suffix}
7020
Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name even if
7021
@samp{%u@var{suffix}} was already seen.
7022
 
7023
@item %U@var{suffix}
7024
Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
7025
new one if there is no such last file name.  In the absence of any
7026
@samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
7027
the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
7028
would involve the generation of two distinct file names, one
7029
for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}.  Previously, @samp{%U} was
7030
simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
7031
without regard to any appended suffix.
7032
 
7033
@item %j@var{suffix}
7034
Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
7035
writable, and if save-temps is off; otherwise, substitute the name
7036
of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}.  This temporary file is not
7037
meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
7038
disposal mechanism.
7039
 
7040
@item %|@var{suffix}
7041
@itemx %m@var{suffix}
7042
Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect.  In that case
7043
@samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
7044
all.  These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
7045
should read from standard input or write to standard output.  If you
7046
need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
7047
construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
7048
 
7049
@item %.@var{SUFFIX}
7050
Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
7051
when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}.  @var{SUFFIX} is
7052
terminated by the next space or %.
7053
 
7054
@item %w
7055
Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
7056
designated output file of this compilation.  This puts the argument
7057
into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} will substitute later.
7058
 
7059
@item %o
7060
Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
7061
automatically placed around them.  You should write spaces
7062
around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
7063
@samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
7064
Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
7065
at all, but they are included among the output files, so they will
7066
be linked.
7067
 
7068
@item %O
7069
Substitutes the suffix for object files.  Note that this is
7070
handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
7071
because of the need for those to form complete file names.  The
7072
handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
7073
been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
7074
support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they would
7075
following, for example, @samp{.o}.
7076
 
7077
@item %p
7078
Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
7079
current target machine.  Use this when running @code{cpp}.
7080
 
7081
@item %P
7082
Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
7083
predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
7084
@samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter.  This is for ISO
7085
C@.
7086
 
7087
@item %I
7088
Substitute any of @option{-iprefix} (made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}),
7089
@option{-isysroot} (made from @env{TARGET_SYSTEM_ROOT}),
7090
@option{-isystem} (made from @env{COMPILER_PATH} and @option{-B} options)
7091
and @option{-imultilib} as necessary.
7092
 
7093
@item %s
7094
Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
7095
Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
7096
the full name found.
7097
 
7098
@item %e@var{str}
7099
Print @var{str} as an error message.  @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
7100
Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
7101
 
7102
@item %(@var{name})
7103
Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
7104
 
7105
@item %[@var{name}]
7106
Like @samp{%(@dots{})} but put @samp{__} around @option{-D} arguments.
7107
 
7108
@item %x@{@var{option}@}
7109
Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
7110
 
7111
@item %X
7112
Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
7113
spec string.
7114
 
7115
@item %Y
7116
Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
7117
 
7118
@item %Z
7119
Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
7120
 
7121
@item %a
7122
Process the @code{asm} spec.  This is used to compute the
7123
switches to be passed to the assembler.
7124
 
7125
@item %A
7126
Process the @code{asm_final} spec.  This is a spec string for
7127
passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
7128
needed.
7129
 
7130
@item %l
7131
Process the @code{link} spec.  This is the spec for computing the
7132
command line passed to the linker.  Typically it will make use of the
7133
@samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
7134
 
7135
@item %D
7136
Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
7137
contain startup files.  If the target supports multilibs then the
7138
current multilib directory will be prepended to each of these paths.
7139
 
7140
@item %L
7141
Process the @code{lib} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding which
7142
libraries should be included on the command line to the linker.
7143
 
7144
@item %G
7145
Process the @code{libgcc} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding
7146
which GCC support library should be included on the command line to the linker.
7147
 
7148
@item %S
7149
Process the @code{startfile} spec.  This is a spec for deciding which
7150
object files should be the first ones passed to the linker.  Typically
7151
this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
7152
 
7153
@item %E
7154
Process the @code{endfile} spec.  This is a spec string that specifies
7155
the last object files that will be passed to the linker.
7156
 
7157
@item %C
7158
Process the @code{cpp} spec.  This is used to construct the arguments
7159
to be passed to the C preprocessor.
7160
 
7161
@item %1
7162
Process the @code{cc1} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
7163
passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
7164
 
7165
@item %2
7166
Process the @code{cc1plus} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
7167
passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
7168
 
7169
@item %*
7170
Substitute the variable part of a matched option.  See below.
7171
Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
7172
a single space.
7173
 
7174
@item %<@code{S}
7175
Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line.  Note---this
7176
command is position dependent.  @samp{%} commands in the spec string
7177
before this one will see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
7178
after this one will not.
7179
 
7180
@item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
7181
Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
7182
@var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
7183
into an argument vector in the usual fashion.  The function returns
7184
a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
7185
of the current spec.
7186
 
7187
The following built-in spec functions are provided:
7188
 
7189
@table @code
7190
@item @code{if-exists}
7191
The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
7192
pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
7193
pathname.  Here is a small example of its usage:
7194
 
7195
@smallexample
7196
*startfile:
7197
crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
7198
@end smallexample
7199
 
7200
@item @code{if-exists-else}
7201
The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
7202
spec function, except that it takes two arguments.  The first argument is
7203
an absolute pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
7204
returns the pathname.  If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
7205
This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
7206
based on the existence of the first.  Here is a small example of its usage:
7207
 
7208
@smallexample
7209
*startfile:
7210
crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) \
7211
%:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
7212
@end smallexample
7213
 
7214
@item @code{replace-outfile}
7215
The @code{replace-outfile} spec function takes two arguments.  It looks for the
7216
first argument in the outfiles array and replaces it with the second argument.  Here
7217
is a small example of its usage:
7218
 
7219
@smallexample
7220
%@{fgnu-runtime:%:replace-outfile(-lobjc -lobjc-gnu)@}
7221
@end smallexample
7222
 
7223
@end table
7224
 
7225
@item %@{@code{S}@}
7226
Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch was given to GCC@.
7227
If that switch was not specified, this substitutes nothing.  Note that
7228
the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
7229
automatically inserted if the substitution is performed.  Thus the spec
7230
string @samp{%@{foo@}} would match the command-line option @option{-foo}
7231
and would output the command line option @option{-foo}.
7232
 
7233
@item %W@{@code{S}@}
7234
Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
7235
deleted on failure.
7236
 
7237
@item %@{@code{S}*@}
7238
Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
7239
with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument.  This is used for
7240
switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
7241
GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
7242
one switch whose names starts with @samp{o}.  %@{o*@} would substitute this
7243
text, including the space.  Thus two arguments would be generated.
7244
 
7245
@item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
7246
Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
7247
(the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
7248
There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
7249
wild card is optional.  Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
7250
 
7251
@item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
7252
Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was given to GCC@.
7253
 
7254
@item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
7255
Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was @emph{not} given to GCC@.
7256
 
7257
@item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
7258
Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
7259
@code{-S} are specified to GCC@.  Normally @code{X} is substituted only
7260
once, no matter how many such switches appeared.  However, if @code{%*}
7261
appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} will be substituted once
7262
for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
7263
that switch that matched the @code{*}.
7264
 
7265
@item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
7266
Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
7267
 
7268
@item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
7269
Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
7270
 
7271
@item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
7272
Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} was given to GCC@.
7273
This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, and @code{*} sequences as well,
7274
although they have a stronger binding than the @samp{|}.  If @code{%*}
7275
appears in @code{X}, all of the alternatives must be starred, and only
7276
the first matching alternative is substituted.
7277
 
7278
For example, a spec string like this:
7279
 
7280
@smallexample
7281
%@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
7282
@end smallexample
7283
 
7284
will output the following command-line options from the following input
7285
command-line options:
7286
 
7287
@smallexample
7288
fred.c        -foo -baz
7289
jim.d         -bar -boggle
7290
-d fred.c     -foo -baz -boggle
7291
-d jim.d      -bar -baz -boggle
7292
@end smallexample
7293
 
7294
@item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
7295
 
7296
If @code{S} was given to GCC, substitutes @code{X}; else if @code{T} was
7297
given to GCC, substitutes @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}.  There can
7298
be as many clauses as you need.  This may be combined with @code{.},
7299
@code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
7300
 
7301
 
7302
@end table
7303
 
7304
The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
7305
construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
7306
even newlines.  They are processed as usual, as described above.
7307
Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored.  White space may also
7308
appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
7309
except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
7310
 
7311
The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
7312
handled specifically in these constructs.  If another value of
7313
@option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
7314
@option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
7315
switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
7316
just one letter, which passes all matching options.
7317
 
7318
The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
7319
indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
7320
only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
7321
 
7322
It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
7323
(You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
7324
compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments.  But this cannot
7325
be done in a consistent fashion.  GCC cannot even decide which input
7326
files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
7327
and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
7328
compilers to run).
7329
 
7330
GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
7331
treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
7332
proper position among the other output files.
7333
 
7334
@c man begin OPTIONS
7335
 
7336
@node Target Options
7337
@section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
7338
@cindex target options
7339
@cindex cross compiling
7340
@cindex specifying machine version
7341
@cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
7342
@cindex compiler version, specifying
7343
@cindex target machine, specifying
7344
 
7345
The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @file{gcc}, or
7346
@file{<machine>-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
7347
@file{<machine>-gcc-<version>} to run a version other than the one that
7348
was installed last.  Sometimes this is inconvenient, so GCC provides
7349
options that will switch to another cross-compiler or version.
7350
 
7351
@table @gcctabopt
7352
@item -b @var{machine}
7353
@opindex b
7354
The argument @var{machine} specifies the target machine for compilation.
7355
 
7356
The value to use for @var{machine} is the same as was specified as the
7357
machine type when configuring GCC as a cross-compiler.  For
7358
example, if a cross-compiler was configured with @samp{configure
7359
arm-elf}, meaning to compile for an arm processor with elf binaries,
7360
then you would specify @option{-b arm-elf} to run that cross compiler.
7361
Because there are other options beginning with @option{-b}, the
7362
configuration must contain a hyphen.
7363
 
7364
@item -V @var{version}
7365
@opindex V
7366
The argument @var{version} specifies which version of GCC to run.
7367
This is useful when multiple versions are installed.  For example,
7368
@var{version} might be @samp{4.0}, meaning to run GCC version 4.0.
7369
@end table
7370
 
7371
The @option{-V} and @option{-b} options work by running the
7372
@file{<machine>-gcc-<version>} executable, so there's no real reason to
7373
use them if you can just run that directly.
7374
 
7375
@node Submodel Options
7376
@section Hardware Models and Configurations
7377
@cindex submodel options
7378
@cindex specifying hardware config
7379
@cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
7380
@cindex machine dependent options
7381
 
7382
Earlier we discussed the standard option @option{-b} which chooses among
7383
different installed compilers for completely different target
7384
machines, such as VAX vs.@: 68000 vs.@: 80386.
7385
 
7386
In addition, each of these target machine types can have its own
7387
special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
7388
hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
7389
floating coprocessor or none.  A single installed version of the
7390
compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
7391
options specified.
7392
 
7393
Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
7394
options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
7395
platform.
7396
 
7397
@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
7398
@c It should be the same order and spelling as these options are listed
7399
@c in Machine Dependent Options
7400
 
7401
@menu
7402
* ARC Options::
7403
* ARM Options::
7404
* AVR Options::
7405
* Blackfin Options::
7406
* CRIS Options::
7407
* CRX Options::
7408
* Darwin Options::
7409
* DEC Alpha Options::
7410
* DEC Alpha/VMS Options::
7411
* FRV Options::
7412
* GNU/Linux Options::
7413
* H8/300 Options::
7414
* HPPA Options::
7415
* i386 and x86-64 Options::
7416
* IA-64 Options::
7417
* M32C Options::
7418
* M32R/D Options::
7419
* M680x0 Options::
7420
* M68hc1x Options::
7421
* MCore Options::
7422
* MIPS Options::
7423
* MMIX Options::
7424
* MN10300 Options::
7425
* MT Options::
7426
* PDP-11 Options::
7427
* PowerPC Options::
7428
* RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
7429
* S/390 and zSeries Options::
7430
* Score Options::
7431
* SH Options::
7432
* SPARC Options::
7433
* System V Options::
7434
* TMS320C3x/C4x Options::
7435
* V850 Options::
7436
* VAX Options::
7437
* x86-64 Options::
7438
* Xstormy16 Options::
7439
* Xtensa Options::
7440
* zSeries Options::
7441
@end menu
7442
 
7443
@node ARC Options
7444
@subsection ARC Options
7445
@cindex ARC Options
7446
 
7447
These options are defined for ARC implementations:
7448
 
7449
@table @gcctabopt
7450
@item -EL
7451
@opindex EL
7452
Compile code for little endian mode.  This is the default.
7453
 
7454
@item -EB
7455
@opindex EB
7456
Compile code for big endian mode.
7457
 
7458
@item -mmangle-cpu
7459
@opindex mmangle-cpu
7460
Prepend the name of the cpu to all public symbol names.
7461
In multiple-processor systems, there are many ARC variants with different
7462
instruction and register set characteristics.  This flag prevents code
7463
compiled for one cpu to be linked with code compiled for another.
7464
No facility exists for handling variants that are ``almost identical''.
7465
This is an all or nothing option.
7466
 
7467
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
7468
@opindex mcpu
7469
Compile code for ARC variant @var{cpu}.
7470
Which variants are supported depend on the configuration.
7471
All variants support @option{-mcpu=base}, this is the default.
7472
 
7473
@item -mtext=@var{text-section}
7474
@itemx -mdata=@var{data-section}
7475
@itemx -mrodata=@var{readonly-data-section}
7476
@opindex mtext
7477
@opindex mdata
7478
@opindex mrodata
7479
Put functions, data, and readonly data in @var{text-section},
7480
@var{data-section}, and @var{readonly-data-section} respectively
7481
by default.  This can be overridden with the @code{section} attribute.
7482
@xref{Variable Attributes}.
7483
 
7484
@end table
7485
 
7486
@node ARM Options
7487
@subsection ARM Options
7488
@cindex ARM options
7489
 
7490
These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
7491
architectures:
7492
 
7493
@table @gcctabopt
7494
@item -mabi=@var{name}
7495
@opindex mabi
7496
Generate code for the specified ABI@.  Permissible values are: @samp{apcs-gnu},
7497
@samp{atpcs}, @samp{aapcs}, @samp{aapcs-linux} and @samp{iwmmxt}.
7498
 
7499
@item -mapcs-frame
7500
@opindex mapcs-frame
7501
Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
7502
Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
7503
correct execution of the code.  Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7504
with this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for
7505
leaf functions.  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
7506
 
7507
@item -mapcs
7508
@opindex mapcs
7509
This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
7510
 
7511
@ignore
7512
@c not currently implemented
7513
@item -mapcs-stack-check
7514
@opindex mapcs-stack-check
7515
Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
7516
every function (that actually uses some stack space).  If there is
7517
insufficient space available then either the function
7518
@samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} will be
7519
called, depending upon the amount of stack space required.  The run time
7520
system is required to provide these functions.  The default is
7521
@option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
7522
 
7523
@c not currently implemented
7524
@item -mapcs-float
7525
@opindex mapcs-float
7526
Pass floating point arguments using the float point registers.  This is
7527
one of the variants of the APCS@.  This option is recommended if the
7528
target hardware has a floating point unit or if a lot of floating point
7529
arithmetic is going to be performed by the code.  The default is
7530
@option{-mno-apcs-float}, since integer only code is slightly increased in
7531
size if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
7532
 
7533
@c not currently implemented
7534
@item -mapcs-reentrant
7535
@opindex mapcs-reentrant
7536
Generate reentrant, position independent code.  The default is
7537
@option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
7538
@end ignore
7539
 
7540
@item -mthumb-interwork
7541
@opindex mthumb-interwork
7542
Generate code which supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
7543
instruction sets.  Without this option the two instruction sets cannot
7544
be reliably used inside one program.  The default is
7545
@option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code is generated
7546
when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified.
7547
 
7548
@item -mno-sched-prolog
7549
@opindex mno-sched-prolog
7550
Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prolog, or the
7551
merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
7552
body.  This means that all functions will start with a recognizable set
7553
of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
7554
different function prologues), and this information can be used to
7555
locate the start if functions inside an executable piece of code.  The
7556
default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
7557
 
7558
@item -mhard-float
7559
@opindex mhard-float
7560
Generate output containing floating point instructions.  This is the
7561
default.
7562
 
7563
@item -msoft-float
7564
@opindex msoft-float
7565
Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
7566
@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all ARM
7567
targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
7568
used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
7569
your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
7570
cross-compilation.
7571
 
7572
@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
7573
therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
7574
this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
7575
library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
7576
this to work.
7577
 
7578
@item -mfloat-abi=@var{name}
7579
@opindex mfloat-abi
7580
Specifies which ABI to use for floating point values.  Permissible values
7581
are: @samp{soft}, @samp{softfp} and @samp{hard}.
7582
 
7583
@samp{soft} and @samp{hard} are equivalent to @option{-msoft-float}
7584
and @option{-mhard-float} respectively.  @samp{softfp} allows the generation
7585
of floating point instructions, but still uses the soft-float calling
7586
conventions.
7587
 
7588
@item -mlittle-endian
7589
@opindex mlittle-endian
7590
Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is
7591
the default for all standard configurations.
7592
 
7593
@item -mbig-endian
7594
@opindex mbig-endian
7595
Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
7596
to compile code for a little-endian processor.
7597
 
7598
@item -mwords-little-endian
7599
@opindex mwords-little-endian
7600
This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
7601
Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
7602
order.  That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}.  Note: this
7603
option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
7604
big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
7605
2.8.
7606
 
7607
@item -mcpu=@var{name}
7608
@opindex mcpu
7609
This specifies the name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name
7610
to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
7611
assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
7612
@samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
7613
@samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
7614
@samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
7615
@samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
7616
@samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm7tdmi-s},
7617
@samp{arm8}, @samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
7618
@samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
7619
@samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm922t}, @samp{arm946e-s}, @samp{arm966e-s},
7620
@samp{arm968e-s}, @samp{arm926ej-s}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi},
7621
@samp{arm10tdmi}, @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{arm1026ej-s},
7622
@samp{arm10e}, @samp{arm1020e}, @samp{arm1022e},
7623
@samp{arm1136j-s}, @samp{arm1136jf-s}, @samp{mpcore}, @samp{mpcorenovfp},
7624
@samp{arm1176jz-s}, @samp{arm1176jzf-s}, @samp{xscale}, @samp{iwmmxt},
7625
@samp{ep9312}.
7626
 
7627
@itemx -mtune=@var{name}
7628
@opindex mtune
7629
This option is very similar to the @option{-mcpu=} option, except that
7630
instead of specifying the actual target processor type, and hence
7631
restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies that GCC should
7632
tune the performance of the code as if the target were of the type
7633
specified in this option, but still choosing the instructions that it
7634
will generate based on the cpu specified by a @option{-mcpu=} option.
7635
For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
7636
this option.
7637
 
7638
@item -march=@var{name}
7639
@opindex march
7640
This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this
7641
name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
7642
assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
7643
of the @option{-mcpu=} option.  Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
7644
@samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
7645
@samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5te}, @samp{armv6}, @samp{armv6j},
7646
@samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{ep9312}.
7647
 
7648
@item -mfpu=@var{name}
7649
@itemx -mfpe=@var{number}
7650
@itemx -mfp=@var{number}
7651
@opindex mfpu
7652
@opindex mfpe
7653
@opindex mfp
7654
This specifies what floating point hardware (or hardware emulation) is
7655
available on the target.  Permissible names are: @samp{fpa}, @samp{fpe2},
7656
@samp{fpe3}, @samp{maverick}, @samp{vfp}.  @option{-mfp} and @option{-mfpe}
7657
are synonyms for @option{-mfpu}=@samp{fpe}@var{number}, for compatibility
7658
with older versions of GCC@.
7659
 
7660
If @option{-msoft-float} is specified this specifies the format of
7661
floating point values.
7662
 
7663
@item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
7664
@opindex mstructure-size-boundary
7665
The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple
7666
of the number of bits set by this option.  Permissible values are 8, 32
7667
and 64.  The default value varies for different toolchains.  For the COFF
7668
targeted toolchain the default value is 8.  A value of 64 is only allowed
7669
if the underlying ABI supports it.
7670
 
7671
Specifying the larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but
7672
can also increase the size of the program.  Different values are potentially
7673
incompatible.  Code compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to
7674
work with code or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
7675
information using structures or unions.
7676
 
7677
@item -mabort-on-noreturn
7678
@opindex mabort-on-noreturn
7679
Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
7680
@code{noreturn} function.  It will be executed if the function tries to
7681
return.
7682
 
7683
@item -mlong-calls
7684
@itemx -mno-long-calls
7685
@opindex mlong-calls
7686
@opindex mno-long-calls
7687
Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
7688
address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
7689
call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
7690
will lie outside of the 64 megabyte addressing range of the offset based
7691
version of subroutine call instruction.
7692
 
7693
Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned
7694
into long calls.  The heuristic is that static functions, functions
7695
which have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
7696
the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive and functions whose
7697
definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
7698
unit, will not be turned into long calls.  The exception to this rule is
7699
that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
7700
attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
7701
the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive, will always be
7702
turned into long calls.
7703
 
7704
This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
7705
@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior, as will
7706
placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
7707
long_calls_off} directive.  Note these switches have no effect on how
7708
the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
7709
pointers.
7710
 
7711
@item -mnop-fun-dllimport
7712
@opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
7713
Disable support for the @code{dllimport} attribute.
7714
 
7715
@item -msingle-pic-base
7716
@opindex msingle-pic-base
7717
Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
7718
loading it in the prologue for each function.  The run-time system is
7719
responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
7720
before execution begins.
7721
 
7722
@item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
7723
@opindex mpic-register
7724
Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.  The default is R10
7725
unless stack-checking is enabled, when R9 is used.
7726
 
7727
@item -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
7728
@opindex mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
7729
@opindex mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns
7730
Insert NOPs into the instruction stream to in order to work around
7731
problems with invalid Maverick instruction combinations.  This option
7732
is only valid if the @option{-mcpu=ep9312} option has been used to
7733
enable generation of instructions for the Cirrus Maverick floating
7734
point co-processor.  This option is not enabled by default, since the
7735
problem is only present in older Maverick implementations.  The default
7736
can be re-enabled by use of the @option{-mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns}
7737
switch.
7738
 
7739
@item -mpoke-function-name
7740
@opindex mpoke-function-name
7741
Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
7742
preceding the function prologue.  The generated code is similar to this:
7743
 
7744
@smallexample
7745
     t0
7746
         .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
7747
         .align
7748
     t1
7749
         .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
7750
     arm_poke_function_name
7751
         mov     ip, sp
7752
         stmfd   sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
7753
         sub     fp, ip, #4
7754
@end smallexample
7755
 
7756
When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
7757
@code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}.  If the trace function then looks at
7758
location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
7759
there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
7760
and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
7761
 
7762
@item -mthumb
7763
@opindex mthumb
7764
Generate code for the 16-bit Thumb instruction set.  The default is to
7765
use the 32-bit ARM instruction set.
7766
 
7767
@item -mtpcs-frame
7768
@opindex mtpcs-frame
7769
Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
7770
Standard for all non-leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
7771
not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
7772
 
7773
@item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
7774
@opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
7775
Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
7776
Standard for all leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
7777
not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
7778
 
7779
@item -mcallee-super-interworking
7780
@opindex mcallee-super-interworking
7781
Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
7782
instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
7783
rest of the function.  This allows these functions to be called from
7784
non-interworking code.
7785
 
7786
@item -mcaller-super-interworking
7787
@opindex mcaller-super-interworking
7788
Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
7789
execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
7790
compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the cost
7791
of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.
7792
 
7793
@item -mtp=@var{name}
7794
@opindex mtp
7795
Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer.  The valid
7796
models are @option{soft}, which generates calls to @code{__aeabi_read_tp},
7797
@option{cp15}, which fetches the thread pointer from @code{cp15} directly
7798
(supported in the arm6k architecture), and @option{auto}, which uses the
7799
best available method for the selected processor.  The default setting is
7800
@option{auto}.
7801
 
7802
@end table
7803
 
7804
@node AVR Options
7805
@subsection AVR Options
7806
@cindex AVR Options
7807
 
7808
These options are defined for AVR implementations:
7809
 
7810
@table @gcctabopt
7811
@item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
7812
@opindex mmcu
7813
Specify ATMEL AVR instruction set or MCU type.
7814
 
7815
Instruction set avr1 is for the minimal AVR core, not supported by the C
7816
compiler, only for assembler programs (MCU types: at90s1200, attiny10,
7817
attiny11, attiny12, attiny15, attiny28).
7818
 
7819
Instruction set avr2 (default) is for the classic AVR core with up to
7820
8K program memory space (MCU types: at90s2313, at90s2323, attiny22,
7821
at90s2333, at90s2343, at90s4414, at90s4433, at90s4434, at90s8515,
7822
at90c8534, at90s8535).
7823
 
7824
Instruction set avr3 is for the classic AVR core with up to 128K program
7825
memory space (MCU types: atmega103, atmega603, at43usb320, at76c711).
7826
 
7827
Instruction set avr4 is for the enhanced AVR core with up to 8K program
7828
memory space (MCU types: atmega8, atmega83, atmega85).
7829
 
7830
Instruction set avr5 is for the enhanced AVR core with up to 128K program
7831
memory space (MCU types: atmega16, atmega161, atmega163, atmega32, atmega323,
7832
atmega64, atmega128, at43usb355, at94k).
7833
 
7834
@item -msize
7835
@opindex msize
7836
Output instruction sizes to the asm file.
7837
 
7838
@item -minit-stack=@var{N}
7839
@opindex minit-stack
7840
Specify the initial stack address, which may be a symbol or numeric value,
7841
@samp{__stack} is the default.
7842
 
7843
@item -mno-interrupts
7844
@opindex mno-interrupts
7845
Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
7846
Code size will be smaller.
7847
 
7848
@item -mcall-prologues
7849
@opindex mcall-prologues
7850
Functions prologues/epilogues expanded as call to appropriate
7851
subroutines.  Code size will be smaller.
7852
 
7853
@item -mno-tablejump
7854
@opindex mno-tablejump
7855
Do not generate tablejump insns which sometimes increase code size.
7856
 
7857
@item -mtiny-stack
7858
@opindex mtiny-stack
7859
Change only the low 8 bits of the stack pointer.
7860
 
7861
@item -mint8
7862
@opindex mint8
7863
Assume int to be 8 bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: A
7864
char will be 1 byte, an int will be 1 byte, an long will be 2 bytes
7865
and long long will be 4 bytes.  Please note that this option does not
7866
comply to the C standards, but it will provide you with smaller code
7867
size.
7868
@end table
7869
 
7870
@node Blackfin Options
7871
@subsection Blackfin Options
7872
@cindex Blackfin Options
7873
 
7874
@table @gcctabopt
7875
@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
7876
@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
7877
Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
7878
avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
7879
makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
7880
@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions
7881
which might make debugging harder.
7882
 
7883
@item -mspecld-anomaly
7884
@opindex mspecld-anomaly
7885
When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
7886
contain speculative loads after jump instructions.  This option is enabled
7887
by default.
7888
 
7889
@item -mno-specld-anomaly
7890
@opindex mno-specld-anomaly
7891
Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.
7892
 
7893
@item -mcsync-anomaly
7894
@opindex mcsync-anomaly
7895
When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
7896
contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional branches.
7897
This option is enabled by default.
7898
 
7899
@item -mno-csync-anomaly
7900
@opindex mno-csync-anomaly
7901
Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from
7902
occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
7903
 
7904
@item -mlow-64k
7905
@opindex mlow-64k
7906
When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that
7907
the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
7908
 
7909
@item -mno-low-64k
7910
@opindex mno-low-64k
7911
Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.
7912
 
7913
@item -mid-shared-library
7914
@opindex mid-shared-library
7915
Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
7916
This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
7917
without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
7918
 
7919
@item -mno-id-shared-library
7920
@opindex mno-id-shared-library
7921
Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
7922
This is the default.
7923
 
7924
@item -mshared-library-id=n
7925
@opindex mshared-library-id
7926
Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
7927
compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
7928
other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
7929
library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
7930
 
7931
@item -mlong-calls
7932
@itemx -mno-long-calls
7933
@opindex mlong-calls
7934
@opindex mno-long-calls
7935
Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
7936
address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
7937
call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
7938
will lie outside of the 24 bit addressing range of the offset based
7939
version of subroutine call instruction.
7940
 
7941
This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
7942
@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior.  Note these
7943
switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle
7944
function calls via function pointers.
7945
@end table
7946
 
7947
@node CRIS Options
7948
@subsection CRIS Options
7949
@cindex CRIS Options
7950
 
7951
These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
7952
 
7953
@table @gcctabopt
7954
@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
7955
@itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
7956
@opindex march
7957
@opindex mcpu
7958
Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
7959
@var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
7960
respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX@.
7961
Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
7962
@samp{v10}.
7963
 
7964
@item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
7965
@opindex mtune
7966
Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
7967
code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The
7968
choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
7969
@option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
7970
 
7971
@item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
7972
@opindex mmax-stack-frame
7973
Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
7974
 
7975
@item -melinux-stacksize=@var{n}
7976
@opindex melinux-stacksize
7977
Only available with the @samp{cris-axis-aout} target.  Arranges for
7978
indications in the program to the kernel loader that the stack of the
7979
program should be set to @var{n} bytes.
7980
 
7981
@item -metrax4
7982
@itemx -metrax100
7983
@opindex metrax4
7984
@opindex metrax100
7985
The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
7986
@option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
7987
 
7988
@item -mmul-bug-workaround
7989
@itemx -mno-mul-bug-workaround
7990
@opindex mmul-bug-workaround
7991
@opindex mno-mul-bug-workaround
7992
Work around a bug in the @code{muls} and @code{mulu} instructions for CPU
7993
models where it applies.  This option is active by default.
7994
 
7995
@item -mpdebug
7996
@opindex mpdebug
7997
Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
7998
code.  This option also has the effect to turn off the @samp{#NO_APP}
7999
formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
8000
assembly file.
8001
 
8002
@item -mcc-init
8003
@opindex mcc-init
8004
Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
8005
compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
8006
 
8007
@item -mno-side-effects
8008
@opindex mno-side-effects
8009
Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than
8010
post-increment.
8011
 
8012
@item -mstack-align
8013
@itemx -mno-stack-align
8014
@itemx -mdata-align
8015
@itemx -mno-data-align
8016
@itemx -mconst-align
8017
@itemx -mno-const-align
8018
@opindex mstack-align
8019
@opindex mno-stack-align
8020
@opindex mdata-align
8021
@opindex mno-data-align
8022
@opindex mconst-align
8023
@opindex mno-const-align
8024
These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the
8025
stack-frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
8026
single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The default is to
8027
arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are
8028
not affected by these options.
8029
 
8030
@item -m32-bit
8031
@itemx -m16-bit
8032
@itemx -m8-bit
8033
@opindex m32-bit
8034
@opindex m16-bit
8035
@opindex m8-bit
8036
Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
8037
arrange for stack-frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
8038
16-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit alignment.
8039
 
8040
@item -mno-prologue-epilogue
8041
@itemx -mprologue-epilogue
8042
@opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
8043
@opindex mprologue-epilogue
8044
With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
8045
epilogue that sets up the stack-frame are omitted and no return
8046
instructions or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
8047
option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
8048
warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
8049
or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.
8050
 
8051
@item -mno-gotplt
8052
@itemx -mgotplt
8053
@opindex mno-gotplt
8054
@opindex mgotplt
8055
With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
8056
instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
8057
of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
8058
PLT@.  The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
8059
 
8060
@item -maout
8061
@opindex maout
8062
Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-aout target.
8063
 
8064
@item -melf
8065
@opindex melf
8066
Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
8067
cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
8068
 
8069
@item -melinux
8070
@opindex melinux
8071
Only recognized with the cris-axis-aout target, where it selects a
8072
GNU/linux-like multilib, include files and instruction set for
8073
@option{-march=v8}.
8074
 
8075
@item -mlinux
8076
@opindex mlinux
8077
Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
8078
 
8079
@item -sim
8080
@opindex sim
8081
This option, recognized for the cris-axis-aout and cris-axis-elf arranges
8082
to link with input-output functions from a simulator library.  Code,
8083
initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
8084
 
8085
@item -sim2
8086
@opindex sim2
8087
Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
8088
0x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
8089
@end table
8090
 
8091
@node CRX Options
8092
@subsection CRX Options
8093
@cindex CRX Options
8094
 
8095
These options are defined specifically for the CRX ports.
8096
 
8097
@table @gcctabopt
8098
 
8099
@item -mmac
8100
@opindex mmac
8101
Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
8102
 
8103
@item -mpush-args
8104
@opindex mpush-args
8105
Push instructions will be used to pass outgoing arguments when functions
8106
are called. Enabled by default.
8107
@end table
8108
 
8109
@node Darwin Options
8110
@subsection Darwin Options
8111
@cindex Darwin options
8112
 
8113
These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating
8114
system.
8115
 
8116
FSF GCC on Darwin does not create ``fat'' object files; it will create
8117
an object file for the single architecture that it was built to
8118
target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create ``fat'' files if multiple
8119
@option{-arch} options are used; it does so by running the compiler or
8120
linker multiple times and joining the results together with
8121
@file{lipo}.
8122
 
8123
The subtype of the file created (like @samp{ppc7400} or @samp{ppc970} or
8124
@samp{i686}) is determined by the flags that specify the ISA
8125
that GCC is targetting, like @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march}.  The
8126
@option{-force_cpusubtype_ALL} option can be used to override this.
8127
 
8128
The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
8129
mismatch.  The assembler, @file{as}, will only permit instructions to
8130
be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,
8131
so you cannot put 64-bit instructions in an @samp{ppc750} object file.
8132
The linker for shared libraries, @file{/usr/bin/libtool}, will fail
8133
and print an error if asked to create a shared library with a less
8134
restrictive subtype than its input files (for instance, trying to put
8135
a @samp{ppc970} object file in a @samp{ppc7400} library).  The linker
8136
for executables, @file{ld}, will quietly give the executable the most
8137
restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
8138
 
8139
@table @gcctabopt
8140
@item -F@var{dir}
8141
@opindex F
8142
Add the framework directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of
8143
directories to be searched for header files.  These directories are
8144
interleaved with those specified by @option{-I} options and are
8145
scanned in a left-to-right order.
8146
 
8147
A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it.  A
8148
framework is a directory with a @samp{"Headers"} and/or
8149
@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} directory contained directly in it that ends
8150
in @samp{".framework"}.  The name of a framework is the name of this
8151
directory excluding the @samp{".framework"}.  Headers associated with
8152
the framework are found in one of those two directories, with
8153
@samp{"Headers"} being searched first.  A subframework is a framework
8154
directory that is in a framework's @samp{"Frameworks"} directory.
8155
Includes of subframework headers can only appear in a header of a
8156
framework that contains the subframework, or in a sibling subframework
8157
header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same
8158
framework.  A subframework should not have the same name as a
8159
framework, a warning will be issued if this is violated.  Currently a
8160
subframework cannot have subframeworks, in the future, the mechanism
8161
may be extended to support this.  The standard frameworks can be found
8162
in @samp{"/System/Library/Frameworks"} and
8163
@samp{"/Library/Frameworks"}.  An example include looks like
8164
@code{#include <Framework/header.h>}, where @samp{Framework} denotes
8165
the name of the framework and header.h is found in the
8166
@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} or @samp{"Headers"} directory.
8167
 
8168
@item -gused
8169
@opindex gused
8170
Emit debugging information for symbols that are used.  For STABS
8171
debugging format, this enables @option{-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols}.
8172
This is by default ON@.
8173
 
8174
@item -gfull
8175
@opindex gfull
8176
Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
8177
 
8178
@item -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version}
8179
The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on
8180
is @var{version}.  Typical values of @var{version} include @code{10.1},
8181
@code{10.2}, and @code{10.3.9}.
8182
 
8183
The default for this option is to make choices that seem to be most
8184
useful.
8185
 
8186
@item -mkernel
8187
@opindex mkernel
8188
Enable kernel development mode.  The @option{-mkernel} option sets
8189
@option{-static}, @option{-fno-common}, @option{-fno-cxa-atexit},
8190
@option{-fno-exceptions}, @option{-fno-non-call-exceptions},
8191
@option{-fapple-kext}, @option{-fno-weak} and @option{-fno-rtti} where
8192
applicable.  This mode also sets @option{-mno-altivec},
8193
@option{-msoft-float}, @option{-fno-builtin} and
8194
@option{-mlong-branch} for PowerPC targets.
8195
 
8196
@item -mone-byte-bool
8197
@opindex mone-byte-bool
8198
Override the defaults for @samp{bool} so that @samp{sizeof(bool)==1}.
8199
By default @samp{sizeof(bool)} is @samp{4} when compiling for
8200
Darwin/PowerPC and @samp{1} when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this
8201
option has no effect on x86.
8202
 
8203
@strong{Warning:} The @option{-mone-byte-bool} switch causes GCC
8204
to generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated
8205
without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all
8206
other modules in a program, including system libraries.  Use this
8207
switch to conform to a non-default data model.
8208
 
8209
@item -mfix-and-continue
8210
@itemx -ffix-and-continue
8211
@itemx -findirect-data
8212
@opindex mfix-and-continue
8213
@opindex ffix-and-continue
8214
@opindex findirect-data
8215
Generate code suitable for fast turn around development.  Needed to
8216
enable gdb to dynamically load @code{.o} files into already running
8217
programs.  @option{-findirect-data} and @option{-ffix-and-continue}
8218
are provided for backwards compatibility.
8219
 
8220
@item -all_load
8221
@opindex all_load
8222
Loads all members of static archive libraries.
8223
See man ld(1) for more information.
8224
 
8225
@item -arch_errors_fatal
8226
@opindex arch_errors_fatal
8227
Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
8228
to be fatal.
8229
 
8230
@item -bind_at_load
8231
@opindex bind_at_load
8232
Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
8233
bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
8234
 
8235
@item -bundle
8236
@opindex bundle
8237
Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
8238
See man ld(1) for more information.
8239
 
8240
@item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
8241
@opindex bundle_loader
8242
This option specifies the @var{executable} that will be loading the build
8243
output file being linked.  See man ld(1) for more information.
8244
 
8245
@item -dynamiclib
8246
@opindex dynamiclib
8247
When passed this option, GCC will produce a dynamic library instead of
8248
an executable when linking, using the Darwin @file{libtool} command.
8249
 
8250
@item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
8251
@opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
8252
This causes GCC's output file to have the @var{ALL} subtype, instead of
8253
one controlled by the @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march} option.
8254
 
8255
@item -allowable_client  @var{client_name}
8256
@itemx -client_name
8257
@itemx -compatibility_version
8258
@itemx -current_version
8259
@itemx -dead_strip
8260
@itemx -dependency-file
8261
@itemx -dylib_file
8262
@itemx -dylinker_install_name
8263
@itemx -dynamic
8264
@itemx -exported_symbols_list
8265
@itemx -filelist
8266
@itemx -flat_namespace
8267
@itemx -force_flat_namespace
8268
@itemx -headerpad_max_install_names
8269
@itemx -image_base
8270
@itemx -init
8271
@itemx -install_name
8272
@itemx -keep_private_externs
8273
@itemx -multi_module
8274
@itemx -multiply_defined
8275
@itemx -multiply_defined_unused
8276
@itemx -noall_load
8277
@itemx -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
8278
@itemx -nofixprebinding
8279
@itemx -nomultidefs
8280
@itemx -noprebind
8281
@itemx -noseglinkedit
8282
@itemx -pagezero_size
8283
@itemx -prebind
8284
@itemx -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
8285
@itemx -private_bundle
8286
@itemx -read_only_relocs
8287
@itemx -sectalign
8288
@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
8289
@itemx -whyload
8290
@itemx -seg1addr
8291
@itemx -sectcreate
8292
@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
8293
@itemx -sectorder
8294
@itemx -segaddr
8295
@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
8296
@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
8297
@itemx -seg_addr_table
8298
@itemx -seg_addr_table_filename
8299
@itemx -seglinkedit
8300
@itemx -segprot
8301
@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
8302
@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
8303
@itemx -single_module
8304
@itemx -static
8305
@itemx -sub_library
8306
@itemx -sub_umbrella
8307
@itemx -twolevel_namespace
8308
@itemx -umbrella
8309
@itemx -undefined
8310
@itemx -unexported_symbols_list
8311
@itemx -weak_reference_mismatches
8312
@itemx -whatsloaded
8313
 
8314
@opindex allowable_client
8315
@opindex client_name
8316
@opindex compatibility_version
8317
@opindex current_version
8318
@opindex dead_strip
8319
@opindex dependency-file
8320
@opindex dylib_file
8321
@opindex dylinker_install_name
8322
@opindex dynamic
8323
@opindex exported_symbols_list
8324
@opindex filelist
8325
@opindex flat_namespace
8326
@opindex force_flat_namespace
8327
@opindex headerpad_max_install_names
8328
@opindex image_base
8329
@opindex init
8330
@opindex install_name
8331
@opindex keep_private_externs
8332
@opindex multi_module
8333
@opindex multiply_defined
8334
@opindex multiply_defined_unused
8335
@opindex noall_load
8336
@opindex no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
8337
@opindex nofixprebinding
8338
@opindex nomultidefs
8339
@opindex noprebind
8340
@opindex noseglinkedit
8341
@opindex pagezero_size
8342
@opindex prebind
8343
@opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
8344
@opindex private_bundle
8345
@opindex read_only_relocs
8346
@opindex sectalign
8347
@opindex sectobjectsymbols
8348
@opindex whyload
8349
@opindex seg1addr
8350
@opindex sectcreate
8351
@opindex sectobjectsymbols
8352
@opindex sectorder
8353
@opindex segaddr
8354
@opindex segs_read_only_addr
8355
@opindex segs_read_write_addr
8356
@opindex seg_addr_table
8357
@opindex seg_addr_table_filename
8358
@opindex seglinkedit
8359
@opindex segprot
8360
@opindex segs_read_only_addr
8361
@opindex segs_read_write_addr
8362
@opindex single_module
8363
@opindex static
8364
@opindex sub_library
8365
@opindex sub_umbrella
8366
@opindex twolevel_namespace
8367
@opindex umbrella
8368
@opindex undefined
8369
@opindex unexported_symbols_list
8370
@opindex weak_reference_mismatches
8371
@opindex whatsloaded
8372
 
8373
These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page
8374
describes them in detail.
8375
@end table
8376
 
8377
@node DEC Alpha Options
8378
@subsection DEC Alpha Options
8379
 
8380
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
8381
 
8382
@table @gcctabopt
8383
@item -mno-soft-float
8384
@itemx -msoft-float
8385
@opindex mno-soft-float
8386
@opindex msoft-float
8387
Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
8388
floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
8389
functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
8390
operations.  Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
8391
floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
8392
emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point
8393
operations.   If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
8394
operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
8395
them.
8396
 
8397
Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
8398
required to have floating-point registers.
8399
 
8400
@item -mfp-reg
8401
@itemx -mno-fp-regs
8402
@opindex mfp-reg
8403
@opindex mno-fp-regs
8404
Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
8405
@option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}.  If the floating-point
8406
register set is not used, floating point operands are passed in integer
8407
registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
8408
in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}.  This is a non-standard calling sequence,
8409
so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
8410
compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
8411
option.
8412
 
8413
A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
8414
and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
8415
 
8416
@item -mieee
8417
@opindex mieee
8418
The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
8419
maximum performance.  It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating
8420
point standard.  However, for full compliance, software assistance is
8421
required.  This option generates code fully IEEE compliant code
8422
@emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
8423
If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
8424
defined during compilation.  The resulting code is less efficient but is
8425
able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
8426
values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha
8427
compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
8428
 
8429
@item -mieee-with-inexact
8430
@opindex mieee-with-inexact
8431
This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
8432
the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}.  Turning on this option causes the
8433
generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to
8434
@code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
8435
macro.  On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
8436
significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is
8437
very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
8438
normally not specify this option.  Other Alpha compilers call this
8439
option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
8440
 
8441
@item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
8442
@opindex mfp-trap-mode
8443
This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
8444
Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
8445
The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
8446
 
8447
@table @samp
8448
@item n
8449
This is the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled
8450
are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
8451
trap).
8452
 
8453
@item u
8454
In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
8455
as well.
8456
 
8457
@item su
8458
Like @samp{u}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
8459
completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
8460
 
8461
@item sui
8462
Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
8463
@end table
8464
 
8465
@item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
8466
@opindex mfp-rounding-mode
8467
Selects the IEEE rounding mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this option
8468
@option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}.  The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
8469
of:
8470
 
8471
@table @samp
8472
@item n
8473
Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating point numbers are rounded towards
8474
the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
8475
of a tie.
8476
 
8477
@item m
8478
Round towards minus infinity.
8479
 
8480
@item c
8481
Chopped rounding mode.  Floating point numbers are rounded towards zero.
8482
 
8483
@item d
8484
Dynamic rounding mode.  A field in the floating point control register
8485
(@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
8486
rounding mode in effect.  The C library initializes this register for
8487
rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the
8488
@var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
8489
@end table
8490
 
8491
@item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
8492
@opindex mtrap-precision
8493
In the Alpha architecture, floating point traps are imprecise.  This
8494
means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
8495
floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
8496
GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
8497
in determining the exact location that caused a floating point trap.
8498
Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
8499
precisions can be selected:
8500
 
8501
@table @samp
8502
@item p
8503
Program precision.  This option is the default and means a trap handler
8504
can only identify which program caused a floating point exception.
8505
 
8506
@item f
8507
Function precision.  The trap handler can determine the function that
8508
caused a floating point exception.
8509
 
8510
@item i
8511
Instruction precision.  The trap handler can determine the exact
8512
instruction that caused a floating point exception.
8513
@end table
8514
 
8515
Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
8516
@option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
8517
 
8518
@item -mieee-conformant
8519
@opindex mieee-conformant
8520
This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not
8521
use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
8522
@option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}.  Its only effect
8523
is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
8524
generated assembly file.  Under DEC Unix, this has the effect that
8525
IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.
8526
 
8527
@item -mbuild-constants
8528
@opindex mbuild-constants
8529
Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
8530
see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
8531
instructions.  If it cannot, it will output the constant as a literal and
8532
generate code to load it from the data segment at runtime.
8533
 
8534
Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
8535
using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
8536
 
8537
You would typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
8538
loader.  Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
8539
before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
8540
 
8541
@item -malpha-as
8542
@itemx -mgas
8543
@opindex malpha-as
8544
@opindex mgas
8545
Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied
8546
assembler (@option{-malpha-as}) or by the GNU assembler @option{-mgas}.
8547
 
8548
@item -mbwx
8549
@itemx -mno-bwx
8550
@itemx -mcix
8551
@itemx -mno-cix
8552
@itemx -mfix
8553
@itemx -mno-fix
8554
@itemx -mmax
8555
@itemx -mno-max
8556
@opindex mbwx
8557
@opindex mno-bwx
8558
@opindex mcix
8559
@opindex mno-cix
8560
@opindex mfix
8561
@opindex mno-fix
8562
@opindex mmax
8563
@opindex mno-max
8564
Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
8565
CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.  The default is to use the instruction
8566
sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
8567
of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.
8568
 
8569
@item -mfloat-vax
8570
@itemx -mfloat-ieee
8571
@opindex mfloat-vax
8572
@opindex mfloat-ieee
8573
Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating point
8574
arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
8575
 
8576
@item -mexplicit-relocs
8577
@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
8578
@opindex mexplicit-relocs
8579
@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
8580
Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
8581
except via assembler macros.  Use of these macros does not allow
8582
optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of version 2.12
8583
supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
8584
which relocations should apply to which instructions.  This option
8585
is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
8586
the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
8587
 
8588
@item -msmall-data
8589
@itemx -mlarge-data
8590
@opindex msmall-data
8591
@opindex mlarge-data
8592
When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
8593
accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations.  When @option{-msmall-data}
8594
is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
8595
(the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
8596
16-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register.  This limits the
8597
size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
8598
directly accessed via a single instruction.
8599
 
8600
The default is @option{-mlarge-data}.  With this option the data area
8601
is limited to just below 2GB@.  Programs that require more than 2GB of
8602
data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
8603
heap instead of in the program's data segment.
8604
 
8605
When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
8606
@option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
8607
 
8608
@item -msmall-text
8609
@itemx -mlarge-text
8610
@opindex msmall-text
8611
@opindex mlarge-text
8612
When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
8613
code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
8614
thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When @option{-msmall-data}
8615
is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
8616
same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
8617
required for a function call from 4 to 1.
8618
 
8619
The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
8620
 
8621
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
8622
@opindex mcpu
8623
Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
8624
machine type @var{cpu_type}.  You can specify either the @samp{EV}
8625
style name or the corresponding chip number.  GCC supports scheduling
8626
parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will
8627
choose the default values for the instruction set from the processor
8628
you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will default
8629
to the processor on which the compiler was built.
8630
 
8631
Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
8632
 
8633
@table @samp
8634
@item ev4
8635
@itemx ev45
8636
@itemx 21064
8637
Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
8638
 
8639
@item ev5
8640
@itemx 21164
8641
Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
8642
 
8643
@item ev56
8644
@itemx 21164a
8645
Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
8646
 
8647
@item pca56
8648
@itemx 21164pc
8649
@itemx 21164PC
8650
Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
8651
 
8652
@item ev6
8653
@itemx 21264
8654
Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
8655
 
8656
@item ev67
8657
@itemx 21264a
8658
Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
8659
@end table
8660
 
8661
@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
8662
@opindex mtune
8663
Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
8664
@var{cpu_type}.  The instruction set is not changed.
8665
 
8666
@item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
8667
@opindex mmemory-latency
8668
Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
8669
references as seen by the application.  This number is highly
8670
dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
8671
and the size of the external cache on the machine.
8672
 
8673
Valid options for @var{time} are
8674
 
8675
@table @samp
8676
@item @var{number}
8677
A decimal number representing clock cycles.
8678
 
8679
@item L1
8680
@itemx L2
8681
@itemx L3
8682
@itemx main
8683
The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
8684
``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
8685
(also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
8686
Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
8687
 
8688
@end table
8689
@end table
8690
 
8691
@node DEC Alpha/VMS Options
8692
@subsection DEC Alpha/VMS Options
8693
 
8694
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:
8695
 
8696
@table @gcctabopt
8697
@item -mvms-return-codes
8698
@opindex mvms-return-codes
8699
Return VMS condition codes from main.  The default is to return POSIX
8700
style condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
8701
@end table
8702
 
8703
@node FRV Options
8704
@subsection FRV Options
8705
@cindex FRV Options
8706
 
8707
@table @gcctabopt
8708
@item -mgpr-32
8709
@opindex mgpr-32
8710
 
8711
Only use the first 32 general purpose registers.
8712
 
8713
@item -mgpr-64
8714
@opindex mgpr-64
8715
 
8716
Use all 64 general purpose registers.
8717
 
8718
@item -mfpr-32
8719
@opindex mfpr-32
8720
 
8721
Use only the first 32 floating point registers.
8722
 
8723
@item -mfpr-64
8724
@opindex mfpr-64
8725
 
8726
Use all 64 floating point registers
8727
 
8728
@item -mhard-float
8729
@opindex mhard-float
8730
 
8731
Use hardware instructions for floating point operations.
8732
 
8733
@item -msoft-float
8734
@opindex msoft-float
8735
 
8736
Use library routines for floating point operations.
8737
 
8738
@item -malloc-cc
8739
@opindex malloc-cc
8740
 
8741
Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
8742
 
8743
@item -mfixed-cc
8744
@opindex mfixed-cc
8745
 
8746
Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
8747
use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
8748
 
8749
@item -mdword
8750
@opindex mdword
8751
 
8752
Change ABI to use double word insns.
8753
 
8754
@item -mno-dword
8755
@opindex mno-dword
8756
 
8757
Do not use double word instructions.
8758
 
8759
@item -mdouble
8760
@opindex mdouble
8761
 
8762
Use floating point double instructions.
8763
 
8764
@item -mno-double
8765
@opindex mno-double
8766
 
8767
Do not use floating point double instructions.
8768
 
8769
@item -mmedia
8770
@opindex mmedia
8771
 
8772
Use media instructions.
8773
 
8774
@item -mno-media
8775
@opindex mno-media
8776
 
8777
Do not use media instructions.
8778
 
8779
@item -mmuladd
8780
@opindex mmuladd
8781
 
8782
Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
8783
 
8784
@item -mno-muladd
8785
@opindex mno-muladd
8786
 
8787
Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
8788
 
8789
@item -mfdpic
8790
@opindex mfdpic
8791
 
8792
Select the FDPIC ABI, that uses function descriptors to represent
8793
pointers to functions.  Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
8794
implies @option{-fPIE}.  With @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}, it
8795
assumes GOT entries and small data are within a 12-bit range from the
8796
GOT base address; with @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, GOT offsets
8797
are computed with 32 bits.
8798
 
8799
@item -minline-plt
8800
@opindex minline-plt
8801
 
8802
Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
8803
not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
8804
It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
8805
shared libraries (i.e., @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fpic}), or when an
8806
optimization option such as @option{-O3} or above is present in the
8807
command line.
8808
 
8809
@item -mTLS
8810
@opindex TLS
8811
 
8812
Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
8813
 
8814
@item -mtls
8815
@opindex tls
8816
 
8817
Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
8818
 
8819
@item -mgprel-ro
8820
@opindex mgprel-ro
8821
 
8822
Enable the use of @code{GPREL} relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
8823
that is known to be in read-only sections.  It's enabled by default,
8824
except for @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}: even though it may help
8825
make the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
8826
With @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, it trades 3 instructions for 4,
8827
one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need
8828
for a GOT entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a
8829
win.  If it is not, @option{-mno-gprel-ro} can be used to disable it.
8830
 
8831
@item -multilib-library-pic
8832
@opindex multilib-library-pic
8833
 
8834
Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by
8835
@option{-mlibrary-pic}, as well as by @option{-fPIC} and
8836
@option{-fpic} without @option{-mfdpic}.  You should never have to use
8837
it explicitly.
8838
 
8839
@item -mlinked-fp
8840
@opindex mlinked-fp
8841
 
8842
Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever
8843
a stack frame is allocated.  This option is enabled by default and can
8844
be disabled with @option{-mno-linked-fp}.
8845
 
8846
@item -mlong-calls
8847
@opindex mlong-calls
8848
 
8849
Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
8850
compilation unit.  This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
8851
within the 32-bit address space.
8852
 
8853
@item -malign-labels
8854
@opindex malign-labels
8855
 
8856
Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting nops into the
8857
previous packet.  This option only has an effect when VLIW packing
8858
is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds nops to
8859
existing ones.
8860
 
8861
@item -mlibrary-pic
8862
@opindex mlibrary-pic
8863
 
8864
Generate position-independent EABI code.
8865
 
8866
@item -macc-4
8867
@opindex macc-4
8868
 
8869
Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
8870
 
8871
@item -macc-8
8872
@opindex macc-8
8873
 
8874
Use all eight media accumulator registers.
8875
 
8876
@item -mpack
8877
@opindex mpack
8878
 
8879
Pack VLIW instructions.
8880
 
8881
@item -mno-pack
8882
@opindex mno-pack
8883
 
8884
Do not pack VLIW instructions.
8885
 
8886
@item -mno-eflags
8887
@opindex mno-eflags
8888
 
8889
Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
8890
 
8891
@item -mcond-move
8892
@opindex mcond-move
8893
 
8894
Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
8895
 
8896
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8897
in a future version.
8898
 
8899
@item -mno-cond-move
8900
@opindex mno-cond-move
8901
 
8902
Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
8903
 
8904
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8905
in a future version.
8906
 
8907
@item -mscc
8908
@opindex mscc
8909
 
8910
Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
8911
 
8912
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8913
in a future version.
8914
 
8915
@item -mno-scc
8916
@opindex mno-scc
8917
 
8918
Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
8919
 
8920
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8921
in a future version.
8922
 
8923
@item -mcond-exec
8924
@opindex mcond-exec
8925
 
8926
Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
8927
 
8928
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8929
in a future version.
8930
 
8931
@item -mno-cond-exec
8932
@opindex mno-cond-exec
8933
 
8934
Disable the use of conditional execution.
8935
 
8936
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8937
in a future version.
8938
 
8939
@item -mvliw-branch
8940
@opindex mvliw-branch
8941
 
8942
Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
8943
 
8944
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8945
in a future version.
8946
 
8947
@item -mno-vliw-branch
8948
@opindex mno-vliw-branch
8949
 
8950
Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
8951
 
8952
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8953
in a future version.
8954
 
8955
@item -mmulti-cond-exec
8956
@opindex mmulti-cond-exec
8957
 
8958
Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
8959
(default).
8960
 
8961
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8962
in a future version.
8963
 
8964
@item -mno-multi-cond-exec
8965
@opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
8966
 
8967
Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
8968
 
8969
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8970
in a future version.
8971
 
8972
@item -mnested-cond-exec
8973
@opindex mnested-cond-exec
8974
 
8975
Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
8976
 
8977
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8978
in a future version.
8979
 
8980
@item -mno-nested-cond-exec
8981
@opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
8982
 
8983
Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
8984
 
8985
This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
8986
in a future version.
8987
 
8988
@item -moptimize-membar
8989
@opindex moptimize-membar
8990
 
8991
This switch removes redundant @code{membar} instructions from the
8992
compiler generated code.  It is enabled by default.
8993
 
8994
@item -mno-optimize-membar
8995
@opindex mno-optimize-membar
8996
 
8997
This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant @code{membar}
8998
instructions from the generated code.
8999
 
9000
@item -mtomcat-stats
9001
@opindex mtomcat-stats
9002
 
9003
Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
9004
 
9005
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
9006
@opindex mcpu
9007
 
9008
Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are
9009
@samp{frv}, @samp{fr550}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr450},
9010
@samp{fr405}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300} and @samp{simple}.
9011
 
9012
@end table
9013
 
9014
@node GNU/Linux Options
9015
@subsection GNU/Linux Options
9016
 
9017
These @samp{-m} options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
9018
 
9019
@table @gcctabopt
9020
@item -mglibc
9021
@opindex mglibc
9022
Use the GNU C library instead of uClibc.  This is the default except
9023
on @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
9024
 
9025
@item -muclibc
9026
@opindex muclibc
9027
Use uClibc instead of the GNU C library.  This is the default on
9028
@samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
9029
@end table
9030
 
9031
@node H8/300 Options
9032
@subsection H8/300 Options
9033
 
9034
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
9035
 
9036
@table @gcctabopt
9037
@item -mrelax
9038
@opindex mrelax
9039
Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
9040
linker option @option{-relax}.  @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
9041
ld, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
9042
 
9043
@item -mh
9044
@opindex mh
9045
Generate code for the H8/300H@.
9046
 
9047
@item -ms
9048
@opindex ms
9049
Generate code for the H8S@.
9050
 
9051
@item -mn
9052
@opindex mn
9053
Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch
9054
must be used either with @option{-mh} or @option{-ms}.
9055
 
9056
@item -ms2600
9057
@opindex ms2600
9058
Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
9059
 
9060
@item -mint32
9061
@opindex mint32
9062
Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
9063
 
9064
@item -malign-300
9065
@opindex malign-300
9066
On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
9067
The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on 4
9068
byte boundaries.
9069
@option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2 byte boundaries.
9070
This option has no effect on the H8/300.
9071
@end table
9072
 
9073
@node HPPA Options
9074
@subsection HPPA Options
9075
@cindex HPPA Options
9076
 
9077
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
9078
 
9079
@table @gcctabopt
9080
@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
9081
@opindex march
9082
Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
9083
@var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
9084
1.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to
9085
@file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
9086
architecture option for your machine.  Code compiled for lower numbered
9087
architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the
9088
other way around.
9089
 
9090
@item -mpa-risc-1-0
9091
@itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
9092
@itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
9093
@opindex mpa-risc-1-0
9094
@opindex mpa-risc-1-1
9095
@opindex mpa-risc-2-0
9096
Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
9097
 
9098
@item -mbig-switch
9099
@opindex mbig-switch
9100
Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
9101
the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
9102
table.
9103
 
9104
@item -mjump-in-delay
9105
@opindex mjump-in-delay
9106
Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
9107
by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
9108
of the conditional jump.
9109
 
9110
@item -mdisable-fpregs
9111
@opindex mdisable-fpregs
9112
Prevent floating point registers from being used in any manner.  This is
9113
necessary for compiling kernels which perform lazy context switching of
9114
floating point registers.  If you use this option and attempt to perform
9115
floating point operations, the compiler will abort.
9116
 
9117
@item -mdisable-indexing
9118
@opindex mdisable-indexing
9119
Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes.  This avoids some
9120
rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
9121
 
9122
@item -mno-space-regs
9123
@opindex mno-space-regs
9124
Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers.  This allows
9125
GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
9126
 
9127
Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
9128
 
9129
@item -mfast-indirect-calls
9130
@opindex mfast-indirect-calls
9131
Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.  This
9132
allows GCC to emit code which performs faster indirect calls.
9133
 
9134
This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
9135
functions.
9136
 
9137
@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
9138
@opindex mfixed-range
9139
Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
9140
A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
9141
useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
9142
two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
9143
specified separated by a comma.
9144
 
9145
@item -mlong-load-store
9146
@opindex mlong-load-store
9147
Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
9148
the HP-UX 10 linker.  This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
9149
the HP compilers.
9150
 
9151
@item -mportable-runtime
9152
@opindex mportable-runtime
9153
Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
9154
 
9155
@item -mgas
9156
@opindex mgas
9157
Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
9158
 
9159
@item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
9160
@opindex mschedule
9161
Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
9162
@var{cpu-type}.  The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
9163
@samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}.  Refer
9164
to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
9165
proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is
9166
@samp{8000}.
9167
 
9168
@item -mlinker-opt
9169
@opindex mlinker-opt
9170
Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic
9171
debugging impossible.  It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
9172
linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
9173
 
9174
@item -msoft-float
9175
@opindex msoft-float
9176
Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
9177
@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
9178
targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
9179
used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
9180
your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
9181
cross-compilation.  The embedded target @samp{hppa1.1-*-pro}
9182
does provide software floating point support.
9183
 
9184
@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
9185
therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
9186
this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
9187
library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
9188
this to work.
9189
 
9190
@item -msio
9191
@opindex msio
9192
Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO@.  The default is
9193
@option{-mwsio}.  This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
9194
@code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO@.  These
9195
options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX@.
9196
 
9197
@item -mgnu-ld
9198
@opindex gnu-ld
9199
Use GNU ld specific options.  This passes @option{-shared} to ld when
9200
building a shared library.  It is the default when GCC is configured,
9201
explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
9202
have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters
9203
are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the
9204
@option{--with-ld} configure option, GCC's program search path, and
9205
finally by the user's @env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed
9206
using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available
9207
on the 64 bit HP-UX GCC, i.e. configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
9208
 
9209
@item -mhp-ld
9210
@opindex hp-ld
9211
Use HP ld specific options.  This passes @option{-b} to ld when building
9212
a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to ld on all
9213
links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
9214
implicitly, with the HP linker.  This option does not have any affect on
9215
which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that
9216
ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
9217
configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's
9218
@env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
9219
`gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available on the 64 bit
9220
HP-UX GCC, i.e. configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
9221
 
9222
@item -mlong-calls
9223
@opindex mno-long-calls
9224
Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call
9225
is always able to reach linker generated stubs.  The default is to generate
9226
long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
9227
of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
9228
predefined limit set by the branch type being used.  The limits for
9229
normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
9230
PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at
9231
240,000 bytes.
9232
 
9233
Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
9234
@option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
9235
and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
9236
the SOM linker.
9237
 
9238
It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade
9239
performance.  However, it may be useful in large applications,
9240
particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
9241
 
9242
The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
9243
assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated.  The
9244
impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
9245
symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
9246
However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
9247
and it is quite long.
9248
 
9249
@item -munix=@var{unix-std}
9250
@opindex march
9251
Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified
9252
UNIX standard.  The choices for @var{unix-std} are @samp{93}, @samp{95}
9253
and @samp{98}.  @samp{93} is supported on all HP-UX versions.  @samp{95}
9254
is available on HP-UX 10.10 and later.  @samp{98} is available on HP-UX
9255
11.11 and later.  The default values are @samp{93} for HP-UX 10.00,
9256
@samp{95} for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and @samp{98} for HP-UX 11.11
9257
and later.
9258
 
9259
@option{-munix=93} provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
9260
@option{-munix=95} provides additional predefines for @code{XOPEN_UNIX}
9261
and @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, and the startfile @file{unix95.o}.
9262
@option{-munix=98} provides additional predefines for @code{_XOPEN_UNIX},
9263
@code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, @code{_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE} and
9264
@code{_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500}, and the startfile @file{unix98.o}.
9265
 
9266
It is @emph{important} to note that this option changes the interfaces
9267
for various library routines.  It also affects the operational behavior
9268
of the C library.  Thus, @emph{extreme} care is needed in using this
9269
option.
9270
 
9271
Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
9272
standard must test, set and restore the variable @var{__xpg4_extended_mask}
9273
as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.
9274
 
9275
@item -nolibdld
9276
@opindex nolibdld
9277
Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the
9278
@option{-static} option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
9279
 
9280
@item -static
9281
@opindex static
9282
The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
9283
libdld.sl.  There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl.  Thus,
9284
when the @option{-static} option is specified, special link options
9285
are needed to resolve this dependency.
9286
 
9287
On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
9288
link with libdld.sl when the @option{-static} option is specified.
9289
This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On the 64-bit port,
9290
the linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The
9291
@option{-nolibdld} option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from
9292
adding these link options.
9293
 
9294
@item -threads
9295
@opindex threads
9296
Add support for multithreading with the @dfn{dce thread} library
9297
under HP-UX@.  This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
9298
linker.
9299
@end table
9300
 
9301
@node i386 and x86-64 Options
9302
@subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
9303
@cindex i386 Options
9304
@cindex x86-64 Options
9305
@cindex Intel 386 Options
9306
@cindex AMD x86-64 Options
9307
 
9308
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
9309
computers:
9310
 
9311
@table @gcctabopt
9312
@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
9313
@opindex mtune
9314
Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
9315
for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The choices for
9316
@var{cpu-type} are:
9317
@table @emph
9318
@item generic
9319
Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/AMD64/EM64T processors.
9320
If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
9321
the corresponding @option{-mtune} option instead of
9322
@option{-mtune=generic}.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users
9323
of your application will have, then you should use this option.
9324
 
9325
As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this
9326
option will change.  Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
9327
GCC, the code generated option will change to reflect the processors
9328
that were most common when that version of GCC was released.
9329
 
9330
There is no @option{-march=generic} option because @option{-march}
9331
indicates the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no
9332
generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In contrast,
9333
@option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
9334
processors) for which the code is optimized.
9335
@item native
9336
This selects the CPU to tune for at compilation time by determining
9337
the processor type of the compiling machine.  Using @option{-mtune=native}
9338
will produce code optimized for the local machine under the constraints
9339
of the selected instruction set.  Using @option{-march=native} will
9340
enable all instruction subsets supported by the local machine (hence
9341
the result might not run on different machines).
9342
@item i386
9343
Original Intel's i386 CPU@.
9344
@item i486
9345
Intel's i486 CPU@.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
9346
@item i586, pentium
9347
Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
9348
@item pentium-mmx
9349
Intel PentiumMMX CPU based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.
9350
@item pentiumpro
9351
Intel PentiumPro CPU@.
9352
@item i686
9353
Same as @code{generic}, but when used as @code{march} option, PentiumPro
9354
instruction set will be used, so the code will run on all i686 family chips.
9355
@item pentium2
9356
Intel Pentium2 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX instruction set support.
9357
@item pentium3, pentium3m
9358
Intel Pentium3 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX and SSE instruction set
9359
support.
9360
@item pentium-m
9361
Low power version of Intel Pentium3 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set
9362
support.  Used by Centrino notebooks.
9363
@item pentium4, pentium4m
9364
Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.
9365
@item prescott
9366
Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
9367
set support.
9368
@item nocona
9369
Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE,
9370
SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
9371
@item k6
9372
AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
9373
@item k6-2, k6-3
9374
Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3dNOW! instruction set support.
9375
@item athlon, athlon-tbird
9376
AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3dNOW! and SSE prefetch instructions
9377
support.
9378
@item athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp
9379
Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3dNOW! and full SSE
9380
instruction set support.
9381
@item k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx
9382
AMD K8 core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets
9383
MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3dNOW! and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
9384
@item winchip-c6
9385
IDT Winchip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction
9386
set support.
9387
@item winchip2
9388
IDT Winchip2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX and 3dNOW!
9389
instruction set support.
9390
@item c3
9391
Via C3 CPU with MMX and 3dNOW! instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
9392
implemented for this chip.)
9393
@item c3-2
9394
Via C3-2 CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
9395
implemented for this chip.)
9396
@end table
9397
 
9398
While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} will schedule things appropriately
9399
for that particular chip, the compiler will not generate any code that
9400
does not run on the i386 without the @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} option
9401
being used.
9402
 
9403
@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
9404
@opindex march
9405
Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}.  The choices
9406
for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-mtune}.  Moreover,
9407
specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}.
9408
 
9409
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
9410
@opindex mcpu
9411
A deprecated synonym for @option{-mtune}.
9412
 
9413
@item -m386
9414
@itemx -m486
9415
@itemx -mpentium
9416
@itemx -mpentiumpro
9417
@opindex m386
9418
@opindex m486
9419
@opindex mpentium
9420
@opindex mpentiumpro
9421
These options are synonyms for @option{-mtune=i386}, @option{-mtune=i486},
9422
@option{-mtune=pentium}, and @option{-mtune=pentiumpro} respectively.
9423
These synonyms are deprecated.
9424
 
9425
@item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
9426
@opindex march
9427
Generate floating point arithmetics for selected unit @var{unit}.  The choices
9428
for @var{unit} are:
9429
 
9430
@table @samp
9431
@item 387
9432
Use the standard 387 floating point coprocessor present majority of chips and
9433
emulated otherwise.  Code compiled with this option will run almost everywhere.
9434
The temporary results are computed in 80bit precision instead of precision
9435
specified by the type resulting in slightly different results compared to most
9436
of other chips.  See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
9437
 
9438
This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
9439
 
9440
@item sse
9441
Use scalar floating point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
9442
This instruction set is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line
9443
by Athlon-4, Athlon-xp and Athlon-mp chips.  The earlier version of SSE
9444
instruction set supports only single precision arithmetics, thus the double and
9445
extended precision arithmetics is still done using 387.  Later version, present
9446
only in Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips supports double precision
9447
arithmetics too.
9448
 
9449
For the i386 compiler, you need to use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse}
9450
or @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
9451
effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
9452
 
9453
The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid
9454
the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
9455
code that expects temporaries to be 80bit.
9456
 
9457
This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.
9458
 
9459
@item sse,387
9460
Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once.  This effectively double the
9461
amount of available registers and on chips with separate execution units for
9462
387 and SSE the execution resources too.  Use this option with care, as it is
9463
still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not model separate
9464
functional units well resulting in instable performance.
9465
@end table
9466
 
9467
@item -masm=@var{dialect}
9468
@opindex masm=@var{dialect}
9469
Output asm instructions using selected @var{dialect}.  Supported
9470
choices are @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default one).  Darwin does
9471
not support @samp{intel}.
9472
 
9473
@item -mieee-fp
9474
@itemx -mno-ieee-fp
9475
@opindex mieee-fp
9476
@opindex mno-ieee-fp
9477
Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating point
9478
comparisons.  These handle correctly the case where the result of a
9479
comparison is unordered.
9480
 
9481
@item -msoft-float
9482
@opindex msoft-float
9483
Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
9484
@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
9485
Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
9486
this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your
9487
own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
9488
cross-compilation.
9489
 
9490
On machines where a function returns floating point results in the 80387
9491
register stack, some floating point opcodes may be emitted even if
9492
@option{-msoft-float} is used.
9493
 
9494
@item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
9495
@opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
9496
Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
9497
 
9498
The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
9499
@code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
9500
is no FPU@.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate
9501
an FPU@.
9502
 
9503
The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
9504
in ordinary CPU registers instead.
9505
 
9506
@item -mno-fancy-math-387
9507
@opindex mno-fancy-math-387
9508
Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
9509
@code{sqrt} instructions for the 387.  Specify this option to avoid
9510
generating those instructions.  This option is the default on FreeBSD,
9511
OpenBSD and NetBSD@.  This option is overridden when @option{-march}
9512
indicates that the target cpu will always have an FPU and so the
9513
instruction will not need emulation.  As of revision 2.6.1, these
9514
instructions are not generated unless you also use the
9515
@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
9516
 
9517
@item -malign-double
9518
@itemx -mno-align-double
9519
@opindex malign-double
9520
@opindex mno-align-double
9521
Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
9522
@code{long long} variables on a two word boundary or a one word
9523
boundary.  Aligning @code{double} variables on a two word boundary will
9524
produce code that runs somewhat faster on a @samp{Pentium} at the
9525
expense of more memory.
9526
 
9527
On x86-64, @option{-malign-double} is enabled by default.
9528
 
9529
@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
9530
structures containing the above types will be aligned differently than
9531
the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
9532
and will not be binary compatible with structures in code compiled
9533
without that switch.
9534
 
9535
@item -m96bit-long-double
9536
@itemx -m128bit-long-double
9537
@opindex m96bit-long-double
9538
@opindex m128bit-long-double
9539
These switches control the size of @code{long double} type.  The i386
9540
application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits,
9541
so @option{-m96bit-long-double} is the default in 32 bit mode.
9542
 
9543
Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) would prefer @code{long double}
9544
to be aligned to an 8 or 16 byte boundary.  In arrays or structures
9545
conforming to the ABI, this would not be possible.  So specifying a
9546
@option{-m128bit-long-double} will align @code{long double}
9547
to a 16 byte boundary by padding the @code{long double} with an additional
9548
32 bit zero.
9549
 
9550
In the x86-64 compiler, @option{-m128bit-long-double} is the default choice as
9551
its ABI specifies that @code{long double} is to be aligned on 16 byte boundary.
9552
 
9553
Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87
9554
standard of 80 bits for a @code{long double}.
9555
 
9556
@strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, the
9557
structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables will change
9558
their size as well as function calling convention for function taking
9559
@code{long double} will be modified.  Hence they will not be binary
9560
compatible with arrays or structures in code compiled without that switch.
9561
 
9562
@item -mmlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
9563
@opindex mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
9564
When @option{-mcmodel=medium} is specified, the data greater than
9565
@var{threshold} are placed in large data section.  This value must be the
9566
same across all object linked into the binary and defaults to 65535.
9567
 
9568
@item -msvr3-shlib
9569
@itemx -mno-svr3-shlib
9570
@opindex msvr3-shlib
9571
@opindex mno-svr3-shlib
9572
Control whether GCC places uninitialized local variables into the
9573
@code{bss} or @code{data} segments.  @option{-msvr3-shlib} places them
9574
into @code{bss}.  These options are meaningful only on System V Release 3.
9575
 
9576
@item -mrtd
9577
@opindex mrtd
9578
Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
9579
take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret} @var{num}
9580
instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This saves one
9581
instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
9582
there.
9583
 
9584
You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
9585
sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}.  You can also
9586
override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
9587
@samp{cdecl}.  @xref{Function Attributes}.
9588
 
9589
@strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
9590
normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
9591
libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
9592
 
9593
Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
9594
take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
9595
otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
9596
functions.
9597
 
9598
In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
9599
function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
9600
harmlessly ignored.)
9601
 
9602
@item -mregparm=@var{num}
9603
@opindex mregparm
9604
Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By
9605
default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
9606
registers can be used.  You can control this behavior for a specific
9607
function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
9608
@xref{Function Attributes}.
9609
 
9610
@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
9611
@var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
9612
value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and
9613
startup modules.
9614
 
9615
@item -msseregparm
9616
@opindex msseregparm
9617
Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
9618
and return values.  You can control this behavior for a specific
9619
function by using the function attribute @samp{sseregparm}.
9620
@xref{Function Attributes}.
9621
 
9622
@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch then you must build all
9623
modules with the same value, including any libraries.  This includes
9624
the system libraries and startup modules.
9625
 
9626
@item -mstackrealign
9627
@opindex mstackrealign
9628
Realign the stack at entry.  On the Intel x86, the
9629
@option{-mstackrealign} option will generate an alternate prologue and
9630
epilogue that realigns the runtime stack.  This supports mixing legacy
9631
codes that keep a 4-byte aligned stack with modern codes that keep a
9632
16-byte stack for SSE compatibility.  The alternate prologue and
9633
epilogue are slower and bigger than the regular ones, and the
9634
alternate prologue requires an extra scratch register; this lowers the
9635
number of registers available if used in conjunction with the
9636
@code{regparm} attribute.  The @option{-mstackrealign} option is
9637
incompatible with the nested function prologue; this is considered a
9638
hard error.  See also the attribute @code{force_align_arg_pointer},
9639
applicable to individual functions.
9640
 
9641
@item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
9642
@opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
9643
Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
9644
byte boundary.  If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
9645
the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
9646
 
9647
On Pentium and PentiumPro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
9648
should be aligned to an 8 byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
9649
suffer significant run time performance penalties.  On Pentium III, the
9650
Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} may not work
9651
properly if it is not 16 byte aligned.
9652
 
9653
To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
9654
must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
9655
Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
9656
aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
9657
stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
9658
boundary will most likely misalign the stack.  It is recommended that
9659
libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
9660
 
9661
This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
9662
increases code size.  Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
9663
as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
9664
preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
9665
 
9666
@item -mmmx
9667
@itemx -mno-mmx
9668
@item -msse
9669
@itemx -mno-sse
9670
@item -msse2
9671
@itemx -mno-sse2
9672
@item -msse3
9673
@itemx -mno-sse3
9674
@item -m3dnow
9675
@itemx -mno-3dnow
9676
@opindex mmmx
9677
@opindex mno-mmx
9678
@opindex msse
9679
@opindex mno-sse
9680
@opindex m3dnow
9681
@opindex mno-3dnow
9682
These switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX,
9683
SSE, SSE2 or 3DNow! extended instruction sets.  These extensions are
9684
also available as built-in functions: see @ref{X86 Built-in Functions},
9685
for details of the functions enabled and disabled by these switches.
9686
 
9687
To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point
9688
code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
9689
 
9690
These options will enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
9691
generated code, even without @option{-mfpmath=sse}.  Applications which
9692
perform runtime CPU detection must compile separate files for each
9693
supported architecture, using the appropriate flags.  In particular,
9694
the file containing the CPU detection code should be compiled without
9695
these options.
9696
 
9697
@item -mpush-args
9698
@itemx -mno-push-args
9699
@opindex mpush-args
9700
@opindex mno-push-args
9701
Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter
9702
and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
9703
by default.  In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
9704
improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
9705
 
9706
@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
9707
@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
9708
If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments will be
9709
computed in the function prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs
9710
because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
9711
when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is a notable
9712
increase in code size.  This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
9713
 
9714
@item -mthreads
9715
@opindex mthreads
9716
Support thread-safe exception handling on @samp{Mingw32}.  Code that relies
9717
on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
9718
@option{-mthreads} option.  When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
9719
@option{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
9720
@option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per thread exception handling data.
9721
 
9722
@item -mno-align-stringops
9723
@opindex mno-align-stringops
9724
Do not align destination of inlined string operations.  This switch reduces
9725
code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
9726
but GCC doesn't know about it.
9727
 
9728
@item -minline-all-stringops
9729
@opindex minline-all-stringops
9730
By default GCC inlines string operations only when destination is known to be
9731
aligned at least to 4 byte boundary.  This enables more inlining, increase code
9732
size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast memcpy, strlen
9733
and memset for short lengths.
9734
 
9735
@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
9736
@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
9737
Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
9738
avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
9739
makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
9740
@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions
9741
which might make debugging harder.
9742
 
9743
@item -mtls-direct-seg-refs
9744
@itemx -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
9745
@opindex mtls-direct-seg-refs
9746
Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from the
9747
TLS segment register (@code{%gs} for 32-bit, @code{%fs} for 64-bit),
9748
or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or not this
9749
is legal depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
9750
segment to cover the entire TLS area.
9751
 
9752
For systems that use GNU libc, the default is on.
9753
@end table
9754
 
9755
These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
9756
on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
9757
 
9758
@table @gcctabopt
9759
@item -m32
9760
@itemx -m64
9761
@opindex m32
9762
@opindex m64
9763
Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
9764
The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
9765
generates code that runs on any i386 system.
9766
The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
9767
to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture. For
9768
darwin only the -m64 option turns off the @option{-fno-pic} and
9769
@option{-mdynamic-no-pic} options.
9770
 
9771
@item -mno-red-zone
9772
@opindex no-red-zone
9773
Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated
9774
by the x86-64 ABI, it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
9775
stack pointer that will not be modified by signal or interrupt handlers
9776
and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
9777
pointer.  The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
9778
 
9779
@item -mcmodel=small
9780
@opindex mcmodel=small
9781
Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
9782
be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.
9783
Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This is the default
9784
code model.
9785
 
9786
@item -mcmodel=kernel
9787
@opindex mcmodel=kernel
9788
Generate code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the
9789
negative 2 GB of the address space.
9790
This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
9791
 
9792
@item -mcmodel=medium
9793
@opindex mcmodel=medium
9794
Generate code for the medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2
9795
GB of the address space but symbols can be located anywhere in the
9796
address space.  Programs can be statically or dynamically linked, but
9797
building of shared libraries are not supported with the medium model.
9798
 
9799
@item -mcmodel=large
9800
@opindex mcmodel=large
9801
Generate code for the large model: This model makes no assumptions
9802
about addresses and sizes of sections.  Currently GCC does not implement
9803
this model.
9804
@end table
9805
 
9806
@node IA-64 Options
9807
@subsection IA-64 Options
9808
@cindex IA-64 Options
9809
 
9810
These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
9811
 
9812
@table @gcctabopt
9813
@item -mbig-endian
9814
@opindex mbig-endian
9815
Generate code for a big endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX@.
9816
 
9817
@item -mlittle-endian
9818
@opindex mlittle-endian
9819
Generate code for a little endian target.  This is the default for AIX5
9820
and GNU/Linux.
9821
 
9822
@item -mgnu-as
9823
@itemx -mno-gnu-as
9824
@opindex mgnu-as
9825
@opindex mno-gnu-as
9826
Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.
9827
@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
9828
@c is used.
9829
 
9830
@item -mgnu-ld
9831
@itemx -mno-gnu-ld
9832
@opindex mgnu-ld
9833
@opindex mno-gnu-ld
9834
Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.
9835
@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
9836
@c is used.
9837
 
9838
@item -mno-pic
9839
@opindex mno-pic
9840
Generate code that does not use a global pointer register.  The result
9841
is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
9842
 
9843
@item -mvolatile-asm-stop
9844
@itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
9845
@opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
9846
@opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
9847
Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
9848
statements.
9849
 
9850
@item -mregister-names
9851
@itemx -mno-register-names
9852
@opindex mregister-names
9853
@opindex mno-register-names
9854
Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
9855
the stacked registers.  This may make assembler output more readable.
9856
 
9857
@item -mno-sdata
9858
@itemx -msdata
9859
@opindex mno-sdata
9860
@opindex msdata
9861
Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.  This may
9862
be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
9863
 
9864
@item -mconstant-gp
9865
@opindex mconstant-gp
9866
Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is
9867
useful when compiling kernel code.
9868
 
9869
@item -mauto-pic
9870
@opindex mauto-pic
9871
Generate code that is self-relocatable.  This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
9872
This is useful when compiling firmware code.
9873
 
9874
@item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
9875
@opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
9876
Generate code for inline divides of floating point values
9877
using the minimum latency algorithm.
9878
 
9879
@item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
9880
@opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
9881
Generate code for inline divides of floating point values
9882
using the maximum throughput algorithm.
9883
 
9884
@item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
9885
@opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
9886
Generate code for inline divides of integer values
9887
using the minimum latency algorithm.
9888
 
9889
@item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
9890
@opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
9891
Generate code for inline divides of integer values
9892
using the maximum throughput algorithm.
9893
 
9894
@item -minline-sqrt-min-latency
9895
@opindex minline-sqrt-min-latency
9896
Generate code for inline square roots
9897
using the minimum latency algorithm.
9898
 
9899
@item -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
9900
@opindex minline-sqrt-max-throughput
9901
Generate code for inline square roots
9902
using the maximum throughput algorithm.
9903
 
9904
@item -mno-dwarf2-asm
9905
@itemx -mdwarf2-asm
9906
@opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
9907
@opindex mdwarf2-asm
9908
Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging
9909
info.  This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
9910
 
9911
@item -mearly-stop-bits
9912
@itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
9913
@opindex mearly-stop-bits
9914
@opindex mno-early-stop-bits
9915
Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
9916
instruction that triggered the stop bit.  This can improve instruction
9917
scheduling, but does not always do so.
9918
 
9919
@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
9920
@opindex mfixed-range
9921
Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
9922
A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
9923
useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
9924
two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
9925
specified separated by a comma.
9926
 
9927
@item -mtls-size=@var{tls-size}
9928
@opindex mtls-size
9929
Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and
9930
64.
9931
 
9932
@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
9933
@opindex mtune
9934
Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values are
9935
itanium, itanium1, merced, itanium2, and mckinley.
9936
 
9937
@item -mt
9938
@itemx -pthread
9939
@opindex mt
9940
@opindex pthread
9941
Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This
9942
option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  It does
9943
not affect the thread safety of object code produced by the compiler or
9944
that of libraries supplied with it.  These are HP-UX specific flags.
9945
 
9946
@item -milp32
9947
@itemx -mlp64
9948
@opindex milp32
9949
@opindex mlp64
9950
Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
9951
The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
9952
The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
9953
to 64 bits.  These are HP-UX specific flags.
9954
 
9955
@item -mno-sched-br-data-spec
9956
@itemx -msched-br-data-spec
9957
@opindex mno-sched-br-data-spec
9958
@opindex msched-br-data-spec
9959
(Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload.
9960
This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
9961
the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
9962
The default is 'disable'.
9963
 
9964
@item -msched-ar-data-spec
9965
@itemx -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
9966
@opindex msched-ar-data-spec
9967
@opindex mno-sched-ar-data-spec
9968
(En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.
9969
This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
9970
the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
9971
The default is 'enable'.
9972
 
9973
@item -mno-sched-control-spec
9974
@itemx -msched-control-spec
9975
@opindex mno-sched-control-spec
9976
@opindex msched-control-spec
9977
(Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is
9978
available only during region scheduling (i.e. before reload).
9979
This will result in generation of the ld.s instructions and
9980
the corresponding check instructions chk.s .
9981
The default is 'disable'.
9982
 
9983
@item -msched-br-in-data-spec
9984
@itemx -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
9985
@opindex msched-br-in-data-spec
9986
@opindex mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
9987
(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
9988
are dependent on the data speculative loads before reload.
9989
This is effective only with @option{-msched-br-data-spec} enabled.
9990
The default is 'enable'.
9991
 
9992
@item -msched-ar-in-data-spec
9993
@itemx -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
9994
@opindex msched-ar-in-data-spec
9995
@opindex mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
9996
(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
9997
are dependent on the data speculative loads after reload.
9998
This is effective only with @option{-msched-ar-data-spec} enabled.
9999
The default is 'enable'.
10000
 
10001
@item -msched-in-control-spec
10002
@itemx -mno-sched-in-control-spec
10003
@opindex msched-in-control-spec
10004
@opindex mno-sched-in-control-spec
10005
(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
10006
are dependent on the control speculative loads.
10007
This is effective only with @option{-msched-control-spec} enabled.
10008
The default is 'enable'.
10009
 
10010
@item -msched-ldc
10011
@itemx -mno-sched-ldc
10012
@opindex msched-ldc
10013
@opindex mno-sched-ldc
10014
(En/Dis)able use of simple data speculation checks ld.c .
10015
If disabled, only chk.a instructions will be emitted to check
10016
data speculative loads.
10017
The default is 'enable'.
10018
 
10019
@item -mno-sched-control-ldc
10020
@itemx -msched-control-ldc
10021
@opindex mno-sched-control-ldc
10022
@opindex msched-control-ldc
10023
(Dis/En)able use of ld.c instructions to check control speculative loads.
10024
If enabled, in case of control speculative load with no speculatively
10025
scheduled dependent instructions this load will be emitted as ld.sa and
10026
ld.c will be used to check it.
10027
The default is 'disable'.
10028
 
10029
@item -mno-sched-spec-verbose
10030
@itemx -msched-spec-verbose
10031
@opindex mno-sched-spec-verbose
10032
@opindex msched-spec-verbose
10033
(Dis/En)able printing of the information about speculative motions.
10034
 
10035
@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
10036
@itemx -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
10037
@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
10038
@opindex msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
10039
If enabled, data speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
10040
only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
10041
the use of the data speculation much more conservative.
10042
The default is 'disable'.
10043
 
10044
@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
10045
@itemx -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
10046
@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
10047
@opindex msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
10048
If enabled, control speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
10049
only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
10050
the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
10051
The default is 'disable'.
10052
 
10053
@item -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
10054
@itemx -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
10055
@opindex mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
10056
@opindex msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
10057
If enabled, speculative dependencies will be considered during
10058
computation of the instructions priorities.  This will make the use of the
10059
speculation a bit more conservative.
10060
The default is 'disable'.
10061
 
10062
@end table
10063
 
10064
@node M32C Options
10065
@subsection M32C Options
10066
@cindex M32C options
10067
 
10068
@table @gcctabopt
10069
@item -mcpu=@var{name}
10070
@opindex mcpu=
10071
Select the CPU for which code is generated.  @var{name} may be one of
10072
@samp{r8c} for the R8C/Tiny series, @samp{m16c} for the M16C (up to
10073
/60) series, @samp{m32cm} for the M16C/80 series, or @samp{m32c} for
10074
the M32C/80 series.
10075
 
10076
@item -msim
10077
@opindex msim
10078
Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
10079
an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports, for
10080
example, file I/O.  You must not use this option when generating
10081
programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own
10082
runtime library for whatever I/O functions are needed.
10083
 
10084
@item -memregs=@var{number}
10085
@opindex memregs=
10086
Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC will use
10087
during code generation.  These pseudo-registers will be used like real
10088
registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
10089
code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
10090
memory instead of registers.  Note that all modules in a program must
10091
be compiled with the same value for this option.  Because of that, you
10092
must not use this option with the default runtime libraries gcc
10093
builds.
10094
 
10095
@end table
10096
 
10097
@node M32R/D Options
10098
@subsection M32R/D Options
10099
@cindex M32R/D options
10100
 
10101
These @option{-m} options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
10102
 
10103
@table @gcctabopt
10104
@item -m32r2
10105
@opindex m32r2
10106
Generate code for the M32R/2@.
10107
 
10108
@item -m32rx
10109
@opindex m32rx
10110
Generate code for the M32R/X@.
10111
 
10112
@item -m32r
10113
@opindex m32r
10114
Generate code for the M32R@.  This is the default.
10115
 
10116
@item -mmodel=small
10117
@opindex mmodel=small
10118
Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
10119
can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
10120
are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
10121
This is the default.
10122
 
10123
The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
10124
@code{model} attribute.
10125
 
10126
@item -mmodel=medium
10127
@opindex mmodel=medium
10128
Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
10129
will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
10130
assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
10131
 
10132
@item -mmodel=large
10133
@opindex mmodel=large
10134
Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
10135
will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
10136
assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
10137
(the compiler will generate the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
10138
instruction sequence).
10139
 
10140
@item -msdata=none
10141
@opindex msdata=none
10142
Disable use of the small data area.  Variables will be put into
10143
one of @samp{.data}, @samp{bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
10144
@code{section} attribute has been specified).
10145
This is the default.
10146
 
10147
The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
10148
Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
10149
@code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
10150
 
10151
@item -msdata=sdata
10152
@opindex msdata=sdata
10153
Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
10154
generate special code to reference them.
10155
 
10156
@item -msdata=use
10157
@opindex msdata=use
10158
Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
10159
special instructions to reference them.
10160
 
10161
@item -G @var{num}
10162
@opindex G
10163
@cindex smaller data references
10164
Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
10165
into the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
10166
sections.  The default value of @var{num} is 8.
10167
The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
10168
for this option to have any effect.
10169
 
10170
All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
10171
Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
10172
doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
10173
generated.
10174
 
10175
@item -mdebug
10176
@opindex mdebug
10177
Makes the M32R specific code in the compiler display some statistics
10178
that might help in debugging programs.
10179
 
10180
@item -malign-loops
10181
@opindex malign-loops
10182
Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
10183
 
10184
@item -mno-align-loops
10185
@opindex mno-align-loops
10186
Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.
10187
 
10188
@item -missue-rate=@var{number}
10189
@opindex missue-rate=@var{number}
10190
Issue @var{number} instructions per cycle.  @var{number} can only be 1
10191
or 2.
10192
 
10193
@item -mbranch-cost=@var{number}
10194
@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{number}
10195
@var{number} can only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches will be
10196
preferred over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite will
10197
apply.
10198
 
10199
@item -mflush-trap=@var{number}
10200
@opindex mflush-trap=@var{number}
10201
Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is
10202
12.  Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
10203
 
10204
@item -mno-flush-trap
10205
@opindex mno-flush-trap
10206
Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
10207
 
10208
@item -mflush-func=@var{name}
10209
@opindex mflush-func=@var{name}
10210
Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to flush
10211
the cache.  The default is @emph{_flush_cache}, but a function call
10212
will only be used if a trap is not available.
10213
 
10214
@item -mno-flush-func
10215
@opindex mno-flush-func
10216
Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
10217
 
10218
@end table
10219
 
10220
@node M680x0 Options
10221
@subsection M680x0 Options
10222
@cindex M680x0 options
10223
 
10224
These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the 68000 series.  The default
10225
values for these options depends on which style of 68000 was selected when
10226
the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices are
10227
given below.
10228
 
10229
@table @gcctabopt
10230
@item -m68000
10231
@itemx -mc68000
10232
@opindex m68000
10233
@opindex mc68000
10234
Generate output for a 68000.  This is the default
10235
when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
10236
 
10237
Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
10238
including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
10239
 
10240
@item -m68020
10241
@itemx -mc68020
10242
@opindex m68020
10243
@opindex mc68020
10244
Generate output for a 68020.  This is the default
10245
when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
10246
 
10247
@item -m68881
10248
@opindex m68881
10249
Generate output containing 68881 instructions for floating point.
10250
This is the default for most 68020 systems unless @option{--nfp} was
10251
specified when the compiler was configured.
10252
 
10253
@item -m68030
10254
@opindex m68030
10255
Generate output for a 68030.  This is the default when the compiler is
10256
configured for 68030-based systems.
10257
 
10258
@item -m68040
10259
@opindex m68040
10260
Generate output for a 68040.  This is the default when the compiler is
10261
configured for 68040-based systems.
10262
 
10263
This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
10264
emulated by software on the 68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not
10265
have code to emulate those instructions.
10266
 
10267
@item -m68060
10268
@opindex m68060
10269
Generate output for a 68060.  This is the default when the compiler is
10270
configured for 68060-based systems.
10271
 
10272
This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
10273
have to be emulated by software on the 68060.  Use this option if your 68060
10274
does not have code to emulate those instructions.
10275
 
10276
@item -mcpu32
10277
@opindex mcpu32
10278
Generate output for a CPU32.  This is the default
10279
when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
10280
 
10281
Use this option for microcontrollers with a
10282
CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
10283
68336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
10284
 
10285
@item -m5200
10286
@opindex m5200
10287
Generate output for a 520X ``coldfire'' family cpu.  This is the default
10288
when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
10289
 
10290
Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
10291
the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5202.
10292
 
10293
@item -mcfv4e
10294
@opindex mcfv4e
10295
Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family cpu (e.g.@: 547x/548x).
10296
This includes use of hardware floating point instructions.
10297
 
10298
@item -m68020-40
10299
@opindex m68020-40
10300
Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
10301
This results in code which can run relatively efficiently on either a
10302
68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
10303
68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
10304
 
10305
@item -m68020-60
10306
@opindex m68020-60
10307
Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
10308
This results in code which can run relatively efficiently on either a
10309
68020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
10310
68881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
10311
 
10312
@item -msoft-float
10313
@opindex msoft-float
10314
Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
10315
@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all m68k
10316
targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
10317
used, but this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must
10318
make your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
10319
cross-compilation.  The embedded targets @samp{m68k-*-aout} and
10320
@samp{m68k-*-coff} do provide software floating point support.
10321
 
10322
@item -mshort
10323
@opindex mshort
10324
Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
10325
Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
10326
16-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.
10327
 
10328
@item -mnobitfield
10329
@opindex mnobitfield
10330
Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
10331
and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
10332
 
10333
@item -mbitfield
10334
@opindex mbitfield
10335
Do use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68020} option implies
10336
@option{-mbitfield}.  This is the default if you use a configuration
10337
designed for a 68020.
10338
 
10339
@item -mrtd
10340
@opindex mrtd
10341
Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
10342
that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
10343
instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This
10344
saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
10345
the arguments there.
10346
 
10347
This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
10348
used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
10349
compiled with the Unix compiler.
10350
 
10351
Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
10352
take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
10353
otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
10354
functions.
10355
 
10356
In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
10357
function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
10358
harmlessly ignored.)
10359
 
10360
The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
10361
68040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
10362
 
10363
@item -malign-int
10364
@itemx -mno-align-int
10365
@opindex malign-int
10366
@opindex mno-align-int
10367
Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
10368
@code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
10369
boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
10370
Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
10371
faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
10372
 
10373
@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC will
10374
align structures containing the above types  differently than
10375
most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
10376
 
10377
@item -mpcrel
10378
@opindex mpcrel
10379
Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
10380
using a global offset table.  At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
10381
allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.  @option{-fPIC} is
10382
not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
10383
68020 and higher processors.
10384
 
10385
@item -mno-strict-align
10386
@itemx -mstrict-align
10387
@opindex mno-strict-align
10388
@opindex mstrict-align
10389
Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by
10390
the system.
10391
 
10392
@item -msep-data
10393
Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
10394
area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
10395
an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
10396
@option{-fPIC}.
10397
 
10398
@item -mno-sep-data
10399
Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
10400
This is the default.
10401
 
10402
@item -mid-shared-library
10403
Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
10404
This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
10405
without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
10406
 
10407
@item -mno-id-shared-library
10408
Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
10409
This is the default.
10410
 
10411
@item -mshared-library-id=n
10412
Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
10413
compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
10414
other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
10415
library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
10416
 
10417
@end table
10418
 
10419
@node M68hc1x Options
10420
@subsection M68hc1x Options
10421
@cindex M68hc1x options
10422
 
10423
These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the 68hc11 and 68hc12
10424
microcontrollers.  The default values for these options depends on
10425
which style of microcontroller was selected when the compiler was configured;
10426
the defaults for the most common choices are given below.
10427
 
10428
@table @gcctabopt
10429
@item -m6811
10430
@itemx -m68hc11
10431
@opindex m6811
10432
@opindex m68hc11
10433
Generate output for a 68HC11.  This is the default
10434
when the compiler is configured for 68HC11-based systems.
10435
 
10436
@item -m6812
10437
@itemx -m68hc12
10438
@opindex m6812
10439
@opindex m68hc12
10440
Generate output for a 68HC12.  This is the default
10441
when the compiler is configured for 68HC12-based systems.
10442
 
10443
@item -m68S12
10444
@itemx -m68hcs12
10445
@opindex m68S12
10446
@opindex m68hcs12
10447
Generate output for a 68HCS12.
10448
 
10449
@item -mauto-incdec
10450
@opindex mauto-incdec
10451
Enable the use of 68HC12 pre and post auto-increment and auto-decrement
10452
addressing modes.
10453
 
10454
@item -minmax
10455
@itemx -nominmax
10456
@opindex minmax
10457
@opindex mnominmax
10458
Enable the use of 68HC12 min and max instructions.
10459
 
10460
@item -mlong-calls
10461
@itemx -mno-long-calls
10462
@opindex mlong-calls
10463
@opindex mno-long-calls
10464
Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be
10465
far away, the compiler will use the @code{call} instruction to
10466
call a function and the @code{rtc} instruction for returning.
10467
 
10468
@item -mshort
10469
@opindex mshort
10470
Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
10471
 
10472
@item -msoft-reg-count=@var{count}
10473
@opindex msoft-reg-count
10474
Specify the number of pseudo-soft registers which are used for the
10475
code generation.  The maximum number is 32.  Using more pseudo-soft
10476
register may or may not result in better code depending on the program.
10477
The default is 4 for 68HC11 and 2 for 68HC12.
10478
 
10479
@end table
10480
 
10481
@node MCore Options
10482
@subsection MCore Options
10483
@cindex MCore options
10484
 
10485
These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
10486
processors.
10487
 
10488
@table @gcctabopt
10489
 
10490
@item -mhardlit
10491
@itemx -mno-hardlit
10492
@opindex mhardlit
10493
@opindex mno-hardlit
10494
Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
10495
instructions or less.
10496
 
10497
@item -mdiv
10498
@itemx -mno-div
10499
@opindex mdiv
10500
@opindex mno-div
10501
Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).
10502
 
10503
@item -mrelax-immediate
10504
@itemx -mno-relax-immediate
10505
@opindex mrelax-immediate
10506
@opindex mno-relax-immediate
10507
Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.
10508
 
10509
@item -mwide-bitfields
10510
@itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
10511
@opindex mwide-bitfields
10512
@opindex mno-wide-bitfields
10513
Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.
10514
 
10515
@item -m4byte-functions
10516
@itemx -mno-4byte-functions
10517
@opindex m4byte-functions
10518
@opindex mno-4byte-functions
10519
Force all functions to be aligned to a four byte boundary.
10520
 
10521
@item -mcallgraph-data
10522
@itemx -mno-callgraph-data
10523
@opindex mcallgraph-data
10524
@opindex mno-callgraph-data
10525
Emit callgraph information.
10526
 
10527
@item -mslow-bytes
10528
@itemx -mno-slow-bytes
10529
@opindex mslow-bytes
10530
@opindex mno-slow-bytes
10531
Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
10532
 
10533
@item -mlittle-endian
10534
@itemx -mbig-endian
10535
@opindex mlittle-endian
10536
@opindex mbig-endian
10537
Generate code for a little endian target.
10538
 
10539
@item -m210
10540
@itemx -m340
10541
@opindex m210
10542
@opindex m340
10543
Generate code for the 210 processor.
10544
@end table
10545
 
10546
@node MIPS Options
10547
@subsection MIPS Options
10548
@cindex MIPS options
10549
 
10550
@table @gcctabopt
10551
 
10552
@item -EB
10553
@opindex EB
10554
Generate big-endian code.
10555
 
10556
@item -EL
10557
@opindex EL
10558
Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for @samp{mips*el-*-*}
10559
configurations.
10560
 
10561
@item -march=@var{arch}
10562
@opindex march
10563
Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
10564
generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
10565
The ISA names are:
10566
@samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
10567
@samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, and @samp{mips64}.
10568
The processor names are:
10569
@samp{4kc}, @samp{4km}, @samp{4kp},
10570
@samp{5kc}, @samp{5kf},
10571
@samp{20kc},
10572
@samp{24k}, @samp{24kc}, @samp{24kf}, @samp{24kx},
10573
@samp{m4k},
10574
@samp{orion},
10575
@samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
10576
@samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
10577
@samp{rm7000}, @samp{rm9000},
10578
@samp{sb1},
10579
@samp{sr71000},
10580
@samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4111}, @samp{vr4120}, @samp{vr4130}, @samp{vr4300},
10581
@samp{vr5000}, @samp{vr5400} and @samp{vr5500}.
10582
The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
10583
most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
10584
@samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
10585
 
10586
In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
10587
(for example, @samp{-march=r2k}).  Prefixes are optional, and
10588
@samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
10589
 
10590
GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option.  The first
10591
is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
10592
a string.  The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
10593
where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
10594
For example, @samp{-march=r2000} will set @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
10595
to @samp{"r2000"} and define the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
10596
 
10597
Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
10598
above.  In other words, it will have the full prefix and will not
10599
abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}.  In the case of @samp{from-abi},
10600
the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
10601
@samp{"mips3"}).  It names the default architecture when no
10602
@option{-march} option is given.
10603
 
10604
@item -mtune=@var{arch}
10605
@opindex mtune
10606
Optimize for @var{arch}.  Among other things, this option controls
10607
the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
10608
operations.  The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
10609
@option{-march}.
10610
 
10611
When this option is not used, GCC will optimize for the processor
10612
specified by @option{-march}.  By using @option{-march} and
10613
@option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that will
10614
run on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
10615
particular member of that family.
10616
 
10617
@samp{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
10618
@samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
10619
@samp{-march} ones described above.
10620
 
10621
@item -mips1
10622
@opindex mips1
10623
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips1}.
10624
 
10625
@item -mips2
10626
@opindex mips2
10627
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips2}.
10628
 
10629
@item -mips3
10630
@opindex mips3
10631
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips3}.
10632
 
10633
@item -mips4
10634
@opindex mips4
10635
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips4}.
10636
 
10637
@item -mips32
10638
@opindex mips32
10639
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32}.
10640
 
10641
@item -mips32r2
10642
@opindex mips32r2
10643
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32r2}.
10644
 
10645
@item -mips64
10646
@opindex mips64
10647
Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64}.
10648
 
10649
@item -mips16
10650
@itemx -mno-mips16
10651
@opindex mips16
10652
@opindex mno-mips16
10653
Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code.  If GCC is targetting a
10654
MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it will make use of the MIPS16e ASE@.
10655
 
10656
@item -mabi=32
10657
@itemx -mabi=o64
10658
@itemx -mabi=n32
10659
@itemx -mabi=64
10660
@itemx -mabi=eabi
10661
@opindex mabi=32
10662
@opindex mabi=o64
10663
@opindex mabi=n32
10664
@opindex mabi=64
10665
@opindex mabi=eabi
10666
Generate code for the given ABI@.
10667
 
10668
Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally
10669
generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
10670
can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
10671
 
10672
For information about the O64 ABI, see
10673
@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/projects/mipso64-abi.html}}.
10674
 
10675
@item -mabicalls
10676
@itemx -mno-abicalls
10677
@opindex mabicalls
10678
@opindex mno-abicalls
10679
Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
10680
dynamic objects.  @option{-mabicalls} is the default for SVR4-based
10681
systems.
10682
 
10683
@item -mshared
10684
@itemx -mno-shared
10685
Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
10686
and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries.  This option
10687
only affects @option{-mabicalls}.
10688
 
10689
All @option{-mabicalls} code has traditionally been position-independent,
10690
regardless of options like @option{-fPIC} and @option{-fpic}.  However,
10691
as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
10692
accesses for locally-binding symbols.  It can also use shorter GP
10693
initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-defined
10694
functions.  This mode is selected by @option{-mno-shared}.
10695
 
10696
@option{-mno-shared} depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
10697
objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker.  However, the option
10698
does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the ABI
10699
of relocatable objects.  Using @option{-mno-shared} will generally make
10700
executables both smaller and quicker.
10701
 
10702
@option{-mshared} is the default.
10703
 
10704
@item -mxgot
10705
@itemx -mno-xgot
10706
@opindex mxgot
10707
@opindex mno-xgot
10708
Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
10709
offset table.
10710
 
10711
GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
10712
While this is relatively efficient, it will only work if the GOT
10713
is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger will cause the linker
10714
to report an error such as:
10715
 
10716
@cindex relocation truncated to fit (MIPS)
10717
@smallexample
10718
relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
10719
@end smallexample
10720
 
10721
If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
10722
It should then work with very large GOTs, although it will also be
10723
less efficient, since it will take three instructions to fetch the
10724
value of a global symbol.
10725
 
10726
Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a
10727
linker, you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when a single object
10728
file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.
10729
 
10730
These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
10731
independent code.
10732
 
10733
@item -mgp32
10734
@opindex mgp32
10735
Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
10736
 
10737
@item -mgp64
10738
@opindex mgp64
10739
Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
10740
 
10741
@item -mfp32
10742
@opindex mfp32
10743
Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
10744
 
10745
@item -mfp64
10746
@opindex mfp64
10747
Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
10748
 
10749
@item -mhard-float
10750
@opindex mhard-float
10751
Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
10752
 
10753
@item -msoft-float
10754
@opindex msoft-float
10755
Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions.  Implement
10756
floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
10757
 
10758
@item -msingle-float
10759
@opindex msingle-float
10760
Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision
10761
operations.
10762
 
10763
@itemx -mdouble-float
10764
@opindex mdouble-float
10765
Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-precision
10766
operations.  This is the default.
10767
 
10768
@itemx -mdsp
10769
@itemx -mno-dsp
10770
@opindex mdsp
10771
@opindex mno-dsp
10772
Use (do not use) the MIPS DSP ASE.  @xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.
10773
 
10774
@itemx -mpaired-single
10775
@itemx -mno-paired-single
10776
@opindex mpaired-single
10777
@opindex mno-paired-single
10778
Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
10779
@xref{MIPS Paired-Single Support}.  This option can only be used
10780
when generating 64-bit code and requires hardware floating-point
10781
support to be enabled.
10782
 
10783
@itemx -mips3d
10784
@itemx -mno-mips3d
10785
@opindex mips3d
10786
@opindex mno-mips3d
10787
Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE@.  @xref{MIPS-3D Built-in Functions}.
10788
The option @option{-mips3d} implies @option{-mpaired-single}.
10789
 
10790
@item -mlong64
10791
@opindex mlong64
10792
Force @code{long} types to be 64 bits wide.  See @option{-mlong32} for
10793
an explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
10794
determined.
10795
 
10796
@item -mlong32
10797
@opindex mlong32
10798
Force @code{long}, @code{int}, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
10799
 
10800
The default size of @code{int}s, @code{long}s and pointers depends on
10801
the ABI@.  All the supported ABIs use 32-bit @code{int}s.  The n64 ABI
10802
uses 64-bit @code{long}s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use
10803
32-bit @code{long}s.  Pointers are the same size as @code{long}s,
10804
or the same size as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
10805
 
10806
@item -msym32
10807
@itemx -mno-sym32
10808
@opindex msym32
10809
@opindex mno-sym32
10810
Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless
10811
of the selected ABI@.  This option is useful in combination with
10812
@option{-mabi=64} and @option{-mno-abicalls} because it allows GCC
10813
to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
10814
 
10815
@item -G @var{num}
10816
@opindex G
10817
@cindex smaller data references (MIPS)
10818
@cindex gp-relative references (MIPS)
10819
Put global and static items less than or equal to @var{num} bytes into
10820
the small data or bss section instead of the normal data or bss section.
10821
This allows the data to be accessed using a single instruction.
10822
 
10823
All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}}
10824
value.
10825
 
10826
@item -membedded-data
10827
@itemx -mno-embedded-data
10828
@opindex membedded-data
10829
@opindex mno-embedded-data
10830
Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
10831
next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data.  This gives
10832
slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
10833
when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
10834
 
10835
@item -muninit-const-in-rodata
10836
@itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
10837
@opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
10838
@opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
10839
Put uninitialized @code{const} variables in the read-only data section.
10840
This option is only meaningful in conjunction with @option{-membedded-data}.
10841
 
10842
@item -msplit-addresses
10843
@itemx -mno-split-addresses
10844
@opindex msplit-addresses
10845
@opindex mno-split-addresses
10846
Enable (disable) use of the @code{%hi()} and @code{%lo()} assembler
10847
relocation operators.  This option has been superseded by
10848
@option{-mexplicit-relocs} but is retained for backwards compatibility.
10849
 
10850
@item -mexplicit-relocs
10851
@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
10852
@opindex mexplicit-relocs
10853
@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
10854
Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with symbolic
10855
addresses.  The alternative, selected by @option{-mno-explicit-relocs},
10856
is to use assembler macros instead.
10857
 
10858
@option{-mexplicit-relocs} is the default if GCC was configured
10859
to use an assembler that supports relocation operators.
10860
 
10861
@item -mcheck-zero-division
10862
@itemx -mno-check-zero-division
10863
@opindex mcheck-zero-division
10864
@opindex mno-check-zero-division
10865
Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.  The default is
10866
@option{-mcheck-zero-division}.
10867
 
10868
@item -mdivide-traps
10869
@itemx -mdivide-breaks
10870
@opindex mdivide-traps
10871
@opindex mdivide-breaks
10872
MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
10873
conditional trap or a break instruction.  Using traps results in
10874
smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also, some
10875
versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from
10876
generating the proper signal (@code{SIGFPE}).  Use @option{-mdivide-traps} to
10877
allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
10878
@option{-mdivide-breaks} to force the use of breaks.
10879
 
10880
The default is usually @option{-mdivide-traps}, but this can be
10881
overridden at configure time using @option{--with-divide=breaks}.
10882
Divide-by-zero checks can be completely disabled using
10883
@option{-mno-check-zero-division}.
10884
 
10885
@item -mmemcpy
10886
@itemx -mno-memcpy
10887
@opindex mmemcpy
10888
@opindex mno-memcpy
10889
Force (do not force) the use of @code{memcpy()} for non-trivial block
10890
moves.  The default is @option{-mno-memcpy}, which allows GCC to inline
10891
most constant-sized copies.
10892
 
10893
@item -mlong-calls
10894
@itemx -mno-long-calls
10895
@opindex mlong-calls
10896
@opindex mno-long-calls
10897
Disable (do not disable) use of the @code{jal} instruction.  Calling
10898
functions using @code{jal} is more efficient but requires the caller
10899
and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
10900
 
10901
This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is
10902
@option{-mno-long-calls}.
10903
 
10904
@item -mmad
10905
@itemx -mno-mad
10906
@opindex mmad
10907
@opindex mno-mad
10908
Enable (disable) use of the @code{mad}, @code{madu} and @code{mul}
10909
instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA@.
10910
 
10911
@item -mfused-madd
10912
@itemx -mno-fused-madd
10913
@opindex mfused-madd
10914
@opindex mno-fused-madd
10915
Enable (disable) use of the floating point multiply-accumulate
10916
instructions, when they are available.  The default is
10917
@option{-mfused-madd}.
10918
 
10919
When multiply-accumulate instructions are used, the intermediate
10920
product is calculated to infinite precision and is not subject to
10921
the FCSR Flush to Zero bit.  This may be undesirable in some
10922
circumstances.
10923
 
10924
@item -nocpp
10925
@opindex nocpp
10926
Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
10927
assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
10928
 
10929
@item -mfix-r4000
10930
@itemx -mno-fix-r4000
10931
@opindex mfix-r4000
10932
@opindex mno-fix-r4000
10933
Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
10934
@itemize @minus
10935
@item
10936
A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
10937
immediately after starting an integer division.
10938
@item
10939
A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
10940
while an integer multiplication is in progress.
10941
@item
10942
An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot
10943
of a taken branch or a jump.
10944
@end itemize
10945
 
10946
@item -mfix-r4400
10947
@itemx -mno-fix-r4400
10948
@opindex mfix-r4400
10949
@opindex mno-fix-r4400
10950
Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
10951
@itemize @minus
10952
@item
10953
A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
10954
immediately after starting an integer division.
10955
@end itemize
10956
 
10957
@item -mfix-vr4120
10958
@itemx -mno-fix-vr4120
10959
@opindex mfix-vr4120
10960
Work around certain VR4120 errata:
10961
@itemize @minus
10962
@item
10963
@code{dmultu} does not always produce the correct result.
10964
@item
10965
@code{div} and @code{ddiv} do not always produce the correct result if one
10966
of the operands is negative.
10967
@end itemize
10968
The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in
10969
@file{libgcc.a}.  At present, these functions are only provided by
10970
the @code{mips64vr*-elf} configurations.
10971
 
10972
Other VR4120 errata require a nop to be inserted between certain pairs of
10973
instructions.  These errata are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.
10974
 
10975
@item -mfix-vr4130
10976
@opindex mfix-vr4130
10977
Work around the VR4130 @code{mflo}/@code{mfhi} errata.  The
10978
workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC,
10979
although GCC will avoid using @code{mflo} and @code{mfhi} if the
10980
VR4130 @code{macc}, @code{macchi}, @code{dmacc} and @code{dmacchi}
10981
instructions are available instead.
10982
 
10983
@item -mfix-sb1
10984
@itemx -mno-fix-sb1
10985
@opindex mfix-sb1
10986
Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.
10987
(This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2
10988
``F1'' and ``F2'' floating point errata.)
10989
 
10990
@item -mflush-func=@var{func}
10991
@itemx -mno-flush-func
10992
@opindex mflush-func
10993
Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
10994
call any such function.  If called, the function must take the same
10995
arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
10996
memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
10997
memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches).  The default
10998
depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly is either
10999
@samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
11000
 
11001
@item -mbranch-likely
11002
@itemx -mno-branch-likely
11003
@opindex mbranch-likely
11004
@opindex mno-branch-likely
11005
Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
11006
default for the selected architecture.  By default, Branch Likely
11007
instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
11008
architecture.  An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
11009
and processors which implement those architectures; for those, Branch
11010
Likely instructions will not be generated by default because the MIPS32
11011
and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
11012
 
11013
@item -mfp-exceptions
11014
@itemx -mno-fp-exceptions
11015
@opindex mfp-exceptions
11016
Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how we schedule
11017
FP instructions for some processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are
11018
enabled.
11019
 
11020
For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting
11021
64-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one
11022
FP pipe.
11023
 
11024
@item -mvr4130-align
11025
@itemx -mno-vr4130-align
11026
@opindex mvr4130-align
11027
The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
11028
instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned.  When this
11029
option is enabled, GCC will align pairs of instructions that it
11030
thinks should execute in parallel.
11031
 
11032
This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.
11033
It normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
11034
It is enabled by default at optimization level @option{-O3}.
11035
@end table
11036
 
11037
@node MMIX Options
11038
@subsection MMIX Options
11039
@cindex MMIX Options
11040
 
11041
These options are defined for the MMIX:
11042
 
11043
@table @gcctabopt
11044
@item -mlibfuncs
11045
@itemx -mno-libfuncs
11046
@opindex mlibfuncs
11047
@opindex mno-libfuncs
11048
Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
11049
values in registers, no matter the size.
11050
 
11051
@item -mepsilon
11052
@itemx -mno-epsilon
11053
@opindex mepsilon
11054
@opindex mno-epsilon
11055
Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
11056
to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
11057
 
11058
@item -mabi=mmixware
11059
@itemx -mabi=gnu
11060
@opindex mabi-mmixware
11061
@opindex mabi=gnu
11062
Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
11063
the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
11064
the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
11065
 
11066
@item -mzero-extend
11067
@itemx -mno-zero-extend
11068
@opindex mzero-extend
11069
@opindex mno-zero-extend
11070
When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
11071
use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
11072
sign-extending ones.
11073
 
11074
@item -mknuthdiv
11075
@itemx -mno-knuthdiv
11076
@opindex mknuthdiv
11077
@opindex mno-knuthdiv
11078
Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
11079
the divisor.  With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
11080
remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
11081
arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
11082
 
11083
@item -mtoplevel-symbols
11084
@itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
11085
@opindex mtoplevel-symbols
11086
@opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
11087
Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
11088
code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
11089
 
11090
@item -melf
11091
@opindex melf
11092
Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
11093
@samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
11094
 
11095
@item -mbranch-predict
11096
@itemx -mno-branch-predict
11097
@opindex mbranch-predict
11098
@opindex mno-branch-predict
11099
Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
11100
prediction indicates a probable branch.
11101
 
11102
@item -mbase-addresses
11103
@itemx -mno-base-addresses
11104
@opindex mbase-addresses
11105
@opindex mno-base-addresses
11106
Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}.  Using a
11107
base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
11108
and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register.  The
11109
register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
11110
to 255 from the value held in the register.  The generally leads to short
11111
and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
11112
addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses lots of static
11113
data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
11114
 
11115
@item -msingle-exit
11116
@itemx -mno-single-exit
11117
@opindex msingle-exit
11118
@opindex mno-single-exit
11119
Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
11120
function.
11121
@end table
11122
 
11123
@node MN10300 Options
11124
@subsection MN10300 Options
11125
@cindex MN10300 options
11126
 
11127
These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
11128
 
11129
@table @gcctabopt
11130
@item -mmult-bug
11131
@opindex mmult-bug
11132
Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
11133
processors.  This is the default.
11134
 
11135
@item -mno-mult-bug
11136
@opindex mno-mult-bug
11137
Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
11138
MN10300 processors.
11139
 
11140
@item -mam33
11141
@opindex mam33
11142
Generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor.
11143
 
11144
@item -mno-am33
11145
@opindex mno-am33
11146
Do not generate code which uses features specific to the AM33 processor.  This
11147
is the default.
11148
 
11149
@item -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
11150
@opindex mreturn-pointer-on-d0
11151
When generating a function which returns a pointer, return the pointer
11152
in both @code{a0} and @code{d0}.  Otherwise, the pointer is returned
11153
only in a0, and attempts to call such functions without a prototype
11154
would result in errors.  Note that this option is on by default; use
11155
@option{-mno-return-pointer-on-d0} to disable it.
11156
 
11157
@item -mno-crt0
11158
@opindex mno-crt0
11159
Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
11160
 
11161
@item -mrelax
11162
@opindex mrelax
11163
Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
11164
to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses.  This option only
11165
has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
11166
 
11167
This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
11168
@end table
11169
 
11170
@node MT Options
11171
@subsection MT Options
11172
@cindex MT options
11173
 
11174
These @option{-m} options are defined for Morpho MT architectures:
11175
 
11176
@table @gcctabopt
11177
 
11178
@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
11179
@opindex march
11180
Generate code that will run on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
11181
representing a certain processor type.  Possible values for
11182
@var{cpu-type} are @samp{ms1-64-001}, @samp{ms1-16-002},
11183
@samp{ms1-16-003} and @samp{ms2}.
11184
 
11185
When this option is not used, the default is @option{-march=ms1-16-002}.
11186
 
11187
@item -mbacc
11188
@opindex mbacc
11189
Use byte loads and stores when generating code.
11190
 
11191
@item -mno-bacc
11192
@opindex mno-bacc
11193
Do not use byte loads and stores when generating code.
11194
 
11195
@item -msim
11196
@opindex msim
11197
Use simulator runtime
11198
 
11199
@item -mno-crt0
11200
@opindex mno-crt0
11201
Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file
11202
@file{crti.o}.  Other run-time initialization and termination files
11203
such as @file{startup.o} and @file{exit.o} are still included on the
11204
linker command line.
11205
 
11206
@end table
11207
 
11208
@node PDP-11 Options
11209
@subsection PDP-11 Options
11210
@cindex PDP-11 Options
11211
 
11212
These options are defined for the PDP-11:
11213
 
11214
@table @gcctabopt
11215
@item -mfpu
11216
@opindex mfpu
11217
Use hardware FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating
11218
point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
11219
 
11220
@item -msoft-float
11221
@opindex msoft-float
11222
Do not use hardware floating point.
11223
 
11224
@item -mac0
11225
@opindex mac0
11226
Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
11227
 
11228
@item -mno-ac0
11229
@opindex mno-ac0
11230
Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.
11231
 
11232
@item -m40
11233
@opindex m40
11234
Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
11235
 
11236
@item -m45
11237
@opindex m45
11238
Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.
11239
 
11240
@item -m10
11241
@opindex m10
11242
Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
11243
 
11244
@item -mbcopy-builtin
11245
@opindex bcopy-builtin
11246
Use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.  This is the
11247
default.
11248
 
11249
@item -mbcopy
11250
@opindex mbcopy
11251
Do not use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.
11252
 
11253
@item -mint16
11254
@itemx -mno-int32
11255
@opindex mint16
11256
@opindex mno-int32
11257
Use 16-bit @code{int}.  This is the default.
11258
 
11259
@item -mint32
11260
@itemx -mno-int16
11261
@opindex mint32
11262
@opindex mno-int16
11263
Use 32-bit @code{int}.
11264
 
11265
@item -mfloat64
11266
@itemx -mno-float32
11267
@opindex mfloat64
11268
@opindex mno-float32
11269
Use 64-bit @code{float}.  This is the default.
11270
 
11271
@item -mfloat32
11272
@itemx -mno-float64
11273
@opindex mfloat32
11274
@opindex mno-float64
11275
Use 32-bit @code{float}.
11276
 
11277
@item -mabshi
11278
@opindex mabshi
11279
Use @code{abshi2} pattern.  This is the default.
11280
 
11281
@item -mno-abshi
11282
@opindex mno-abshi
11283
Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
11284
 
11285
@item -mbranch-expensive
11286
@opindex mbranch-expensive
11287
Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with
11288
code generation only.
11289
 
11290
@item -mbranch-cheap
11291
@opindex mbranch-cheap
11292
Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.
11293
 
11294
@item -msplit
11295
@opindex msplit
11296
Generate code for a system with split I&D@.
11297
 
11298
@item -mno-split
11299
@opindex mno-split
11300
Generate code for a system without split I&D@.  This is the default.
11301
 
11302
@item -munix-asm
11303
@opindex munix-asm
11304
Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for
11305
@samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
11306
 
11307
@item -mdec-asm
11308
@opindex mdec-asm
11309
Use DEC assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for any
11310
PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
11311
@end table
11312
 
11313
@node PowerPC Options
11314
@subsection PowerPC Options
11315
@cindex PowerPC options
11316
 
11317
These are listed under @xref{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}.
11318
 
11319
@node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
11320
@subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
11321
@cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
11322
@cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
11323
 
11324
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
11325
@table @gcctabopt
11326
@item -mpower
11327
@itemx -mno-power
11328
@itemx -mpower2
11329
@itemx -mno-power2
11330
@itemx -mpowerpc
11331
@itemx -mno-powerpc
11332
@itemx -mpowerpc-gpopt
11333
@itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
11334
@itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
11335
@itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
11336
@itemx -mpowerpc64
11337
@itemx -mno-powerpc64
11338
@itemx -mmfcrf
11339
@itemx -mno-mfcrf
11340
@itemx -mpopcntb
11341
@itemx -mno-popcntb
11342
@itemx -mfprnd
11343
@itemx -mno-fprnd
11344
@opindex mpower
11345
@opindex mno-power
11346
@opindex mpower2
11347
@opindex mno-power2
11348
@opindex mpowerpc
11349
@opindex mno-powerpc
11350
@opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
11351
@opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
11352
@opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
11353
@opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
11354
@opindex mpowerpc64
11355
@opindex mno-powerpc64
11356
@opindex mmfcrf
11357
@opindex mno-mfcrf
11358
@opindex mpopcntb
11359
@opindex mno-popcntb
11360
@opindex mfprnd
11361
@opindex mno-fprnd
11362
GCC supports two related instruction set architectures for the
11363
RS/6000 and PowerPC@.  The @dfn{POWER} instruction set are those
11364
instructions supported by the @samp{rios} chip set used in the original
11365
RS/6000 systems and the @dfn{PowerPC} instruction set is the
11366
architecture of the Freescale MPC5xx, MPC6xx, MPC8xx microprocessors, and
11367
the IBM 4xx, 6xx, and follow-on microprocessors.
11368
 
11369
Neither architecture is a subset of the other.  However there is a
11370
large common subset of instructions supported by both.  An MQ
11371
register is included in processors supporting the POWER architecture.
11372
 
11373
You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
11374
processor you are using.  The default value of these options is
11375
determined when configuring GCC@.  Specifying the
11376
@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
11377
options.  We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
11378
rather than the options listed above.
11379
 
11380
The @option{-mpower} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
11381
are found only in the POWER architecture and to use the MQ register.
11382
Specifying @option{-mpower2} implies @option{-power} and also allows GCC
11383
to generate instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but
11384
not the original POWER architecture.
11385
 
11386
The @option{-mpowerpc} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
11387
are found only in the 32-bit subset of the PowerPC architecture.
11388
Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows
11389
GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
11390
General Purpose group, including floating-point square root.  Specifying
11391
@option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows GCC to
11392
use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
11393
group, including floating-point select.
11394
 
11395
The @option{-mmfcrf} option allows GCC to generate the move from
11396
condition register field instruction implemented on the POWER4
11397
processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01
11398
architecture.
11399
The @option{-mpopcntb} option allows GCC to generate the popcount and
11400
double precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
11401
POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.02
11402
architecture.
11403
The @option{-mfprnd} option allows GCC to generate the FP round to
11404
integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
11405
processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.
11406
 
11407
The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
11408
64-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
11409
and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
11410
@option{-mno-powerpc64}.
11411
 
11412
If you specify both @option{-mno-power} and @option{-mno-powerpc}, GCC
11413
will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
11414
architectures plus some special AIX common-mode calls, and will not use
11415
the MQ register.  Specifying both @option{-mpower} and @option{-mpowerpc}
11416
permits GCC to use any instruction from either architecture and to
11417
allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.
11418
 
11419
@item -mnew-mnemonics
11420
@itemx -mold-mnemonics
11421
@opindex mnew-mnemonics
11422
@opindex mold-mnemonics
11423
Select which mnemonics to use in the generated assembler code.  With
11424
@option{-mnew-mnemonics}, GCC uses the assembler mnemonics defined for
11425
the PowerPC architecture.  With @option{-mold-mnemonics} it uses the
11426
assembler mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture.  Instructions
11427
defined in only one architecture have only one mnemonic; GCC uses that
11428
mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.
11429
 
11430
GCC defaults to the mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in
11431
use.  Specifying @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} sometimes overrides the
11432
value of these option.  Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you
11433
should normally not specify either @option{-mnew-mnemonics} or
11434
@option{-mold-mnemonics}, but should instead accept the default.
11435
 
11436
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
11437
@opindex mcpu
11438
Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and
11439
instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
11440
Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{401}, @samp{403},
11441
@samp{405}, @samp{405fp}, @samp{440}, @samp{440fp}, @samp{505},
11442
@samp{601}, @samp{602}, @samp{603}, @samp{603e}, @samp{604},
11443
@samp{604e}, @samp{620}, @samp{630}, @samp{740}, @samp{7400},
11444
@samp{7450}, @samp{750}, @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823},
11445
@samp{860}, @samp{970}, @samp{8540}, @samp{ec603e}, @samp{G3},
11446
@samp{G4}, @samp{G5}, @samp{power}, @samp{power2}, @samp{power3},
11447
@samp{power4}, @samp{power5}, @samp{power5+}, @samp{power6},
11448
@samp{common}, @samp{powerpc}, @samp{powerpc64},
11449
@samp{rios}, @samp{rios1}, @samp{rios2}, @samp{rsc}, and @samp{rs64}.
11450
 
11451
@option{-mcpu=common} selects a completely generic processor.  Code
11452
generated under this option will run on any POWER or PowerPC processor.
11453
GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
11454
architectures, and will not use the MQ register.  GCC assumes a generic
11455
processor model for scheduling purposes.
11456
 
11457
@option{-mcpu=power}, @option{-mcpu=power2}, @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and
11458
@option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure 32-bit
11459
PowerPC (i.e., not MPC601), and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
11460
types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
11461
scheduling purposes.
11462
 
11463
The other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under
11464
those options will run best on that processor, and may not run at all on
11465
others.
11466
 
11467
The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable the
11468
following options: @option{-maltivec}, @option{-mfprnd},
11469
@option{-mhard-float}, @option{-mmfcrf}, @option{-mmultiple},
11470
@option{-mnew-mnemonics}, @option{-mpopcntb}, @option{-mpower},
11471
@option{-mpower2}, @option{-mpowerpc64}, @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt},
11472
@option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt}, @option{-mstring}, @option{-mmulhw}, @option{-mdlmzb}.
11473
The particular options
11474
set for any particular CPU will vary between compiler versions,
11475
depending on what setting seems to produce optimal code for that CPU;
11476
it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual hardware's capabilities.  If
11477
you wish to set an individual option to a particular value, you may
11478
specify it after the @option{-mcpu} option, like @samp{-mcpu=970
11479
-mno-altivec}.
11480
 
11481
On AIX, the @option{-maltivec} and @option{-mpowerpc64} options are
11482
not enabled or disabled by the @option{-mcpu} option at present because
11483
AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still
11484
enable or disable them individually if you're sure it'll work in your
11485
environment.
11486
 
11487
@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
11488
@opindex mtune
11489
Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
11490
@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type, register usage, or
11491
choice of mnemonics, as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.  The same
11492
values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
11493
@option{-mcpu}.  If both are specified, the code generated will use the
11494
architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
11495
scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
11496
 
11497
@item -mswdiv
11498
@itemx -mno-swdiv
11499
@opindex mswdiv
11500
@opindex mno-swdiv
11501
Generate code to compute division as reciprocal estimate and iterative
11502
refinement, creating opportunities for increased throughput.  This
11503
feature requires: optional PowerPC Graphics instruction set for single
11504
precision and FRE instruction for double precision, assuming divides
11505
cannot generate user-visible traps, and the domain values not include
11506
Infinities, denormals or zero denominator.
11507
 
11508
@item -maltivec
11509
@itemx -mno-altivec
11510
@opindex maltivec
11511
@opindex mno-altivec
11512
Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and also
11513
enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
11514
the AltiVec instruction set.  You may also need to set
11515
@option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
11516
enhancements.
11517
 
11518
@item -mvrsave
11519
@item -mno-vrsave
11520
@opindex mvrsave
11521
@opindex mno-vrsave
11522
Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
11523
 
11524
@item -msecure-plt
11525
@opindex msecure-plt
11526
Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared
11527
libraries with non-exec .plt and .got sections.  This is a PowerPC
11528
32-bit SYSV ABI option.
11529
 
11530
@item -mbss-plt
11531
@opindex mbss-plt
11532
Generate code that uses a BSS .plt section that ld.so fills in, and
11533
requires .plt and .got sections that are both writable and executable.
11534
This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
11535
 
11536
@item -misel
11537
@itemx -mno-isel
11538
@opindex misel
11539
@opindex mno-isel
11540
This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
11541
 
11542
@item -misel=@var{yes/no}
11543
This switch has been deprecated.  Use @option{-misel} and
11544
@option{-mno-isel} instead.
11545
 
11546
@item -mspe
11547
@itemx -mno-spe
11548
@opindex mspe
11549
@opindex mno-spe
11550
This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd
11551
instructions.
11552
 
11553
@item -mspe=@var{yes/no}
11554
This option has been deprecated.  Use @option{-mspe} and
11555
@option{-mno-spe} instead.
11556
 
11557
@item -mfloat-gprs=@var{yes/single/double/no}
11558
@itemx -mfloat-gprs
11559
@opindex mfloat-gprs
11560
This switch enables or disables the generation of floating point
11561
operations on the general purpose registers for architectures that
11562
support it.
11563
 
11564
The argument @var{yes} or @var{single} enables the use of
11565
single-precision floating point operations.
11566
 
11567
The argument @var{double} enables the use of single and
11568
double-precision floating point operations.
11569
 
11570
The argument @var{no} disables floating point operations on the
11571
general purpose registers.
11572
 
11573
This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.
11574
 
11575
@item -m32
11576
@itemx -m64
11577
@opindex m32
11578
@opindex m64
11579
Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
11580
targets (including GNU/Linux).  The 32-bit environment sets int, long
11581
and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any PowerPC
11582
variant.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and
11583
pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as for
11584
@option{-mpowerpc64}.
11585
 
11586
@item -mfull-toc
11587
@itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
11588
@itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
11589
@itemx -mminimal-toc
11590
@opindex mfull-toc
11591
@opindex mno-fp-in-toc
11592
@opindex mno-sum-in-toc
11593
@opindex mminimal-toc
11594
Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
11595
every executable file.  The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
11596
default.  In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
11597
each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program.  GCC
11598
will also place floating-point constants in the TOC@.  However, only
11599
16,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
11600
 
11601
If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
11602
the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
11603
with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
11604
@option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
11605
constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
11606
generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
11607
run-time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@.  You may specify one
11608
or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
11609
slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
11610
 
11611
If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
11612
these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead.  This option causes
11613
GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you specify this
11614
option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which
11615
uses extremely little TOC space.  You may wish to use this option
11616
only on files that contain less frequently executed code.
11617
 
11618
@item -maix64
11619
@itemx -maix32
11620
@opindex maix64
11621
@opindex maix32
11622
Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
11623
@code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
11624
Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64} and
11625
@option{-mpowerpc}, while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
11626
implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}.  GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
11627
 
11628
@item -mxl-compat
11629
@itemx -mno-xl-compat
11630
@opindex mxl-compat
11631
@opindex mno-xl-compat
11632
Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics
11633
when using AIX-compatible ABI.  Pass floating-point arguments to
11634
prototyped functions beyond the register save area (RSA) on the stack
11635
in addition to argument FPRs.  Do not assume that most significant
11636
double in 128-bit long double value is properly rounded when comparing
11637
values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names for long double
11638
support routines.
11639
 
11640
The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
11641
handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
11642
address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.  IBM XL
11643
compilers access floating point arguments which do not fit in the
11644
RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
11645
optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
11646
stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
11647
default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by IBM
11648
XL compilers without optimization.
11649
 
11650
@item -mpe
11651
@opindex mpe
11652
Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@.  Link an
11653
application written to use message passing with special startup code to
11654
enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
11655
standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
11656
must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
11657
appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not
11658
support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
11659
option are incompatible.
11660
 
11661
@item -malign-natural
11662
@itemx -malign-power
11663
@opindex malign-natural
11664
@opindex malign-power
11665
On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
11666
@option{-malign-natural} overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
11667
types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based boundary.
11668
The option @option{-malign-power} instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified
11669
alignment rules.  GCC defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI@.
11670
 
11671
On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and @option{-malign-power}
11672
is not supported.
11673
 
11674
@item -msoft-float
11675
@itemx -mhard-float
11676
@opindex msoft-float
11677
@opindex mhard-float
11678
Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
11679
Software floating point emulation is provided if you use the
11680
@option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
11681
 
11682
@item -mmultiple
11683
@itemx -mno-multiple
11684
@opindex mmultiple
11685
@opindex mno-multiple
11686
Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
11687
instructions and the store multiple word instructions.  These
11688
instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
11689
generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little
11690
endian PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
11691
processor is in little endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and
11692
PPC750 which permit the instructions usage in little endian mode.
11693
 
11694
@item -mstring
11695
@itemx -mno-string
11696
@opindex mstring
11697
@opindex mno-string
11698
Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
11699
and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
11700
do small block moves.  These instructions are generated by default on
11701
POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use
11702
@option{-mstring} on little endian PowerPC systems, since those
11703
instructions do not work when the processor is in little endian mode.
11704
The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit the instructions
11705
usage in little endian mode.
11706
 
11707
@item -mupdate
11708
@itemx -mno-update
11709
@opindex mupdate
11710
@opindex mno-update
11711
Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
11712
that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
11713
location.  These instructions are generated by default.  If you use
11714
@option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
11715
stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
11716
stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
11717
signals may get corrupted data.
11718
 
11719
@item -mfused-madd
11720
@itemx -mno-fused-madd
11721
@opindex mfused-madd
11722
@opindex mno-fused-madd
11723
Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating point multiply and
11724
accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default if
11725
hardware floating is used.
11726
 
11727
@item -mmulhw
11728
@itemx -mno-mulhw
11729
@opindex mmulhw
11730
@opindex mno-mulhw
11731
Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
11732
multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405 and 440 processors.
11733
These instructions are generated by default when targetting those
11734
processors.
11735
 
11736
@item -mdlmzb
11737
@itemx -mno-dlmzb
11738
@opindex mdlmzb
11739
@opindex mno-dlmzb
11740
Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search @samp{dlmzb}
11741
instruction on the IBM 405 and 440 processors.  This instruction is
11742
generated by default when targetting those processors.
11743
 
11744
@item -mno-bit-align
11745
@itemx -mbit-align
11746
@opindex mno-bit-align
11747
@opindex mbit-align
11748
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
11749
and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
11750
bit-field.
11751
 
11752
For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
11753
@code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 would be aligned to a 4 byte
11754
boundary and have a size of 4 bytes.  By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
11755
the structure would be aligned to a 1 byte boundary and be one byte in
11756
size.
11757
 
11758
@item -mno-strict-align
11759
@itemx -mstrict-align
11760
@opindex mno-strict-align
11761
@opindex mstrict-align
11762
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
11763
unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
11764
 
11765
@item -mrelocatable
11766
@itemx -mno-relocatable
11767
@opindex mrelocatable
11768
@opindex mno-relocatable
11769
On embedded PowerPC systems generate code that allows (does not allow)
11770
the program to be relocated to a different address at runtime.  If you
11771
use @option{-mrelocatable} on any module, all objects linked together must
11772
be compiled with @option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
11773
 
11774
@item -mrelocatable-lib
11775
@itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
11776
@opindex mrelocatable-lib
11777
@opindex mno-relocatable-lib
11778
On embedded PowerPC systems generate code that allows (does not allow)
11779
the program to be relocated to a different address at runtime.  Modules
11780
compiled with @option{-mrelocatable-lib} can be linked with either modules
11781
compiled without @option{-mrelocatable} and @option{-mrelocatable-lib} or
11782
with modules compiled with the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
11783
 
11784
@item -mno-toc
11785
@itemx -mtoc
11786
@opindex mno-toc
11787
@opindex mtoc
11788
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
11789
register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
11790
used in the program.
11791
 
11792
@item -mlittle
11793
@itemx -mlittle-endian
11794
@opindex mlittle
11795
@opindex mlittle-endian
11796
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
11797
processor in little endian mode.  The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
11798
the same as @option{-mlittle}.
11799
 
11800
@item -mbig
11801
@itemx -mbig-endian
11802
@opindex mbig
11803
@opindex mbig-endian
11804
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
11805
processor in big endian mode.  The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
11806
the same as @option{-mbig}.
11807
 
11808
@item -mdynamic-no-pic
11809
@opindex mdynamic-no-pic
11810
On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
11811
relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable.  The
11812
resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
11813
libraries.
11814
 
11815
@item -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority}
11816
@opindex mprioritize-restricted-insns
11817
This option controls the priority that is assigned to
11818
dispatch-slot restricted instructions during the second scheduling
11819
pass.  The argument @var{priority} takes the value @var{0/1/2} to assign
11820
@var{no/highest/second-highest} priority to dispatch slot restricted
11821
instructions.
11822
 
11823
@item -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type}
11824
@opindex msched-costly-dep
11825
This option controls which dependences are considered costly
11826
by the target during instruction scheduling.  The argument
11827
@var{dependence_type} takes one of the following values:
11828
@var{no}: no dependence is costly,
11829
@var{all}: all dependences are costly,
11830
@var{true_store_to_load}: a true dependence from store to load is costly,
11831
@var{store_to_load}: any dependence from store to load is costly,
11832
@var{number}: any dependence which latency >= @var{number} is costly.
11833
 
11834
@item -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme}
11835
@opindex minsert-sched-nops
11836
This option controls which nop insertion scheme will be used during
11837
the second scheduling pass.  The argument @var{scheme} takes one of the
11838
following values:
11839
@var{no}: Don't insert nops.
11840
@var{pad}: Pad with nops any dispatch group which has vacant issue slots,
11841
according to the scheduler's grouping.
11842
@var{regroup_exact}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
11843
separate groups.  Insert exactly as many nops as needed to force an insn
11844
to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
11845
@var{number}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
11846
separate groups.  Insert @var{number} nops to force an insn to a new group.
11847
 
11848
@item -mcall-sysv
11849
@opindex mcall-sysv
11850
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
11851
conventions that adheres to the March 1995 draft of the System V
11852
Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is the
11853
default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
11854
 
11855
@item -mcall-sysv-eabi
11856
@opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
11857
Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
11858
 
11859
@item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
11860
@opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
11861
Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
11862
 
11863
@item -mcall-solaris
11864
@opindex mcall-solaris
11865
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the Solaris
11866
operating system.
11867
 
11868
@item -mcall-linux
11869
@opindex mcall-linux
11870
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
11871
Linux-based GNU system.
11872
 
11873
@item -mcall-gnu
11874
@opindex mcall-gnu
11875
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
11876
Hurd-based GNU system.
11877
 
11878
@item -mcall-netbsd
11879
@opindex mcall-netbsd
11880
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
11881
NetBSD operating system.
11882
 
11883
@item -maix-struct-return
11884
@opindex maix-struct-return
11885
Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
11886
 
11887
@item -msvr4-struct-return
11888
@opindex msvr4-struct-return
11889
Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
11890
SVR4 ABI)@.
11891
 
11892
@item -mabi=@var{abi-type}
11893
@opindex mabi
11894
Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such extension.
11895
Valid values are @var{altivec}, @var{no-altivec}, @var{spe},
11896
@var{no-spe}, @var{ibmlongdouble}, @var{ieeelongdouble}@.
11897
 
11898
@item -mabi=spe
11899
@opindex mabi=spe
11900
Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change
11901
the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
11902
ABI@.
11903
 
11904
@item -mabi=no-spe
11905
@opindex mabi=no-spe
11906
Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI@.
11907
 
11908
@item -mabi=ibmlongdouble
11909
@opindex mabi=ibmlongdouble
11910
Change the current ABI to use IBM extended precision long double.
11911
This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
11912
 
11913
@item -mabi=ieeelongdouble
11914
@opindex mabi=ieeelongdouble
11915
Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended precision long double.
11916
This is a PowerPC 32-bit Linux ABI option.
11917
 
11918
@item -mprototype
11919
@itemx -mno-prototype
11920
@opindex mprototype
11921
@opindex mno-prototype
11922
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
11923
variable argument functions are properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the
11924
compiler must insert an instruction before every non prototyped call to
11925
set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
11926
indicate whether floating point values were passed in the floating point
11927
registers in case the function takes a variable arguments.  With
11928
@option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
11929
will set or clear the bit.
11930
 
11931
@item -msim
11932
@opindex msim
11933
On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
11934
@file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
11935
@file{libc.a}.  This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}.
11936
configurations.
11937
 
11938
@item -mmvme
11939
@opindex mmvme
11940
On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
11941
@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
11942
@file{libc.a}.
11943
 
11944
@item -mads
11945
@opindex mads
11946
On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
11947
@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
11948
@file{libc.a}.
11949
 
11950
@item -myellowknife
11951
@opindex myellowknife
11952
On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
11953
@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
11954
@file{libc.a}.
11955
 
11956
@item -mvxworks
11957
@opindex mvxworks
11958
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
11959
compiling for a VxWorks system.
11960
 
11961
@item -mwindiss
11962
@opindex mwindiss
11963
Specify that you are compiling for the WindISS simulation environment.
11964
 
11965
@item -memb
11966
@opindex memb
11967
On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
11968
header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
11969
 
11970
@item -meabi
11971
@itemx -mno-eabi
11972
@opindex meabi
11973
@opindex mno-eabi
11974
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
11975
Embedded Applications Binary Interface (eabi) which is a set of
11976
modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting @option{-meabi}
11977
means that the stack is aligned to an 8 byte boundary, a function
11978
@code{__eabi} is called to from @code{main} to set up the eabi
11979
environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
11980
@code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas.  Selecting
11981
@option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16 byte boundary,
11982
do not call an initialization function from @code{main}, and the
11983
@option{-msdata} option will only use @code{r13} to point to a single
11984
small data area.  The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
11985
configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
11986
 
11987
@item -msdata=eabi
11988
@opindex msdata=eabi
11989
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
11990
@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
11991
is pointed to by register @code{r2}.  Put small initialized
11992
non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
11993
which is pointed to by register @code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized
11994
global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
11995
the @samp{.sdata} section.  The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
11996
incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option.  The
11997
@option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
11998
 
11999
@item -msdata=sysv
12000
@opindex msdata=sysv
12001
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
12002
data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
12003
@code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
12004
@samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
12005
The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
12006
@option{-mrelocatable} option.
12007
 
12008
@item -msdata=default
12009
@itemx -msdata
12010
@opindex msdata=default
12011
@opindex msdata
12012
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
12013
compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
12014
same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
12015
 
12016
@item -msdata-data
12017
@opindex msdata-data
12018
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global
12019
data in the @samp{.sdata} section.  Put small uninitialized global
12020
data in the @samp{.sbss} section.  Do not use register @code{r13}
12021
to address small data however.  This is the default behavior unless
12022
other @option{-msdata} options are used.
12023
 
12024
@item -msdata=none
12025
@itemx -mno-sdata
12026
@opindex msdata=none
12027
@opindex mno-sdata
12028
On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
12029
in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
12030
@samp{.bss} section.
12031
 
12032
@item -G @var{num}
12033
@opindex G
12034
@cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
12035
@cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
12036
On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
12037
equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or bss sections instead of
12038
the normal data or bss section.  By default, @var{num} is 8.  The
12039
@option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
12040
All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
12041
 
12042
@item -mregnames
12043
@itemx -mno-regnames
12044
@opindex mregnames
12045
@opindex mno-regnames
12046
On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
12047
names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
12048
 
12049
@item -mlongcall
12050
@itemx -mno-longcall
12051
@opindex mlongcall
12052
@opindex mno-longcall
12053
By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer more
12054
expensive calling sequence is required.  This is required for calls
12055
further than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current location.
12056
A short call will be generated if the compiler knows
12057
the call cannot be that far away.  This setting can be overridden by
12058
the @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma
12059
longcall(0)}.
12060
 
12061
Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
12062
glue code on the fly.  On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
12063
generate slower code.  As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
12064
as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature
12065
to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
12066
 
12067
On Darwin/PPC systems, @code{#pragma longcall} will generate ``jbsr
12068
callee, L42'', plus a ``branch island'' (glue code).  The two target
12069
addresses represent the callee and the ``branch island''.  The
12070
Darwin/PPC linker will prefer the first address and generate a ``bl
12071
callee'' if the PPC ``bl'' instruction will reach the callee directly;
12072
otherwise, the linker will generate ``bl L42'' to call the ``branch
12073
island''.  The ``branch island'' is appended to the body of the
12074
calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the callee
12075
and jumps to it.
12076
 
12077
On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to
12078
the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides whether
12079
to use or discard it.
12080
 
12081
In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications
12082
when the linker is known to generate glue.
12083
 
12084
@item -pthread
12085
@opindex pthread
12086
Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
12087
This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
12088
 
12089
@end table
12090
 
12091
@node S/390 and zSeries Options
12092
@subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
12093
@cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
12094
 
12095
These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
12096
 
12097
@table @gcctabopt
12098
@item -mhard-float
12099
@itemx -msoft-float
12100
@opindex mhard-float
12101
@opindex msoft-float
12102
Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
12103
for floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
12104
functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
12105
operations.  When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
12106
generates IEEE floating-point instructions.  This is the default.
12107
 
12108
@item -mlong-double-64
12109
@itemx -mlong-double-128
12110
@opindex mlong-double-64
12111
@opindex mlong-double-128
12112
These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
12113
of 64bit makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
12114
type. This is the default.
12115
 
12116
@item -mbackchain
12117
@itemx -mno-backchain
12118
@opindex mbackchain
12119
@opindex mno-backchain
12120
Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer
12121
into the callee's stack frame.
12122
A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand
12123
DWARF-2 call frame information.
12124
When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is in effect, the backchain pointer is stored
12125
at the bottom of the stack frame; when @option{-mpacked-stack} is in effect,
12126
the backchain is placed into the topmost word of the 96/160 byte register
12127
save area.
12128
 
12129
In general, code compiled with @option{-mbackchain} is call-compatible with
12130
code compiled with @option{-mmo-backchain}; however, use of the backchain
12131
for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is built with
12132
@option{-mbackchain}.  Note that the combination of @option{-mbackchain},
12133
@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
12134
to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
12135
 
12136
The default is to not maintain the backchain.
12137
 
12138
@item -mpacked-stack
12139
@item -mno-packed-stack
12140
@opindex mpacked-stack
12141
@opindex mno-packed-stack
12142
Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is
12143
specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte register save
12144
area only for their default purpose; unused fields still take up stack space.
12145
When @option{-mpacked-stack} is specified, register save slots are densely
12146
packed at the top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other
12147
purposes, allowing for more efficient use of the available stack space.
12148
However, when @option{-mbackchain} is also in effect, the topmost word of
12149
the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address
12150
register is always saved two words below the backchain.
12151
 
12152
As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated with
12153
@option{-mpacked-stack} is call-compatible with code generated with
12154
@option{-mno-packed-stack}.  Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
12155
S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run
12156
time, not just for debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible
12157
with code compiled with @option{-mpacked-stack}.  Also, note that the
12158
combination of @option{-mbackchain},
12159
@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
12160
to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
12161
 
12162
The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
12163
 
12164
@item -msmall-exec
12165
@itemx -mno-small-exec
12166
@opindex msmall-exec
12167
@opindex mno-small-exec
12168
Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
12169
to do subroutine calls.
12170
This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
12171
exceed 64k.  The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
12172
which does not have this limitation.
12173
 
12174
@item -m64
12175
@itemx -m31
12176
@opindex m64
12177
@opindex m31
12178
When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
12179
GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI@.  When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
12180
code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI@.  This allows GCC in
12181
particular to generate 64-bit instructions.  For the @samp{s390}
12182
targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
12183
targets default to @option{-m64}.
12184
 
12185
@item -mzarch
12186
@itemx -mesa
12187
@opindex mzarch
12188
@opindex mesa
12189
When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
12190
instructions available on z/Architecture.
12191
When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
12192
instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that @option{-mesa} is
12193
not possible with @option{-m64}.
12194
When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,
12195
the default is @option{-mesa}.  When generating code compliant
12196
to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is @option{-mzarch}.
12197
 
12198
@item -mmvcle
12199
@itemx -mno-mvcle
12200
@opindex mmvcle
12201
@opindex mno-mvcle
12202
Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
12203
to perform block moves.  When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
12204
use a @code{mvc} loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for
12205
size.
12206
 
12207
@item -mdebug
12208
@itemx -mno-debug
12209
@opindex mdebug
12210
@opindex mno-debug
12211
Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
12212
The default is to not print debug information.
12213
 
12214
@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
12215
@opindex march
12216
Generate code that will run on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
12217
representing a certain processor type.  Possible values for
12218
@var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6}, @samp{z900}, and @samp{z990}.
12219
When generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture,
12220
the default is @option{-march=z900}.  Otherwise, the default is
12221
@option{-march=g5}.
12222
 
12223
@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
12224
@opindex mtune
12225
Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
12226
except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
12227
The list of @var{cpu-type} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
12228
The default is the value used for @option{-march}.
12229
 
12230
@item -mtpf-trace
12231
@itemx -mno-tpf-trace
12232
@opindex mtpf-trace
12233
@opindex mno-tpf-trace
12234
Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace
12235
routines in the operating system.  This option is off by default, even
12236
when compiling for the TPF OS@.
12237
 
12238
@item -mfused-madd
12239
@itemx -mno-fused-madd
12240
@opindex mfused-madd
12241
@opindex mno-fused-madd
12242
Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating point multiply and
12243
accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default if
12244
hardware floating point is used.
12245
 
12246
@item -mwarn-framesize=@var{framesize}
12247
@opindex mwarn-framesize
12248
Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because
12249
this is a compile time check it doesn't need to be a real problem when the program
12250
runs.  It is intended to identify functions which most probably cause
12251
a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with limited stack
12252
size e.g.@: the linux kernel.
12253
 
12254
@item -mwarn-dynamicstack
12255
@opindex mwarn-dynamicstack
12256
Emit a warning if the function calls alloca or uses dynamically
12257
sized arrays.  This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack size.
12258
 
12259
@item -mstack-guard=@var{stack-guard}
12260
@item -mstack-size=@var{stack-size}
12261
@opindex mstack-guard
12262
@opindex mstack-size
12263
These arguments always have to be used in conjunction.  If they are present the s390
12264
back end emits additional instructions in the function prologue which trigger a trap
12265
if the stack size is @var{stack-guard} bytes above the @var{stack-size}
12266
(remember that the stack on s390 grows downward).  These options are intended to
12267
be used to help debugging stack overflow problems.  The additionally emitted code
12268
causes only little overhead and hence can also be used in production like systems
12269
without greater performance degradation.  The given values have to be exact
12270
powers of 2 and @var{stack-size} has to be greater than @var{stack-guard} without
12271
exceeding 64k.
12272
In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
12273
at an address aligned to the value given by @var{stack-size}.
12274
@end table
12275
 
12276
@node Score Options
12277
@subsection Score Options
12278
@cindex Score Options
12279
 
12280
These options are defined for Score implementations:
12281
 
12282
@table @gcctabopt
12283
@item -meb
12284
@opindex meb
12285
Compile code for big endian mode.  This is the default.
12286
 
12287
@item -mel
12288
@opindex mel
12289
Compile code for little endian mode.
12290
 
12291
@item -mnhwloop
12292
@opindex mnhwloop
12293
Disable generate bcnz instruction.
12294
 
12295
@item -muls
12296
@opindex muls
12297
Enable generate unaligned load and store instruction.
12298
 
12299
@item -mmac
12300
@opindex mmac
12301
Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
12302
 
12303
@item -mscore5
12304
@opindex mscore5
12305
Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
12306
 
12307
@item -mscore5u
12308
@opindex mscore5u
12309
Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
12310
 
12311
@item -mscore7
12312
@opindex mscore7
12313
Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
12314
 
12315
@item -mscore7d
12316
@opindex mscore7d
12317
Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
12318
@end table
12319
 
12320
@node SH Options
12321
@subsection SH Options
12322
 
12323
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
12324
 
12325
@table @gcctabopt
12326
@item -m1
12327
@opindex m1
12328
Generate code for the SH1.
12329
 
12330
@item -m2
12331
@opindex m2
12332
Generate code for the SH2.
12333
 
12334
@item -m2e
12335
Generate code for the SH2e.
12336
 
12337
@item -m3
12338
@opindex m3
12339
Generate code for the SH3.
12340
 
12341
@item -m3e
12342
@opindex m3e
12343
Generate code for the SH3e.
12344
 
12345
@item -m4-nofpu
12346
@opindex m4-nofpu
12347
Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
12348
 
12349
@item -m4-single-only
12350
@opindex m4-single-only
12351
Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
12352
supports single-precision arithmetic.
12353
 
12354
@item -m4-single
12355
@opindex m4-single
12356
Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
12357
single-precision mode by default.
12358
 
12359
@item -m4
12360
@opindex m4
12361
Generate code for the SH4.
12362
 
12363
@item -m4a-nofpu
12364
@opindex m4a-nofpu
12365
Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that the
12366
floating-point unit is not used.
12367
 
12368
@item -m4a-single-only
12369
@opindex m4a-single-only
12370
Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
12371
floating point operations are used.
12372
 
12373
@item -m4a-single
12374
@opindex m4a-single
12375
Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
12376
single-precision mode by default.
12377
 
12378
@item -m4a
12379
@opindex m4a
12380
Generate code for the SH4a.
12381
 
12382
@item -m4al
12383
@opindex m4al
12384
Same as @option{-m4a-nofpu}, except that it implicitly passes
12385
@option{-dsp} to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any DSP
12386
instructions at the moment.
12387
 
12388
@item -mb
12389
@opindex mb
12390
Compile code for the processor in big endian mode.
12391
 
12392
@item -ml
12393
@opindex ml
12394
Compile code for the processor in little endian mode.
12395
 
12396
@item -mdalign
12397
@opindex mdalign
12398
Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling
12399
conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library will
12400
not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
12401
 
12402
@item -mrelax
12403
@opindex mrelax
12404
Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
12405
linker option @option{-relax}.
12406
 
12407
@item -mbigtable
12408
@opindex mbigtable
12409
Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables.  The default is to use
12410
16-bit offsets.
12411
 
12412
@item -mfmovd
12413
@opindex mfmovd
12414
Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}.
12415
 
12416
@item -mhitachi
12417
@opindex mhitachi
12418
Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
12419
 
12420
@item -mrenesas
12421
@opindex mhitachi
12422
Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
12423
 
12424
@item -mno-renesas
12425
@opindex mhitachi
12426
Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas
12427
conventions were available.  This option is the default for all
12428
targets of the SH toolchain except for @samp{sh-symbianelf}.
12429
 
12430
@item -mnomacsave
12431
@opindex mnomacsave
12432
Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
12433
@option{-mhitachi} is given.
12434
 
12435
@item -mieee
12436
@opindex mieee
12437
Increase IEEE-compliance of floating-point code.
12438
At the moment, this is equivalent to @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
12439
When generating 16 bit SH opcodes, getting IEEE-conforming results for
12440
comparisons of NANs / infinities incurs extra overhead in every
12441
floating point comparison, therefore the default is set to
12442
@option{-ffinite-math-only}.
12443
 
12444
@item -misize
12445
@opindex misize
12446
Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
12447
 
12448
@item -mpadstruct
12449
@opindex mpadstruct
12450
This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
12451
which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
12452
 
12453
@item -mspace
12454
@opindex mspace
12455
Optimize for space instead of speed.  Implied by @option{-Os}.
12456
 
12457
@item -mprefergot
12458
@opindex mprefergot
12459
When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
12460
the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
12461
 
12462
@item -musermode
12463
@opindex musermode
12464
Generate a library function call to invalidate instruction cache
12465
entries, after fixing up a trampoline.  This library function call
12466
doesn't assume it can write to the whole memory address space.  This
12467
is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
12468
 
12469
@item -multcost=@var{number}
12470
@opindex multcost=@var{number}
12471
Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
12472
 
12473
@item -mdiv=@var{strategy}
12474
@opindex mdiv=@var{strategy}
12475
Set the division strategy to use for SHmedia code.  @var{strategy} must be
12476
one of: call, call2, fp, inv, inv:minlat, inv20u, inv20l, inv:call,
12477
inv:call2, inv:fp .
12478
"fp" performs the operation in floating point.  This has a very high latency,
12479
but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice if
12480
your code has enough easily exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to
12481
schedule the floating point instructions together with other instructions.
12482
Division by zero causes a floating point exception.
12483
"inv" uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor,
12484
and then multiplies the dividend with the inverse.  This strategy allows
12485
cse and hoisting of the inverse calculation.  Division by zero calculates
12486
an unspecified result, but does not trap.
12487
"inv:minlat" is a variant of "inv" where if no cse / hoisting opportunities
12488
have been found, or if the entire operation has been hoisted to the same
12489
place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the
12490
final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a few
12491
more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with
12492
other code.
12493
"call" calls a library function that usually implements the inv:minlat
12494
strategy.
12495
This gives high code density for m5-*media-nofpu compilations.
12496
"call2" uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it
12497
assumes that a pointer to a lookup table has already been set up, which
12498
exposes the pointer load to cse / code hoisting optimizations.
12499
"inv:call", "inv:call2" and "inv:fp" all use the "inv" algorithm for initial
12500
code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the "call",
12501
"call2", or "fp" strategies, respectively.  Note that the
12502
potentially-trapping side effect of division by zero is carried by a
12503
separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions
12504
are hoisted out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.
12505
A recombination to fp operations or a call is not possible in that case.
12506
"inv20u" and "inv20l" are variants of the "inv:minlat" strategy.  In the case
12507
that the inverse calculation was nor separated from the multiply, they speed
12508
up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where applicable),
12509
by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test
12510
slows down the case of larger dividends.  inv20u assumes the case of a such
12511
a small dividend to be unlikely, and inv20l assumes it to be likely.
12512
 
12513
@item -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
12514
@opindex mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
12515
Set the name of the library function used for 32 bit signed division to
12516
@var{name}.  This only affect the name used in the call and inv:call
12517
division strategies, and the compiler will still expect the same
12518
sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option was not present.
12519
 
12520
@item -madjust-unroll
12521
@opindex madjust-unroll
12522
Throttle unrolling to avoid thrashing target registers.
12523
This option only has an effect if the gcc code base supports the
12524
TARGET_ADJUST_UNROLL_MAX target hook.
12525
 
12526
@item -mindexed-addressing
12527
@opindex mindexed-addressing
12528
Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.
12529
This is only safe if the hardware and/or OS implement 32 bit wrap-around
12530
semantics for the indexed addressing mode.  The architecture allows the
12531
implementation of processors with 64 bit MMU, which the OS could use to
12532
get 32 bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports
12533
this or any other way to make the indexed addressing mode safe to use in
12534
the 32 bit ABI, the default is -mno-indexed-addressing.
12535
 
12536
@item -mgettrcost=@var{number}
12537
@opindex mgettrcost=@var{number}
12538
Set the cost assumed for the gettr instruction to @var{number}.
12539
The default is 2 if @option{-mpt-fixed} is in effect, 100 otherwise.
12540
 
12541
@item -mpt-fixed
12542
@opindex mpt-fixed
12543
Assume pt* instructions won't trap.  This will generally generate better
12544
scheduled code, but is unsafe on current hardware.  The current architecture
12545
definition says that ptabs and ptrel trap when the target anded with 3 is 3.
12546
This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe to schedule ptabs /
12547
ptrel before a branch, or hoist it out of a loop.  For example,
12548
__do_global_ctors, a part of libgcc that runs constructors at program
12549
startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by -1.  With the
12550
-mpt-fixed option, the ptabs will be done before testing against -1.
12551
That means that all the constructors will be run a bit quicker, but when
12552
the loop comes to the end of the list, the program crashes because ptabs
12553
loads -1 into a target register.  Since this option is unsafe for any
12554
hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the default
12555
is -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless the user specifies a specific cost with
12556
@option{-mgettrcost}, -mno-pt-fixed also implies @option{-mgettrcost=100};
12557
this deters register allocation using target registers for storing
12558
ordinary integers.
12559
 
12560
@item -minvalid-symbols
12561
@opindex minvalid-symbols
12562
Assume symbols might be invalid.  Ordinary function symbols generated by
12563
the compiler will always be valid to load with movi/shori/ptabs or
12564
movi/shori/ptrel, but with assembler and/or linker tricks it is possible
12565
to generate symbols that will cause ptabs / ptrel to trap.
12566
This option is only meaningful when @option{-mno-pt-fixed} is in effect.
12567
It will then prevent cross-basic-block cse, hoisting and most scheduling
12568
of symbol loads.  The default is @option{-mno-invalid-symbols}.
12569
@end table
12570
 
12571
@node SPARC Options
12572
@subsection SPARC Options
12573
@cindex SPARC options
12574
 
12575
These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPARC:
12576
 
12577
@table @gcctabopt
12578
@item -mno-app-regs
12579
@itemx -mapp-regs
12580
@opindex mno-app-regs
12581
@opindex mapp-regs
12582
Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
12583
2 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications.  This
12584
is the default.
12585
 
12586
To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
12587
specify @option{-mno-app-regs}.  You should compile libraries and system
12588
software with this option.
12589
 
12590
@item -mfpu
12591
@itemx -mhard-float
12592
@opindex mfpu
12593
@opindex mhard-float
12594
Generate output containing floating point instructions.  This is the
12595
default.
12596
 
12597
@item -mno-fpu
12598
@itemx -msoft-float
12599
@opindex mno-fpu
12600
@opindex msoft-float
12601
Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
12602
@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
12603
targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
12604
used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
12605
your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
12606
cross-compilation.  The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
12607
@samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating point support.
12608
 
12609
@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
12610
therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
12611
this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
12612
library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
12613
this to work.
12614
 
12615
@item -mhard-quad-float
12616
@opindex mhard-quad-float
12617
Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating point
12618
instructions.
12619
 
12620
@item -msoft-quad-float
12621
@opindex msoft-quad-float
12622
Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
12623
floating point instructions.  The functions called are those specified
12624
in the SPARC ABI@.  This is the default.
12625
 
12626
As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware
12627
support for the quad-word floating point instructions.  They all invoke
12628
a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
12629
emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead,
12630
this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines.  Thus the
12631
@option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
12632
 
12633
@item -mno-unaligned-doubles
12634
@itemx -munaligned-doubles
12635
@opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
12636
@opindex munaligned-doubles
12637
Assume that doubles have 8 byte alignment.  This is the default.
12638
 
12639
With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8 byte
12640
alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
12641
absolute address.  Otherwise, it assumes they have 4 byte alignment.
12642
Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
12643
generated by other compilers.  It is not the default because it results
12644
in a performance loss, especially for floating point code.
12645
 
12646
@item -mno-faster-structs
12647
@itemx -mfaster-structs
12648
@opindex mno-faster-structs
12649
@opindex mfaster-structs
12650
With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
12651
should have 8 byte alignment.  This enables the use of pairs of
12652
@code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
12653
assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
12654
However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
12655
ABI@.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
12656
acknowledges that their resulting code will not be directly in line with
12657
the rules of the ABI@.
12658
 
12659
@item -mimpure-text
12660
@opindex mimpure-text
12661
@option{-mimpure-text}, used in addition to @option{-shared}, tells
12662
the compiler to not pass @option{-z text} to the linker when linking a
12663
shared object.  Using this option, you can link position-dependent
12664
code into a shared object.
12665
 
12666
@option{-mimpure-text} suppresses the ``relocations remain against
12667
allocatable but non-writable sections'' linker error message.
12668
However, the necessary relocations will trigger copy-on-write, and the
12669
shared object is not actually shared across processes.  Instead of
12670
using @option{-mimpure-text}, you should compile all source code with
12671
@option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}.
12672
 
12673
This option is only available on SunOS and Solaris.
12674
 
12675
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
12676
@opindex mcpu
12677
Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
12678
for machine type @var{cpu_type}.  Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
12679
@samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{sparclite},
12680
@samp{f930}, @samp{f934}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{sparclite86x},
12681
@samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9}, @samp{ultrasparc},
12682
@samp{ultrasparc3}, and @samp{niagara}.
12683
 
12684
Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
12685
an architecture and not an implementation.  These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
12686
@samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
12687
 
12688
Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
12689
implementations.
12690
 
12691
@smallexample
12692
    v7:             cypress
12693
    v8:             supersparc, hypersparc
12694
    sparclite:      f930, f934, sparclite86x
12695
    sparclet:       tsc701
12696
    v9:             ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara
12697
@end smallexample
12698
 
12699
By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for the V7
12700
variant of the SPARC architecture.  With @option{-mcpu=cypress}, the compiler
12701
additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the
12702
SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
12703
SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
12704
 
12705
With @option{-mcpu=v8}, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
12706
architecture.  The only difference from V7 code is that the compiler emits
12707
the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which exist in SPARC-V8
12708
but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=supersparc}, the compiler additionally
12709
optimizes it for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and
12710
2000 series.
12711
 
12712
With @option{-mcpu=sparclite}, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of
12713
the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, integer divide step
12714
and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC-V7.
12715
With @option{-mcpu=f930}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
12716
Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original SPARClite, with no FPU@.  With
12717
@option{-mcpu=f934}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu
12718
MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU@.
12719
 
12720
With @option{-mcpu=sparclet}, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
12721
the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, multiply/accumulate,
12722
integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClet
12723
but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=tsc701}, the compiler additionally
12724
optimizes it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.
12725
 
12726
With @option{-mcpu=v9}, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
12727
architecture.  This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move instructions,
12728
3 additional floating-point condition code registers and conditional move
12729
instructions.  With @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc}, the compiler additionally
12730
optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi chips.  With
12731
@option{-mcpu=ultrasparc3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
12732
Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips.  With
12733
@option{-mcpu=niagara}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
12734
Sun UltraSPARC T1 chips.
12735
 
12736
@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
12737
@opindex mtune
12738
Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
12739
@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
12740
option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.
12741
 
12742
The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
12743
@option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
12744
that select a particular cpu implementation.  Those are @samp{cypress},
12745
@samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
12746
@samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc},
12747
@samp{ultrasparc3}, and @samp{niagara}.
12748
 
12749
@item -mv8plus
12750
@itemx -mno-v8plus
12751
@opindex mv8plus
12752
@opindex mno-v8plus
12753
With @option{-mv8plus}, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI@.  The
12754
difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
12755
considered 64-bit wide.  This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
12756
mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
12757
 
12758
@item -mvis
12759
@itemx -mno-vis
12760
@opindex mvis
12761
@opindex mno-vis
12762
With @option{-mvis}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
12763
Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The default is @option{-mno-vis}.
12764
@end table
12765
 
12766
These @samp{-m} options are supported in addition to the above
12767
on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:
12768
 
12769
@table @gcctabopt
12770
@item -mlittle-endian
12771
@opindex mlittle-endian
12772
Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  It is only
12773
available for a few configurations and most notably not on Solaris and Linux.
12774
 
12775
@item -m32
12776
@itemx -m64
12777
@opindex m32
12778
@opindex m64
12779
Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
12780
The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
12781
The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
12782
to 64 bits.
12783
 
12784
@item -mcmodel=medlow
12785
@opindex mcmodel=medlow
12786
Generate code for the Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
12787
must be linked in the low 32 bits of memory.  Programs can be statically
12788
or dynamically linked.
12789
 
12790
@item -mcmodel=medmid
12791
@opindex mcmodel=medmid
12792
Generate code for the Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
12793
must be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must
12794
be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of
12795
the text segment.
12796
 
12797
@item -mcmodel=medany
12798
@opindex mcmodel=medany
12799
Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
12800
may be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must be less
12801
than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of the
12802
text segment.
12803
 
12804
@item -mcmodel=embmedany
12805
@opindex mcmodel=embmedany
12806
Generate code for the Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
12807
64-bit addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
12808
size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time).  The
12809
global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment.  Programs
12810
are statically linked and PIC is not supported.
12811
 
12812
@item -mstack-bias
12813
@itemx -mno-stack-bias
12814
@opindex mstack-bias
12815
@opindex mno-stack-bias
12816
With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
12817
frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
12818
when making stack frame references.  This is the default in 64-bit mode.
12819
Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
12820
@end table
12821
 
12822
These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris:
12823
 
12824
@table @gcctabopt
12825
@item -threads
12826
@opindex threads
12827
Add support for multithreading using the Solaris threads library.  This
12828
option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  This option does
12829
not affect the thread safety of object code produced by the compiler or
12830
that of libraries supplied with it.
12831
 
12832
@item -pthreads
12833
@opindex pthreads
12834
Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This
12835
option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  This option does
12836
not affect the thread safety of object code produced  by the compiler or
12837
that of libraries supplied with it.
12838
 
12839
@item -pthread
12840
@opindex pthread
12841
This is a synonym for @option{-pthreads}.
12842
@end table
12843
 
12844
@node System V Options
12845
@subsection Options for System V
12846
 
12847
These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
12848
compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
12849
 
12850
@table @gcctabopt
12851
@item -G
12852
@opindex G
12853
Create a shared object.
12854
It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
12855
 
12856
@item -Qy
12857
@opindex Qy
12858
Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
12859
@code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
12860
 
12861
@item -Qn
12862
@opindex Qn
12863
Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
12864
the default).
12865
 
12866
@item -YP,@var{dirs}
12867
@opindex YP
12868
Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
12869
specified with @option{-l}.
12870
 
12871
@item -Ym,@var{dir}
12872
@opindex Ym
12873
Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
12874
The assembler uses this option.
12875
@c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
12876
@c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
12877
@end table
12878
 
12879
@node TMS320C3x/C4x Options
12880
@subsection TMS320C3x/C4x Options
12881
@cindex TMS320C3x/C4x Options
12882
 
12883
These @samp{-m} options are defined for TMS320C3x/C4x implementations:
12884
 
12885
@table @gcctabopt
12886
 
12887
@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
12888
@opindex mcpu
12889
Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
12890
parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.  Supported values for
12891
@var{cpu_type} are @samp{c30}, @samp{c31}, @samp{c32}, @samp{c40}, and
12892
@samp{c44}.  The default is @samp{c40} to generate code for the
12893
TMS320C40.
12894
 
12895
@item -mbig-memory
12896
@itemx -mbig
12897
@itemx -msmall-memory
12898
@itemx -msmall
12899
@opindex mbig-memory
12900
@opindex mbig
12901
@opindex msmall-memory
12902
@opindex msmall
12903
Generates code for the big or small memory model.  The small memory
12904
model assumed that all data fits into one 64K word page.  At run-time
12905
the data page (DP) register must be set to point to the 64K page
12906
containing the .bss and .data program sections.  The big memory model is
12907
the default and requires reloading of the DP register for every direct
12908
memory access.
12909
 
12910
@item -mbk
12911
@itemx -mno-bk
12912
@opindex mbk
12913
@opindex mno-bk
12914
Allow (disallow) allocation of general integer operands into the block
12915
count register BK@.
12916
 
12917
@item -mdb
12918
@itemx -mno-db
12919
@opindex mdb
12920
@opindex mno-db
12921
Enable (disable) generation of code using decrement and branch,
12922
DBcond(D), instructions.  This is enabled by default for the C4x.  To be
12923
on the safe side, this is disabled for the C3x, since the maximum
12924
iteration count on the C3x is @math{2^{23} + 1} (but who iterates loops more than
12925
@math{2^{23}} times on the C3x?).  Note that GCC will try to reverse a loop so
12926
that it can utilize the decrement and branch instruction, but will give
12927
up if there is more than one memory reference in the loop.  Thus a loop
12928
where the loop counter is decremented can generate slightly more
12929
efficient code, in cases where the RPTB instruction cannot be utilized.
12930
 
12931
@item -mdp-isr-reload
12932
@itemx -mparanoid
12933
@opindex mdp-isr-reload
12934
@opindex mparanoid
12935
Force the DP register to be saved on entry to an interrupt service
12936
routine (ISR), reloaded to point to the data section, and restored on
12937
exit from the ISR@.  This should not be required unless someone has
12938
violated the small memory model by modifying the DP register, say within
12939
an object library.
12940
 
12941
@item -mmpyi
12942
@itemx -mno-mpyi
12943
@opindex mmpyi
12944
@opindex mno-mpyi
12945
For the C3x use the 24-bit MPYI instruction for integer multiplies
12946
instead of a library call to guarantee 32-bit results.  Note that if one
12947
of the operands is a constant, then the multiplication will be performed
12948
using shifts and adds.  If the @option{-mmpyi} option is not specified for the C3x,
12949
then squaring operations are performed inline instead of a library call.
12950
 
12951
@item -mfast-fix
12952
@itemx -mno-fast-fix
12953
@opindex mfast-fix
12954
@opindex mno-fast-fix
12955
The C3x/C4x FIX instruction to convert a floating point value to an
12956
integer value chooses the nearest integer less than or equal to the
12957
floating point value rather than to the nearest integer.  Thus if the
12958
floating point number is negative, the result will be incorrectly
12959
truncated an additional code is necessary to detect and correct this
12960
case.  This option can be used to disable generation of the additional
12961
code required to correct the result.
12962
 
12963
@item -mrptb
12964
@itemx -mno-rptb
12965
@opindex mrptb
12966
@opindex mno-rptb
12967
Enable (disable) generation of repeat block sequences using the RPTB
12968
instruction for zero overhead looping.  The RPTB construct is only used
12969
for innermost loops that do not call functions or jump across the loop
12970
boundaries.  There is no advantage having nested RPTB loops due to the
12971
overhead required to save and restore the RC, RS, and RE registers.
12972
This is enabled by default with @option{-O2}.
12973
 
12974
@item -mrpts=@var{count}
12975
@itemx -mno-rpts
12976
@opindex mrpts
12977
@opindex mno-rpts
12978
Enable (disable) the use of the single instruction repeat instruction
12979
RPTS@.  If a repeat block contains a single instruction, and the loop
12980
count can be guaranteed to be less than the value @var{count}, GCC will
12981
emit a RPTS instruction instead of a RPTB@.  If no value is specified,
12982
then a RPTS will be emitted even if the loop count cannot be determined
12983
at compile time.  Note that the repeated instruction following RPTS does
12984
not have to be reloaded from memory each iteration, thus freeing up the
12985
CPU buses for operands.  However, since interrupts are blocked by this
12986
instruction, it is disabled by default.
12987
 
12988
@item -mloop-unsigned
12989
@itemx -mno-loop-unsigned
12990
@opindex mloop-unsigned
12991
@opindex mno-loop-unsigned
12992
The maximum iteration count when using RPTS and RPTB (and DB on the C40)
12993
is @math{2^{31} + 1} since these instructions test if the iteration count is
12994
negative to terminate the loop.  If the iteration count is unsigned
12995
there is a possibility than the @math{2^{31} + 1} maximum iteration count may be
12996
exceeded.  This switch allows an unsigned iteration count.
12997
 
12998
@item -mti
12999
@opindex mti
13000
Try to emit an assembler syntax that the TI assembler (asm30) is happy
13001
with.  This also enforces compatibility with the API employed by the TI
13002
C3x C compiler.  For example, long doubles are passed as structures
13003
rather than in floating point registers.
13004
 
13005
@item -mregparm
13006
@itemx -mmemparm
13007
@opindex mregparm
13008
@opindex mmemparm
13009
Generate code that uses registers (stack) for passing arguments to functions.
13010
By default, arguments are passed in registers where possible rather
13011
than by pushing arguments on to the stack.
13012
 
13013
@item -mparallel-insns
13014
@itemx -mno-parallel-insns
13015
@opindex mparallel-insns
13016
@opindex mno-parallel-insns
13017
Allow the generation of parallel instructions.  This is enabled by
13018
default with @option{-O2}.
13019
 
13020
@item -mparallel-mpy
13021
@itemx -mno-parallel-mpy
13022
@opindex mparallel-mpy
13023
@opindex mno-parallel-mpy
13024
Allow the generation of MPY||ADD and MPY||SUB parallel instructions,
13025
provided @option{-mparallel-insns} is also specified.  These instructions have
13026
tight register constraints which can pessimize the code generation
13027
of large functions.
13028
 
13029
@end table
13030
 
13031
@node V850 Options
13032
@subsection V850 Options
13033
@cindex V850 Options
13034
 
13035
These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
13036
 
13037
@table @gcctabopt
13038
@item -mlong-calls
13039
@itemx -mno-long-calls
13040
@opindex mlong-calls
13041
@opindex mno-long-calls
13042
Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be
13043
far away, the compiler will always load the functions address up into a
13044
register, and call indirect through the pointer.
13045
 
13046
@item -mno-ep
13047
@itemx -mep
13048
@opindex mno-ep
13049
@opindex mep
13050
Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
13051
pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
13052
use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions.  The @option{-mep}
13053
option is on by default if you optimize.
13054
 
13055
@item -mno-prolog-function
13056
@itemx -mprolog-function
13057
@opindex mno-prolog-function
13058
@opindex mprolog-function
13059
Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers
13060
at the prologue and epilogue of a function.  The external functions
13061
are slower, but use less code space if more than one function saves
13062
the same number of registers.  The @option{-mprolog-function} option
13063
is on by default if you optimize.
13064
 
13065
@item -mspace
13066
@opindex mspace
13067
Try to make the code as small as possible.  At present, this just turns
13068
on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
13069
 
13070
@item -mtda=@var{n}
13071
@opindex mtda
13072
Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
13073
the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to.  The tiny data
13074
area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
13075
 
13076
@item -msda=@var{n}
13077
@opindex msda
13078
Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
13079
the small data area that register @code{gp} points to.  The small data
13080
area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
13081
 
13082
@item -mzda=@var{n}
13083
@opindex mzda
13084
Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
13085
the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
13086
 
13087
@item -mv850
13088
@opindex mv850
13089
Specify that the target processor is the V850.
13090
 
13091
@item -mbig-switch
13092
@opindex mbig-switch
13093
Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
13094
the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
13095
table.
13096
 
13097
@item -mapp-regs
13098
@opindex mapp-regs
13099
This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
13100
the compiler.  This setting is the default.
13101
 
13102
@item -mno-app-regs
13103
@opindex mno-app-regs
13104
This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
13105
 
13106
@item -mv850e1
13107
@opindex mv850e1
13108
Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor
13109
constants @samp{__v850e1__} and @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if
13110
this option is used.
13111
 
13112
@item -mv850e
13113
@opindex mv850e
13114
Specify that the target processor is the V850E@.  The preprocessor
13115
constant @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if this option is used.
13116
 
13117
If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} nor @option{-mv850e1}
13118
are defined then a default target processor will be chosen and the
13119
relevant @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant will be defined.
13120
 
13121
The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
13122
defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
13123
 
13124
@item -mdisable-callt
13125
@opindex mdisable-callt
13126
This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction for the
13127
v850e and v850e1 flavors of the v850 architecture.  The default is
13128
@option{-mno-disable-callt} which allows the CALLT instruction to be used.
13129
 
13130
@end table
13131
 
13132
@node VAX Options
13133
@subsection VAX Options
13134
@cindex VAX options
13135
 
13136
These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
13137
 
13138
@table @gcctabopt
13139
@item -munix
13140
@opindex munix
13141
Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
13142
that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
13143
ranges.
13144
 
13145
@item -mgnu
13146
@opindex mgnu
13147
Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you
13148
will assemble with the GNU assembler.
13149
 
13150
@item -mg
13151
@opindex mg
13152
Output code for g-format floating point numbers instead of d-format.
13153
@end table
13154
 
13155
@node x86-64 Options
13156
@subsection x86-64 Options
13157
@cindex x86-64 options
13158
 
13159
These are listed under @xref{i386 and x86-64 Options}.
13160
 
13161
@node Xstormy16 Options
13162
@subsection Xstormy16 Options
13163
@cindex Xstormy16 Options
13164
 
13165
These options are defined for Xstormy16:
13166
 
13167
@table @gcctabopt
13168
@item -msim
13169
@opindex msim
13170
Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
13171
@end table
13172
 
13173
@node Xtensa Options
13174
@subsection Xtensa Options
13175
@cindex Xtensa Options
13176
 
13177
These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
13178
 
13179
@table @gcctabopt
13180
@item -mconst16
13181
@itemx -mno-const16
13182
@opindex mconst16
13183
@opindex mno-const16
13184
Enable or disable use of @code{CONST16} instructions for loading
13185
constant values.  The @code{CONST16} instruction is currently not a
13186
standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, @code{CONST16}
13187
instructions are always used in place of the standard @code{L32R}
13188
instructions.  The use of @code{CONST16} is enabled by default only if
13189
the @code{L32R} instruction is not available.
13190
 
13191
@item -mfused-madd
13192
@itemx -mno-fused-madd
13193
@opindex mfused-madd
13194
@opindex mno-fused-madd
13195
Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
13196
instructions in the floating-point option.  This has no effect if the
13197
floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused multiply/add
13198
and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
13199
instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations.  This may be
13200
desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
13201
required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
13202
intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
13203
precision than specified by the IEEE standard.  Disabling fused multiply
13204
add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
13205
sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
13206
operations.
13207
 
13208
@item -mtext-section-literals
13209
@itemx -mno-text-section-literals
13210
@opindex mtext-section-literals
13211
@opindex mno-text-section-literals
13212
Control the treatment of literal pools.  The default is
13213
@option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
13214
section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be placed
13215
in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
13216
pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
13217
improve code size.  With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
13218
are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
13219
possible to their references.  This may be necessary for large assembly
13220
files.
13221
 
13222
@item -mtarget-align
13223
@itemx -mno-target-align
13224
@opindex mtarget-align
13225
@opindex mno-target-align
13226
When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
13227
automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
13228
expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
13229
instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
13230
instructions.  If there are not enough preceding safe density
13231
instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed.  The
13232
default is @option{-mtarget-align}.  These options do not affect the
13233
treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
13234
assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or
13235
by inserting no-op instructions.
13236
 
13237
@item -mlongcalls
13238
@itemx -mno-longcalls
13239
@opindex mlongcalls
13240
@opindex mno-longcalls
13241
When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
13242
direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
13243
of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction.  This
13244
translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
13245
files.  Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
13246
instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
13247
The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}.  This option should be used in
13248
programs where the call target can potentially be out of range.  This
13249
option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
13250
assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct call
13251
instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
13252
instructions.  Note that the assembler will use an indirect call for
13253
every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.
13254
@end table
13255
 
13256
@node zSeries Options
13257
@subsection zSeries Options
13258
@cindex zSeries options
13259
 
13260
These are listed under @xref{S/390 and zSeries Options}.
13261
 
13262
@node Code Gen Options
13263
@section Options for Code Generation Conventions
13264
@cindex code generation conventions
13265
@cindex options, code generation
13266
@cindex run-time options
13267
 
13268
These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
13269
used in code generation.
13270
 
13271
Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
13272
of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table below, only
13273
one of the forms is listed---the one which is not the default.  You
13274
can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
13275
it.
13276
 
13277
@table @gcctabopt
13278
@item -fbounds-check
13279
@opindex fbounds-check
13280
For front-ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
13281
indices used to access arrays are within the declared range.  This is
13282
currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front-ends, where
13283
this option defaults to true and false respectively.
13284
 
13285
@item -ftrapv
13286
@opindex ftrapv
13287
This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
13288
multiplication operations.
13289
 
13290
@item -fwrapv
13291
@opindex fwrapv
13292
This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
13293
overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
13294
using twos-complement representation.  This flag enables some optimizations
13295
and disables others.  This option is enabled by default for the Java
13296
front-end, as required by the Java language specification.
13297
 
13298
@item -fexceptions
13299
@opindex fexceptions
13300
Enable exception handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate
13301
exceptions.  For some targets, this implies GCC will generate frame
13302
unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
13303
size overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not
13304
specify this option, GCC will enable it by default for languages like
13305
C++ which normally require exception handling, and disable it for
13306
languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need
13307
to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
13308
properly with exception handlers written in C++.  You may also wish to
13309
disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
13310
use exception handling.
13311
 
13312
@item -fnon-call-exceptions
13313
@opindex fnon-call-exceptions
13314
Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
13315
Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
13316
not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
13317
instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating
13318
point instructions.  It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
13319
arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
13320
 
13321
@item -funwind-tables
13322
@opindex funwind-tables
13323
Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it will just generate any needed
13324
static data, but will not affect the generated code in any other way.
13325
You will normally not enable this option; instead, a language processor
13326
that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.
13327
 
13328
@item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
13329
@opindex fasynchronous-unwind-tables
13330
Generate unwind table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine.  The
13331
table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
13332
unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
13333
 
13334
@item -fpcc-struct-return
13335
@opindex fpcc-struct-return
13336
Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
13337
longer ones, rather than in registers.  This convention is less
13338
efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
13339
GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
13340
the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
13341
 
13342
The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
13343
on the target configuration macros.
13344
 
13345
Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
13346
that of some integer type.
13347
 
13348
@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
13349
switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
13350
@option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
13351
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13352
 
13353
@item -freg-struct-return
13354
@opindex freg-struct-return
13355
Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
13356
This is more efficient for small structures than
13357
@option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
13358
 
13359
If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
13360
@option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
13361
standard for the target.  If there is no standard convention, GCC
13362
defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
13363
the principal compiler.  In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
13364
we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
13365
 
13366
@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
13367
switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
13368
@option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
13369
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13370
 
13371
@item -fshort-enums
13372
@opindex fshort-enums
13373
Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
13374
declared range of possible values.  Specifically, the @code{enum} type
13375
will be equivalent to the smallest integer type which has enough room.
13376
 
13377
@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
13378
code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
13379
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13380
 
13381
@item -fshort-double
13382
@opindex fshort-double
13383
Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
13384
 
13385
@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
13386
code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
13387
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13388
 
13389
@item -fshort-wchar
13390
@opindex fshort-wchar
13391
Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
13392
unsigned int} instead of the default for the target.  This option is
13393
useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
13394
 
13395
@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
13396
code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
13397
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13398
 
13399
@item -fno-common
13400
@opindex fno-common
13401
In C, allocate even uninitialized global variables in the data section of the
13402
object file, rather than generating them as common blocks.  This has the
13403
effect that if the same variable is declared (without @code{extern}) in
13404
two different compilations, you will get an error when you link them.
13405
The only reason this might be useful is if you wish to verify that the
13406
program will work on other systems which always work this way.
13407
 
13408
@item -fno-ident
13409
@opindex fno-ident
13410
Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
13411
 
13412
@item -finhibit-size-directive
13413
@opindex finhibit-size-directive
13414
Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
13415
would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
13416
two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This option is
13417
used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
13418
for anything else.
13419
 
13420
@item -fverbose-asm
13421
@opindex fverbose-asm
13422
Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
13423
make it more readable.  This option is generally only of use to those
13424
who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
13425
debugging the compiler itself).
13426
 
13427
@option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
13428
extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
13429
files.
13430
 
13431
@item -fpic
13432
@opindex fpic
13433
@cindex global offset table
13434
@cindex PIC
13435
Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
13436
library, if supported for the target machine.  Such code accesses all
13437
constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@.  The dynamic
13438
loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
13439
loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system).  If
13440
the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
13441
maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
13442
@option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
13443
instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k
13444
on the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)
13445
 
13446
Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
13447
only on certain machines.  For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
13448
but not for the Sun 386i.  Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
13449
position-independent.
13450
 
13451
When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
13452
are defined to 1.
13453
 
13454
@item -fPIC
13455
@opindex fPIC
13456
If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
13457
suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
13458
global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the m68k,
13459
PowerPC and SPARC@.
13460
 
13461
Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
13462
only on certain machines.
13463
 
13464
When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
13465
are defined to 2.
13466
 
13467
@item -fpie
13468
@itemx -fPIE
13469
@opindex fpie
13470
@opindex fPIE
13471
These options are similar to @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, but
13472
generated position independent code can be only linked into executables.
13473
Usually these options are used when @option{-pie} GCC option will be
13474
used during linking.
13475
 
13476
@item -fno-jump-tables
13477
@opindex fno-jump-tables
13478
Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
13479
more efficient than other code generation strategies.  This option is
13480
of use in conjunction with @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC} for
13481
building code which forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot
13482
reference the address of a jump table.  On some targets, jump tables
13483
do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.
13484
 
13485
@item -ffixed-@var{reg}
13486
@opindex ffixed
13487
Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
13488
should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
13489
pointer or in some other fixed role).
13490
 
13491
@var{reg} must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted
13492
are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
13493
macro in the machine description macro file.
13494
 
13495
This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
13496
three-way choice.
13497
 
13498
@item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
13499
@opindex fcall-used
13500
Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
13501
clobbered by function calls.  It may be allocated for temporaries or
13502
variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled this way
13503
will not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
13504
 
13505
It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
13506
Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
13507
the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
13508
 
13509
This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
13510
three-way choice.
13511
 
13512
@item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
13513
@opindex fcall-saved
13514
Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
13515
functions.  It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
13516
live across a call.  Functions compiled this way will save and restore
13517
the register @var{reg} if they use it.
13518
 
13519
It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
13520
Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
13521
the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
13522
 
13523
A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for
13524
a register in which function values may be returned.
13525
 
13526
This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
13527
three-way choice.
13528
 
13529
@item -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]
13530
@opindex fpack-struct
13531
Without a value specified, pack all structure members together without
13532
holes.  When a value is specified (which must be a small power of two), pack
13533
structure members according to this value, representing the maximum
13534
alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
13535
this will be output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.
13536
 
13537
@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
13538
code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
13539
Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
13540
Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13541
 
13542
@item -finstrument-functions
13543
@opindex finstrument-functions
13544
Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just
13545
after function entry and just before function exit, the following
13546
profiling functions will be called with the address of the current
13547
function and its call site.  (On some platforms,
13548
@code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
13549
function, so the call site information may not be available to the
13550
profiling functions otherwise.)
13551
 
13552
@smallexample
13553
void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
13554
                               void *call_site);
13555
void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
13556
                               void *call_site);
13557
@end smallexample
13558
 
13559
The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
13560
which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
13561
 
13562
This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
13563
functions.  The profiling calls will indicate where, conceptually, the
13564
inline function is entered and exited.  This means that addressable
13565
versions of such functions must be available.  If all your uses of a
13566
function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
13567
code size.  If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
13568
addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is
13569
normally the case anyways, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
13570
expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
13571
providing static copies.)
13572
 
13573
A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
13574
which case this instrumentation will not be done.  This can be used, for
13575
example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
13576
interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
13577
cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
13578
routines generate output or allocate memory).
13579
 
13580
@item -fstack-check
13581
@opindex fstack-check
13582
Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
13583
stack.  You should specify this flag if you are running in an
13584
environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to specify it in
13585
a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
13586
detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
13587
 
13588
Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
13589
operating system must do that.  The switch causes generation of code
13590
to ensure that the operating system sees the stack being extended.
13591
 
13592
@item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
13593
@itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
13594
@itemx -fno-stack-limit
13595
@opindex fstack-limit-register
13596
@opindex fstack-limit-symbol
13597
@opindex fno-stack-limit
13598
Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
13599
either the value of a register or the address of a symbol.  If the stack
13600
would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised.  For most targets,
13601
the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
13602
it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
13603
 
13604
For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
13605
and grows downwards, you can use the flags
13606
@option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
13607
@option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
13608
of 128KB@.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
13609
 
13610
@cindex aliasing of parameters
13611
@cindex parameters, aliased
13612
@item -fargument-alias
13613
@itemx -fargument-noalias
13614
@itemx -fargument-noalias-global
13615
@itemx -fargument-noalias-anything
13616
@opindex fargument-alias
13617
@opindex fargument-noalias
13618
@opindex fargument-noalias-global
13619
@opindex fargument-noalias-anything
13620
Specify the possible relationships among parameters and between
13621
parameters and global data.
13622
 
13623
@option{-fargument-alias} specifies that arguments (parameters) may
13624
alias each other and may alias global storage.@*
13625
@option{-fargument-noalias} specifies that arguments do not alias
13626
each other, but may alias global storage.@*
13627
@option{-fargument-noalias-global} specifies that arguments do not
13628
alias each other and do not alias global storage.
13629
@option{-fargument-noalias-anything} specifies that arguments do not
13630
alias any other storage.
13631
 
13632
Each language will automatically use whatever option is required by
13633
the language standard.  You should not need to use these options yourself.
13634
 
13635
@item -fleading-underscore
13636
@opindex fleading-underscore
13637
This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
13638
change the way C symbols are represented in the object file.  One use
13639
is to help link with legacy assembly code.
13640
 
13641
@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
13642
generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
13643
switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
13644
Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
13645
 
13646
@item -ftls-model=@var{model}
13647
Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
13648
The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
13649
@code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
13650
 
13651
The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
13652
@option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
13653
 
13654
@item -fvisibility=@var{default|internal|hidden|protected}
13655
@opindex fvisibility
13656
Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all
13657
symbols will be marked with this unless overridden within the code.
13658
Using this feature can very substantially improve linking and
13659
load times of shared object libraries, produce more optimized
13660
code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol clashes.
13661
It is @strong{strongly} recommended that you use this in any shared objects
13662
you distribute.
13663
 
13664
Despite the nomenclature, @code{default} always means public ie;
13665
available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
13666
@code{protected} and @code{internal} are pretty useless in real-world
13667
usage so the only other commonly used option will be @code{hidden}.
13668
The default if @option{-fvisibility} isn't specified is
13669
@code{default}, i.e., make every
13670
symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
13671
GCC@.
13672
 
13673
A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF
13674
symbols have the correct visibility is given by ``How To Write
13675
Shared Libraries'' by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
13676
@w{@uref{http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/}})---however a superior
13677
solution made possible by this option to marking things hidden when
13678
the default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
13679
public.  This is the norm with DLL's on Windows and with @option{-fvisibility=hidden}
13680
and @code{__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))} instead of
13681
@code{__declspec(dllexport)} you get almost identical semantics with
13682
identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with
13683
cross-platform projects.
13684
 
13685
For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
13686
@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} of use.  This works by you enclosing
13687
the declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
13688
@samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)} and
13689
@samp{#pragma GCC visibility pop}.
13690
Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed @strong{as
13691
part of the API interface contract} and thus all new code should
13692
always specify visibility when it is not the default ie; declarations
13693
only for use within the local DSO should @strong{always} be marked explicitly
13694
as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
13695
abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.
13696
Note that due to ISO C++ specification requirements, operator new and
13697
operator delete must always be of default visibility.
13698
 
13699
Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system
13700
headers and headers from any other library you use, may not be
13701
expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.  You
13702
may need to explicitly say @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(default)}
13703
before including any such headers.
13704
 
13705
@samp{extern} declarations are not affected by @samp{-fvisibility}, so
13706
a lot of code can be recompiled with @samp{-fvisibility=hidden} with
13707
no modifications.  However, this means that calls to @samp{extern}
13708
functions with no explicit visibility will use the PLT, so it is more
13709
effective to use @samp{__attribute ((visibility))} and/or
13710
@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} to tell the compiler which @samp{extern}
13711
declarations should be treated as hidden.
13712
 
13713
Note that @samp{-fvisibility} does affect C++ vague linkage
13714
entities. This means that, for instance, an exception class that will
13715
be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default
13716
visibility so that the @samp{type_info} nodes will be unified between
13717
the DSOs.
13718
 
13719
An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
13720
is at @w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/Visibility}}.
13721
 
13722
@end table
13723
 
13724
@c man end
13725
 
13726
@node Environment Variables
13727
@section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
13728
@cindex environment variables
13729
 
13730
@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
13731
This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
13732
operates.  Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
13733
when searching for various kinds of files.  Some are used to specify other
13734
aspects of the compilation environment.
13735
 
13736
Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
13737
@option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}).  These
13738
take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
13739
in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
13740
@xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
13741
GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
13742
 
13743
@table @env
13744
@item LANG
13745
@itemx LC_CTYPE
13746
@c @itemx LC_COLLATE
13747
@itemx LC_MESSAGES
13748
@c @itemx LC_MONETARY
13749
@c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
13750
@c @itemx LC_TIME
13751
@itemx LC_ALL
13752
@findex LANG
13753
@findex LC_CTYPE
13754
@c @findex LC_COLLATE
13755
@findex LC_MESSAGES
13756
@c @findex LC_MONETARY
13757
@c @findex LC_NUMERIC
13758
@c @findex LC_TIME
13759
@findex LC_ALL
13760
@cindex locale
13761
These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
13762
localization information that allow GCC to work with different
13763
national conventions.  GCC inspects the locale categories
13764
@env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
13765
so.  These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
13766
installation.  A typical value is @samp{en_GB.UTF-8} for English in the United
13767
Kingdom encoded in UTF-8.
13768
 
13769
The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
13770
classification.  GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
13771
a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
13772
and escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string
13773
end or escape.
13774
 
13775
The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
13776
use in diagnostic messages.
13777
 
13778
If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
13779
of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
13780
and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
13781
environment variable.  If none of these variables are set, GCC
13782
defaults to traditional C English behavior.
13783
 
13784
@item TMPDIR
13785
@findex TMPDIR
13786
If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
13787
files.  GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
13788
compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
13789
the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
13790
proper.
13791
 
13792
@item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
13793
@findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
13794
If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
13795
names of the subprograms executed by the compiler.  No slash is added
13796
when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
13797
specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
13798
 
13799
If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out
13800
an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it was invoked with.
13801
 
13802
If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
13803
tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
13804
 
13805
The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
13806
@file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc/} where @var{prefix} is the value
13807
of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
13808
 
13809
Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
13810
 
13811
This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
13812
used for linking.
13813
 
13814
In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
13815
directories to search for header files.  For each of the standard
13816
directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc}
13817
(more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
13818
replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
13819
alternate directory name.  Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC will search
13820
@file{foo/bar} where it would normally search @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
13821
These alternate directories are searched first; the standard directories
13822
come next.
13823
 
13824
@item COMPILER_PATH
13825
@findex COMPILER_PATH
13826
The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
13827
directories, much like @env{PATH}.  GCC tries the directories thus
13828
specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
13829
subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
13830
 
13831
@item LIBRARY_PATH
13832
@findex LIBRARY_PATH
13833
The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
13834
directories, much like @env{PATH}.  When configured as a native compiler,
13835
GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
13836
linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  Linking
13837
using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
13838
libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
13839
@option{-L} come first).
13840
 
13841
@item LANG
13842
@findex LANG
13843
@cindex locale definition
13844
This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in
13845
which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
13846
when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
13847
When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
13848
the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
13849
 
13850
@table @samp
13851
@item C-JIS
13852
Recognize JIS characters.
13853
@item C-SJIS
13854
Recognize SJIS characters.
13855
@item C-EUCJP
13856
Recognize EUCJP characters.
13857
@end table
13858
 
13859
If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
13860
compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as defined by the default locale to
13861
recognize and translate multibyte characters.
13862
@end table
13863
 
13864
@noindent
13865
Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the
13866
preprocessor.
13867
 
13868
@include cppenv.texi
13869
 
13870
@c man end
13871
 
13872
@node Precompiled Headers
13873
@section Using Precompiled Headers
13874
@cindex precompiled headers
13875
@cindex speed of compilation
13876
 
13877
Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
13878
source file.  The time the compiler takes to process these header files
13879
over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
13880
build the project.  To make builds faster, GCC allows users to
13881
`precompile' a header file; then, if builds can use the precompiled
13882
header file they will be much faster.
13883
 
13884
To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
13885
other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
13886
treat it as a C or C++ header file.  You will probably want to use a
13887
tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
13888
the headers it contains change.
13889
 
13890
A precompiled header file will be searched for when @code{#include} is
13891
seen in the compilation.  As it searches for the included file
13892
(@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp,The C Preprocessor}) the
13893
compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
13894
looks for the include file in that directory.  The name searched for is
13895
the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.gch} appended.  If
13896
the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
13897
 
13898
For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
13899
@file{all.h.gch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
13900
precompiled header file will be used if possible, and the original
13901
header will be used otherwise.
13902
 
13903
Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
13904
directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
13905
before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
13906
Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
13907
used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
13908
directory containing an @code{#error} command.
13909
 
13910
This also works with @option{-include}.  So yet another way to use
13911
precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
13912
header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
13913
a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
13914
file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header.  If the header files
13915
have guards against multiple inclusion, they will be skipped because
13916
they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
13917
 
13918
If you need to precompile the same header file for different
13919
languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
13920
@emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.gch}, and put each precompiled
13921
header in the directory, perhaps using @option{-o}.  It doesn't matter
13922
what you call the files in the directory, every precompiled header in
13923
the directory will be considered.  The first precompiled header
13924
encountered in the directory that is valid for this compilation will
13925
be used; they're searched in no particular order.
13926
 
13927
There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
13928
good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
13929
 
13930
A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
13931
 
13932
@itemize
13933
@item
13934
Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
13935
 
13936
@item
13937
A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen.  You
13938
can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you can
13939
even include a precompiled header from inside another header, so long as
13940
there are no C tokens before the @code{#include}.
13941
 
13942
@item
13943
The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
13944
the current compilation.  You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
13945
compilation.
13946
 
13947
@item
13948
The precompiled header file must have been produced by the same compiler
13949
binary as the current compilation is using.
13950
 
13951
@item
13952
Any macros defined before the precompiled header is included must
13953
either be defined in the same way as when the precompiled header was
13954
generated, or must not affect the precompiled header, which usually
13955
means that they don't appear in the precompiled header at all.
13956
 
13957
The @option{-D} option is one way to define a macro before a
13958
precompiled header is included; using a @code{#define} can also do it.
13959
There are also some options that define macros implicitly, like
13960
@option{-O} and @option{-Wdeprecated}; the same rule applies to macros
13961
defined this way.
13962
 
13963
@item If debugging information is output when using the precompiled
13964
header, using @option{-g} or similar, the same kind of debugging information
13965
must have been output when building the precompiled header.  However,
13966
a precompiled header built using @option{-g} can be used in a compilation
13967
when no debugging information is being output.
13968
 
13969
@item The same @option{-m} options must generally be used when building
13970
and using the precompiled header.  @xref{Submodel Options},
13971
for any cases where this rule is relaxed.
13972
 
13973
@item Each of the following options must be the same when building and using
13974
the precompiled header:
13975
 
13976
@gccoptlist{-fexceptions -funit-at-a-time}
13977
 
13978
@item
13979
Some other command-line options starting with @option{-f},
13980
@option{-p}, or @option{-O} must be defined in the same way as when
13981
the precompiled header was generated.  At present, it's not clear
13982
which options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice
13983
is to use exactly the same options when generating and using the
13984
precompiled header.  The following are known to be safe:
13985
 
13986
@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length= -fpreprocessed
13987
-fsched-interblock -fsched-spec -fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
13988
-fsched-verbose=<number> -fschedule-insns -fvisibility=
13989
-pedantic-errors}
13990
 
13991
@end itemize
13992
 
13993
For all of these except the last, the compiler will automatically
13994
ignore the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met.  If you
13995
find an option combination that doesn't work and doesn't cause the
13996
precompiled header to be ignored, please consider filing a bug report,
13997
see @ref{Bugs}.
13998
 
13999
If you do use differing options when generating and using the
14000
precompiled header, the actual behavior will be a mixture of the
14001
behavior for the options.  For instance, if you use @option{-g} to
14002
generate the precompiled header but not when using it, you may or may
14003
not get debugging information for routines in the precompiled header.
14004
 
14005
@node Running Protoize
14006
@section Running Protoize
14007
 
14008
The program @code{protoize} is an optional part of GCC@.  You can use
14009
it to add prototypes to a program, thus converting the program to ISO
14010
C in one respect.  The companion program @code{unprotoize} does the
14011
reverse: it removes argument types from any prototypes that are found.
14012
 
14013
When you run these programs, you must specify a set of source files as
14014
command line arguments.  The conversion programs start out by compiling
14015
these files to see what functions they define.  The information gathered
14016
about a file @var{foo} is saved in a file named @file{@var{foo}.X}.
14017
 
14018
After scanning comes actual conversion.  The specified files are all
14019
eligible to be converted; any files they include (whether sources or
14020
just headers) are eligible as well.
14021
 
14022
But not all the eligible files are converted.  By default,
14023
@code{protoize} and @code{unprotoize} convert only source and header
14024
files in the current directory.  You can specify additional directories
14025
whose files should be converted with the @option{-d @var{directory}}
14026
option.  You can also specify particular files to exclude with the
14027
@option{-x @var{file}} option.  A file is converted if it is eligible, its
14028
directory name matches one of the specified directory names, and its
14029
name within the directory has not been excluded.
14030
 
14031
Basic conversion with @code{protoize} consists of rewriting most
14032
function definitions and function declarations to specify the types of
14033
the arguments.  The only ones not rewritten are those for varargs
14034
functions.
14035
 
14036
@code{protoize} optionally inserts prototype declarations at the
14037
beginning of the source file, to make them available for any calls that
14038
precede the function's definition.  Or it can insert prototype
14039
declarations with block scope in the blocks where undeclared functions
14040
are called.
14041
 
14042
Basic conversion with @code{unprotoize} consists of rewriting most
14043
function declarations to remove any argument types, and rewriting
14044
function definitions to the old-style pre-ISO form.
14045
 
14046
Both conversion programs print a warning for any function declaration or
14047
definition that they can't convert.  You can suppress these warnings
14048
with @option{-q}.
14049
 
14050
The output from @code{protoize} or @code{unprotoize} replaces the
14051
original source file.  The original file is renamed to a name ending
14052
with @samp{.save} (for DOS, the saved filename ends in @samp{.sav}
14053
without the original @samp{.c} suffix).  If the @samp{.save} (@samp{.sav}
14054
for DOS) file already exists, then the source file is simply discarded.
14055
 
14056
@code{protoize} and @code{unprotoize} both depend on GCC itself to
14057
scan the program and collect information about the functions it uses.
14058
So neither of these programs will work until GCC is installed.
14059
 
14060
Here is a table of the options you can use with @code{protoize} and
14061
@code{unprotoize}.  Each option works with both programs unless
14062
otherwise stated.
14063
 
14064
@table @code
14065
@item -B @var{directory}
14066
Look for the file @file{SYSCALLS.c.X} in @var{directory}, instead of the
14067
usual directory (normally @file{/usr/local/lib}).  This file contains
14068
prototype information about standard system functions.  This option
14069
applies only to @code{protoize}.
14070
 
14071
@item -c @var{compilation-options}
14072
Use @var{compilation-options} as the options when running @command{gcc} to
14073
produce the @samp{.X} files.  The special option @option{-aux-info} is
14074
always passed in addition, to tell @command{gcc} to write a @samp{.X} file.
14075
 
14076
Note that the compilation options must be given as a single argument to
14077
@code{protoize} or @code{unprotoize}.  If you want to specify several
14078
@command{gcc} options, you must quote the entire set of compilation options
14079
to make them a single word in the shell.
14080
 
14081
There are certain @command{gcc} arguments that you cannot use, because they
14082
would produce the wrong kind of output.  These include @option{-g},
14083
@option{-O}, @option{-c}, @option{-S}, and @option{-o} If you include these in
14084
the @var{compilation-options}, they are ignored.
14085
 
14086
@item -C
14087
Rename files to end in @samp{.C} (@samp{.cc} for DOS-based file
14088
systems) instead of @samp{.c}.  This is convenient if you are converting
14089
a C program to C++.  This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
14090
 
14091
@item -g
14092
Add explicit global declarations.  This means inserting explicit
14093
declarations at the beginning of each source file for each function
14094
that is called in the file and was not declared.  These declarations
14095
precede the first function definition that contains a call to an
14096
undeclared function.  This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
14097
 
14098
@item -i @var{string}
14099
Indent old-style parameter declarations with the string @var{string}.
14100
This option applies only to @code{protoize}.
14101
 
14102
@code{unprotoize} converts prototyped function definitions to old-style
14103
function definitions, where the arguments are declared between the
14104
argument list and the initial @samp{@{}.  By default, @code{unprotoize}
14105
uses five spaces as the indentation.  If you want to indent with just
14106
one space instead, use @option{-i " "}.
14107
 
14108
@item -k
14109
Keep the @samp{.X} files.  Normally, they are deleted after conversion
14110
is finished.
14111
 
14112
@item -l
14113
Add explicit local declarations.  @code{protoize} with @option{-l} inserts
14114
a prototype declaration for each function in each block which calls the
14115
function without any declaration.  This option applies only to
14116
@code{protoize}.
14117
 
14118
@item -n
14119
Make no real changes.  This mode just prints information about the conversions
14120
that would have been done without @option{-n}.
14121
 
14122
@item -N
14123
Make no @samp{.save} files.  The original files are simply deleted.
14124
Use this option with caution.
14125
 
14126
@item -p @var{program}
14127
Use the program @var{program} as the compiler.  Normally, the name
14128
@file{gcc} is used.
14129
 
14130
@item -q
14131
Work quietly.  Most warnings are suppressed.
14132
 
14133
@item -v
14134
Print the version number, just like @option{-v} for @command{gcc}.
14135
@end table
14136
 
14137
If you need special compiler options to compile one of your program's
14138
source files, then you should generate that file's @samp{.X} file
14139
specially, by running @command{gcc} on that source file with the
14140
appropriate options and the option @option{-aux-info}.  Then run
14141
@code{protoize} on the entire set of files.  @code{protoize} will use
14142
the existing @samp{.X} file because it is newer than the source file.
14143
For example:
14144
 
14145
@smallexample
14146
gcc -Dfoo=bar file1.c -aux-info file1.X
14147
protoize *.c
14148
@end smallexample
14149
 
14150
@noindent
14151
You need to include the special files along with the rest in the
14152
@code{protoize} command, even though their @samp{.X} files already
14153
exist, because otherwise they won't get converted.
14154
 
14155
@xref{Protoize Caveats}, for more information on how to use
14156
@code{protoize} successfully.

powered by: WebSVN 2.1.0

© copyright 1999-2024 OpenCores.org, equivalent to Oliscience, all rights reserved. OpenCores®, registered trademark.